Escolar Documentos
Profissional Documentos
Cultura Documentos
Device pOints can be organized into 16 conventional zones and up Alarm Silence
to 240 control-by-event groups. System Reset
Device functional testing
Two 2-way data circuits (multiplex) provide communication to and
from a variety of input and output devices. Conventional (non-ad- Solo Test
dressable) detectors may be connected, individually or in small Alarm Verification
groups, to the data circuits using the IXA-500DM or IXA-500DMA
Manual operation of common alarm and fault relays
Conventional Detector Modules. The TFX-500 also connects to
off-site central stations and municipal fire alarm circuits. Optional Features
Offsite signalling with City Box Transmitter
TFX-800M-The Autocall TFX-800M expands the capacity of the
Module--CEB-500 (PIN 940524), Reverse Polarity
Autocall TFX-500 to allow up to 990 individual points, 80 zones, and
Transmitter Module--CVB-500 (PIN 940525), Digital Alarm
ten 2-way data (multiplex) circuits.
Communicator Transmitter Interface Module-SRA-550
Standard Features (P/N 940572).
Auxiliary Relay Module-ARM-500 (PIN 9760130) provides
Modular and Scalable Packaging
eight relay outputs.
Allows TFX to be sized to specific system requirements Expansion InpuVOutput Modules (XIOMs)-IM-16 Input
"Dead front," with locked access to operator control panel Module (PIN 976067) and OM-i6 Output Module (PIN
functions and additional locked access to electronics 976066)-provide inpuVoutput communication functions
Fits standard Autocall backboxes, and uses Autocall 19- by such as driving digital display outputs and accepting digital
5.25-inch module format inputs from volt-free contacts.
Front Door Operator Controls-Fire Control Module, Two Printer Options-Autocall Printer option (PIN 976018 or
Operator Display Module, 16 Indicator Module, 80 Indicator 976264)-piOvides a permanent printed record of system
Module, 40 x 2 Indicator Module, 16 Status control Module, activity.
40 Status Control Module. TFXnet Communications System-Up to 62 TFX-500/800
Status Control Modules may be used for fan control, fire panels connect to a single TFXnet network (supports up
damper control, speaker control, zone disconnect switches, to 59,400 analog/addressable points; 4800 zones). RS-485,
fire phone control, general purpose switches. fiber optic, and dedicated telephone wire communications
between network nodes is supported.
Section 1, "Autocall TFX-500M/800M General System Information," provides a general overview of the features and
functions of the Autoca!l TFX-500M and TFX-800M systems. An overvie..." of general installation procedures and en-
closure installation is provided.
Section 2, "Autocall TFX-500M/800M System Modules" provides a description of each module, board, or assembly to
be installed in the Autocall TFX-500M or TFX-800M control panel or remote operation/display panel.
Section 3, "Auto call TFX-500M/800M Ancillary Device Installation" provides installation instructions for each ancillary
device or auxiliary unit.
Section 4, "Autocall TFX-500M/800M Operation" Autocall TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operating Instructions, gives
"Quick Response" to alarm, supervisory, and trouble conditions. Remove or copy these operating instructions and
place them next to the appropriate control panel
Appendix provides important reference information such as battery calculation worksheet, system wiring information,
spare parts list, and removable Operating Instructions sheets. Remove the Operating Instructions (Publication Num-
bers 19700371 and 19700372) sheets at the back of this book, and post them within easy access of the TFX-500M or
TFX-800M control panel(s) and remote operation panel(s).
Appendix
TFX-500M/800M Battery Calculation Worksheets ..................... , .. A-I
TFX-500M and TFX-800M Spare Parts and Compatible Devices ......... A-5
Smoke Detector Compatibility Chart. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. .. .. . . . . . . . . . . . A-9
Index............................................................. 1-1
V. Appendix
19700368 3 1/97 TFX-500M/800M Standby Battery Calculations
19700373 2 1/97 TFX-500M/800M Spare Parts and Compatible Devices
19700411 2 1/97 Smoke Detector Compatibility Chart
~ o POWER
~
OPERATOR DISPLAY MODULE
16 INDICATOR MODULE
~ ......
101 101
0
0
FIRE
TROUBLE
0 1\ . I
li~,OI
PANEL SILENCE
ALARM SILENC~
I I23 \JAN '94 22 :l7~ 02
I [j]
It]
10 1
10 1
101
101
o SUPERVISOR)
I I SYSTEM RESET I ~
t~,., ~~ [t] ~
t;~,W< ;:0:~
10 1 101
I$~\ I ~ \j] \j] DELETEENTER
10 1 10 1
I "' E!]~
i~
ill t~i s
DRILL
10 1 101
ENABLE
~ 10 1
I i 101
FAST QUIT
~ ~[j]
,
10 1
"
OFF_@ %~,p lltt t})~; ~,,?j.
'""'~/ 10 1
I I
0
0
FIRE
TROUBLE
0 I*~' I
I;;wel
PANEL SILENCEI
ALARM SILENC~
I 23 JAN 94 22~17:02
I~
~ '%1"
o SUPERVISORI
~j!f I SYSTEM RESET I ~~~ t'"
~ DELETEENTER
~ ~ e!; ~ Ij]
.)
~s:/~
110 I DRILL
I '."l>'1\f'
ENABLE
III Ii] ~ FAST
[ij ,<"
'%""/ ACCESS QUIT
TES
OFF_0
~ [i][i]
80 INDICATOR MODULE
I @C] 1L:]12I:::J12C:.J12C:.J12C:.J12C:.JrJ:::J12C:]1.C:]
I2C:]
12I:::J12I:::J12C:.J12C:.J1.C:]12CJrJ:::J12CJ1.C:] I
I2C:]
101 I l2C:il2C:ii.2L:Ji.2L:Ji2I::J~I2LJI2C:Ji2I::J
12I:::J12C:J12CJ12CJ@C]@C]rJ:::J12C:J1.C:]
I I2C:] 1L:]12I:::J12CJ12C:.J12C:.J12CJrJ:::J12CJ1.C:]
I2C:] 10 1 II2I::::l [2[:::J12CJ !2CJ l2I::J ~ I2CJ I2I=:J
I2C:] 12I:::J12I:::J12C:.J12CJ12CJ12CJrJ:::J1.C:]1.C:]
1~~1@C] 12I:::J12I:::J12C:.J12CJ12CJ12CJrJ:::J12C:]12CJ
f>~",@
~~.c~
TFX-SOOM-198 addressable devices, on two 2-way data
II "
Ii!l
eel II ~ 'Ill,'
, Ill
loops (multiplex communications)-99 I/O devices per loop.
TFX-SOOM-990 addressable devices. on ten 2-wav data
100ps-99 I/O devices per l o o p . ' ,
Device points can be organized into 16 conventional zones and up Alarm Silence
to 240 control-by-event groups. System Reset
Device functional testing
Two 2-way data circuits (multiplex) provide communication to and
from a variety of input and output devices. Conventional (non-ad- Solo Test
dressable) detectors may be connected, individually or in small Alarm Verification
groups, to the data circuits using the IXA-SOODM or IXA-SOODMA
Manual operation of common alarm and fault relays
Conventional Detector Modules. The TFX-SOO also connects to
off-site central stations and municipal fire alarm circuits. Optional Features
TFX-SOOM-The Autocall TFX-800M expands the capacity of the Offsite signalling with City Box Transmitter
Module--CEB-SOO (P/N 940S24), Reverse Polarity
Autocall TFX-SOO to allow up to 990 individual points, 80 zones, and
Transmitter Module--CVB-SOO (P/N 94052S), Digital Alarm
ten 2-way data (multiplex) circuits.
Communicator Transmitter Interface Module-SRA-5S0
Standard Features (P/N 940S72).
Modular and Scalable Packaging Auxiliary Relay Module-ARM-SOO (P/N 9760130) provides
eight relay outputs.
Allows TFX to be sized to specific system requirements
"Dead front," with locked access to operator control panel
Expansion Input/Output Modules (XIOMs)-IAA-16 Input
Module (P/N 976067) and OAA-16 Output Module (P/N
functions and additional locked access to electronics 976066)-provide input/output communication functions
Fits standard Autocall backboxes, and uses Autocall 19- by such as driving digital display outputs and accepting digital
S.2S-inch module format. inputs from volt-free contacts.
Front Door Operator Controls-Fire Control Module, Two Printer Opiions-Autocall Printer option (PIN 976018 or
Operator Display Module, 16 Indicator Module, 80 Indicator 976264)-provides a permanent printed record of system
Module, 40 x 2 Indicator Module, 16 Status control Module, activity.
40 Status Control Module. TFXnet Communications System-Up to 62 TFX-500/800
Status Control Modules may be used for fan control, fire panels connect to a single TFXnet network (supports up
damper control, speaker control, zone disconnect switches, to 59,400 analog/addressable points; 4800 zones). RS-48S,
fire phone control, general purpose switches. fiber optic, and dedicated telephone wire communications
between network nodes is supported.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 1
Operator Access Passcodes
(a) II OACT
, , ~~D;~I~ll
Operators gain access to system functions by entering a passcode.
The level of access depends upon the user's access level. Special
01 , 161 ,
FC II ; NB-s~
9B_ ,
,S4, ,S7,
'S5' 'S8'
Pass code allows quick access by emergency personnel. I ~ ~6~ ~ ~9 ~
S1 MP
1'----" '----'.
AUTOCALL TFX-500M , , 02 "OOP , , , --61-0,
S11'
TFX-500M Assembly
110
I. ...
____
...
...
____
..
I S3 PS - S12'
, , : Sub;piaie
TFX-500M Main Control Panel
TFX-500M Remote Ops/Dis Panel
Analog-addressable Circuits (Loops)
0
0
1
1
3
2
01 , 161 I
. r----. ,----",
, '02
1,----" 1, ____ ".
"OOP
I
I,
D
Q
r
,,
,,
....... - ..
...
~-~:-,
,,
"I .......
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 2
TFX-500M System Configuration
Ooor Back Box
Configuration 01 02-07 Sub-Plate B1-B4 Other
Minimum FCM, ODM, MPIM MP, PS Batteries
Maximum (3-Box) FCM, ODM, 161, MPIM DOP1 MP, PS, NB2, 2 MPIMs, Batteries DACT, Printer
101/03 , PIM4
Maximum (5-Box) FCM, ODM, 161, MPIM 3 DOP1 MP, PS, NB2, 2 MPIMs, System Modules 5 , Aux- DACT, Printer
10 1/03 , PIM4 iliary Power supplies,
NOM6, Batteries
Maximum (7 -Box) FCM, ODM, 161, MPIM 5 DOP1 MP, PS, NB2, 2 MPIMs, System Modules, Auxil- DACT, Printer
101/03 , PIM4 iary Power supplies,
NOM6, Batteries
Remote Ops/Dis Panel (3-Box)
Minimum FCM, ODM, MPIM DCPM, MPIM
Maximum (3-Box) FCM, ODM, 161, MPIM DOp1 PS, DCPM, 2 MPIMs, Batteries Printer
101/03 , PIM4, NOM6
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 3
TFX-800M System Configuration
Door Back Box
Configuration 01 02-07 Sub-Plate B1-B4 Other
Minimum FCM, ODM, MPIM 80 Indicator MP, PS MB6 Batteries
I Maximum (5-Box) FCM, ODM, 161, MPIM 3 DOp1 MP, PS, NB2, MB6 System Modules5 , Aux- DACT, Printer
2 MPIMs, 6 1/03 , PIM4, iliary Power supplies,
NOM? NOM?, Batteries
Maximum (7-Box) FCM, ODM, 161, MPIM 5 DOP1 MP, PS, NB2, MB6 System Modules, Auxil- DACT, Printer
2 MPIMs, 6 1/03 , PIM4, iary Power supplies,
NOM? NOM?, Batteries
Warning:
It is important to follow the site plan and the planning forms for your installation because these forms are the basis for Autocall
TFX-500M/SOOM system programming. Any deviation from the site plan may result in incorrect programming of your system.
Fire alarm systems and the associated initiating, indicating, and controlling devices must meet requirements as described in the
codes and standards of the authorities having jurisdiction. Follow NFPA and NEMA guidelines for selection of, limitations of,
placement of, spacing of sensors and other system devices; system installation; system testing.
1. The TFX-500M/SOOM Control Panel; Remote Ops/Dis panel 11. Install and connect devices to Common Alarm Indicating
are shipped in two parts. The enclosure ("backbox"), and the (Sounder) Circuits A and B. Observe correct polarity. Make
electronic sub-plate assembly and front panel ("door") assem- sure all indicating appliances have EMI suppression and diode
bly. polarization devices installed.
2. Mount the enclosures, leave adequate space for access. 12. Install Remote Ops/Dis panel(s).
3. Install and test wiring for all system components, initiating 13. Connect other system options (relays, switches, etc.)
devices, and indicating appliances. Do not attach any 14. Install printer(s).
devices at this time. Be sure to use an LRC meter for testing 15. Power up system and test devices.
all wiring to system specifications (inductance, capacitance, a. Perform "Solo Test" as specified in the Autocall
resistance, and earth ground). TFX-500M/BOOM Operator's Manual (Publication Number
4. Install the electronics sub-plate and front panel assemblies S50515).
(including power supplies). b. Test offsite communications devices (be sure to notify
5. Connect standby batteries. central station before testing is begun).
6. Apply power to the control panel and test it. Then disconnect c. Disconnect AC power and operate any initiating device to
the power. confirm standby battery operation.
7. Set the appropriate address on each addressable device.
S. Install and connect devices on the 2-way data circuits (Loops
"A" and "B" or Loops "A" through "K"). Observe correct
polarity.
9. Make sure that there are no wiring errors (reverse polarity,
short circuits, cross-wiring).
10. Connect the two-way data circuits (with power off).
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
PageS
'Sectors" provide for grouping related zones. The network supports Network zone and sector LED display permits mapping of alarm,
JP to 80 sectors into which anyone, any set, or all TFX zones can supervisory and fault status of selected TFX zones or sectors onto
be assigned. Group actions can be defined to operate on sectors one or more LED zonal or sector displays. This permits one or more
instead of zones. As a result, one action can be used to control TFX panels to display the status of TFX zones or sectors
Dutputs of multiple select zones. throughout the network.
Peer Event Display Central Event Logging
LCD display-TFX panels can optionally annunciate events One or more TFX panels can be designated to provide central
received from other TFX panels to provide LCD display of events event logging. Each TFX panel is programmed with up to 3 panel
at any/all panel locations. The display identifies the panel originat- addresses to which "Ioggable" events are sent. A panel receiving
ing the event; the event type; identification of the zone to which the loggable events displays information about the event, prints the
point is assigned; identification of the point that changed state. event, and records the event in a historical log.
TFXnet Network System Limitations
System Components Minimum Maximum
TFX-500, TFX-800, TFX-500M, TFX-800M control 2 62
panels (Network nodes)
TLI-530 Network interface modules 2 62
TLO-530 fiber optic modem 0
Analog addressable points 0 59,400
7"" ... ,. ....
L.Uln::::~ 0 4800
Network Zone Links 0 250
Sectors 0 80
Sub-nets per system 1 62
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
PageS
(a)
., -l
T
1 TWISTED PAIR CABLE RS485
MAX. DISTANCE BETWEEN
NODES IS 10,000 FEET
USING NO. 18 AWG
TWISTEDI SHIELDED PAIR I
CABLE (WEST PENN #0975 I
OR EQUIVALENT) I I
MAX. DISTANCE
BETWEEN
II NODES USING
FIBER IS 13,000
NODE 7
Q==
NODE6
"1
(b)
1 -l
T
MAX. DISTANCE BETWEEN
NODES IS 10,000 FEET
USING NO. 18 AWG
TWISTEDI SHIELDED PAIR I
CABLE (WEST PENN #0975 I
OR EQUIVALENT) I
I
I
MAX. DISTANCI
BETWEEN
I I NODES USING
FIBER IS 13,00(
FEET
I
I
1
NODE 7 NODE6 NODE5
I
,--_--'-1.",
I .-'I..J,I_ _--.
~ [;;~-i~~~rfaCe I I [;;~-i~~~rfaCe {1 == '--___---'
2 TYPE 62.5/125 FIBER
OPTIC CABLES
Figure-Network Bus Topology showing support and requirements for mixed fiber optic!
twisted pair wiring. (a) Bus topology, (b) Ring topology
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 7
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience installing
and testing fire detection systems. These instructions do not purport to
cover all the details orvariations in the equipment described. Nor dothey
provideforeverypossiblecontingencymetinconnectionwithinstallation,
operation, or maintenance. All specifications are subject to change
without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems arise
which are not covered sufficiently for the user's purposes, the matter
should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company, Inc.,
Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 9
Wiring Parameters
Table 1. TFX-500M/BOOM Field Wiring Circuits with Wiring Parameters (Maximum)
length Inductance Capacitance Resistance Current
Circuit / Supervision Style (ft) Wiring/Cable (l) (e) (R) Rating
2-Way Data (Addressable loops, 99 Style 4 6500 Twisted wire pair with 1,5 0,5 microfarad 75 ohms
addresses each loop) Style 6 shield millihenry (mutual)
Addressable loop supervised, spur circuits Style 7*
not supervised
Remote Bus (EIA-RS485) 16 RBus Style 4 4000 Twisted wire pair with NA 0,5 microfarad 100 ohms
addresses, Supervised (EOls 150 ohm shield (total)
and 120 ohm)
Common Alarm (Bell) Circuits Style Y (See Table 2) Twisted wire pair with -- -- (See Table 1 amp
Supervised (EOl PIN 900937) only shield (See Table 3) 3) inductive
Auxiliary Power Supply Wiring to Modules No, 16 AWG minimum -- -- 0,1 ohm --
(24 VDC) max,
I
Printer (EIA-RS232) 50 (same room) Special serial data cable 0 2500 picofarad 100 ohms --
with special jack (total)
TFX-Net RS485 Network (30 network Style 6 10,000 ft Twisted wire pair with -- 0.3 fAt max@ 75 ohms
points maximum) Style 7 shield 0f'/est Penn 38.4 k-baud; 0,6
#0975 or equivalent) fAf max@ 19,2 k-
baud; 1,2 fd max
@ 9600 baud
and below
*Complies with operation characteristics for NFPAStyle 7 when a line isolator (CA-500Ll) is connected adjacentto and via conduit, tothe input and output of
each addressable device). Maximum number of CA-500Ll modules per analog addressable loop is 12.
Table 2. Wire Chart for Alarm Indicating Devices Table 3. Minimum Separation Between Power and
Signal Wires
Length of wire run (pair) for DC alarm indicating devices on 1 Power Cable Power Cable Current Separaton
amp circuits. (1 volt maximum line loss) Voltage Separation (ft/inches)
(ft/inches)
18AWG 16AWG 14AWG 12AWG
115V 1ft 5amp 1ft
0.1 amp 780ft 1240ft 1980ft 3100 ft
240 V 1 ft, 6 inches 15amp 1ft
0.2 amp 390ft 620ft 990ft 1570ft 415V 2ft 50 amp 1 ft, 8 in
0.3 amp 260ft 410ft 660ft 1040ft 3.3kV 3 ft, 8 inches 100 amp 2ft
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 10
(a) MEASURING CAPACITANCE
LCR METER
"C" CAPACITANCE
((
0 0
Left Sig.+
Left Rtn.-
o
FLOAT
[ )
SHIELD \
Right Sig.+
o v
Right Rtn.-
o
o I )
V
L- TOOVDCC
LCR METER
I~I "R" RESISTANCE
"L" INDUCTANCE
ADDRESSABLE LOOP
0 0
NO SPLICES
l~ /
FLOAT SHIELD
Left Sig.+ o
Left Rtn.- ( )
Right Sig.+ o v
Right Rtn.-
o
- Iy)
o
(
JUMPER
/ TO 0 V DCC
Figure 1. TFX-500M/BOOM System Wiring Parameter Testing Using LRC Meter., (a) capacitance, (b) resistance
and inductance.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 11
TELEPHONE LINES, ADDRESSABLE LOOPS AND
DOOR MODULES: POWER LIMITED OTHER FIELD WIRING
FCM MODULE, ODM MODULA, 16 INDICATOR MODULE, 80 INDI- POWER LIMITED
CATOR MODULE, 40 STATUS CONTROL MODULE, 40 X 2 INDI-
CAOTR MODULE, 16 STATUS CONTROL MODULE, MPIM
ALL POWER LIMITED
POWER
LIMITED
SRA-550
MAIN PROCESSOR
BOARD
POWER
LIMITED
TO PRINTER
POWER LIMITED
MAIN PROCESSOR
BOARD
POWER
LIMITED
PRiNTER
POWER
LIMITED
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 13
DOOR MODULES:
FCM MODULE, ODM MODULA, 16 INDICATOR MODULE, 80
INDICATOR MODULE, 40 STATUS CONTROL MODULE, 40 X 2
INDICAOTR MODULE, 16 STATUS CONTROL MODULE, MPIM
ALL POWER LIMITED
POWER LIMITED
MAINTAIN SEPARATION
- - - - - - -I
o
o
Figure 5. TFX-500M with TU-530 network interface module; typical wire routing to main-
tain 0.25 inch separation of power limited and non-power limited wiring.
ADDRESSABLE LOOPS, TFX-NET NETWORK,
FIELD WIRING POWER LIMITED
MAIN PROCESSOR
BOARD
POWER
LIMITED
UL LISTED
SECONDARY
PROTECTOR
PIN SX-
TB-030-2A
NON-POW-
ER LIMITED
Figure 6. TFX-500M/BOOM with TLB-530 baseboard, TU-530 network board, TLA-530 interface
board, CEB-500 city box transmitter; typical wire routing to maintain 0.25 inch separation of power
limited and non-power limited wiring.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 14
ADDRESSABLE LOOPS, THRON-NET
NETWORK, AND OTHER FIELD WIRING
POWER LIMITED
EXPANSION MOTHERBOARD
DOOR MODULES:
WITH ALXMs AND DCPM
FCM MODULE, ODM MODULE, 16 INDICATOR MODULE, 80 INDI-
POWER LIMITED
CATOR MODULE, 40 STATUS CONTROL MODULE, 40 X 2 INDI-
CAOTR MODULE, 16 STATUS CONTROL MODULE, MPIM
ALL POWER LIMITED
TO
MAIN PROCESSOR PRINTER
BOARD POWER
LIMITED
TFX-NET
NET-
WORK
POWER
LIMITED
TO CITY BOX
TRANSMITTER
NON-POWER
LIMITED
NON-POW-
ER LIM-
ITED
NON-POWER LIMITED
Figure 7. TFX-800M with TLA-530 interface, TLB-530 base board, TU-530 net-
work board, CEB-500 city box transmiiter; typical wire routing to maintain 0.25
inch separation of power limited and non-power limited wiring.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 15
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience installing and testing fire detection
systems. These instructions do not purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment
described. Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection with installation,
operation, or maintenance. All specifications are subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems arise which are not covered
sufficiently for the user's purposes, the matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems
Company Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
Front Panel
1. Fill in Zone 10 strips and insert them into the slots in each door
panel. Make sure each indicator is correctly labeled
ELECTRONICS 2. Install the door panel to the door with screws and washers.
BACK
SUB-PLATE
BOX ~
DOOR
FACE- "-
PLATE "-
MODULES ELECTRONICS
SUB-PLATE
0 ~'------
~I:J
- 'r".-. . :. ~
~c~:;..--o~CJ
NO FIELD WIRING
THIS AREA WHEN
t~ATTERIES
WHEN RE-
QUIRED
v; NO FIELD WIRING
THIS AREA WHEN
to.ATTERIES
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 17
SURFACE MOUNTING FLUSH MOUNTING
I BACK EDGE OF
AGAINST WALL
FLANG~
POSITION
BOX WITH
LOCK
~,
CATCH
THIS SIDE
d \
r:J~ , "
II
!: ..--c;-
l
I n I
~
I
~OORMOUNTING
I ~
0
IIIII
I~"o"::,~
UU
.~
SCREWS 11
8 - 32 T.F.S.M.S. ... MOUNTING SCREWS
1/4 - 20 M.M.C.S. Lt:==::::=::=:j
DOOR MOUNTING CABINET SPACER
SCREWS
8 - 32 T.F.S.M.S.
I I
q 3
5
Standard
Standard
4"
4"
59/16"
5 9/16"
-
-
19"
291/2"
231/8"
335/8"
22"
321/2"
I I "- 7 Standard 4" 5 9/16" 20" 40" 441/8" 43"
I
I
I
I
I
I
W
X
Y ""
Z
5
7
Deep
Deep
6"
6"
7 9/16"
79/16"
-
20"
291/2"
40"
335/8'
441/8"
331/2'"
43"
-0- - - - - - - - -
~/
V
V
Illp~
I
I :I
! ! ! !
o POWER
BunONS
OFF_
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 19
FIRE CONTROL FRONT SLOT FOR
6-32 SCREW POST PANEL DISPLAY,,- LABEL
THREE MODULE
BACKING PLATE
THREADED NYLON
SPACER 3/4-INCH
'"
'"
~---(--~----~~---------,----~
5/16-INCH NUT
FIRE CONTROL BOARD
'a)
c:::>. - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -.' - - --
I
FCM PCB
o P/N 900963
:
I
~;
:
:
I '
,,"
\ ..
-,
.,.,'
I ~ I , - ,
I : I '" ~
-----------------.--------- ~ ------. O~i-;" 0 m
A[Li] [ ~~ 11' , 0-1----....,
.. 1 j
VI
DETAiL "A" """'ffl'-.../\l 16 PIN
\
KEYS~ITCH '" SLOT FOR \
RIBBON
KEYSWITCH " CABLE
SEE DETAIL "A"
HEX NUT / "\.. 6-32 THREADED NY-
LOCK"\..
Q
LON SPACER
!
WASHER FRONT RE- 3/8 INCH LONG
TAINING
RING 5/16-INCH NUT
CROSS-SECTION
MPIM
(b) FIT KEYSWITCH FOR CORRECT
" 6-32 THREADED
ORIENTATION . .~. .~. . . . . . . . . .~~... NYLON SPACER
FCM 3/4-INCH
THREE MODULE
BOARD
--..-I!IIt-~IIfiI..-=-....-IJ!III-...ij. III1/ 6-32 THREADED
SCREW POST
BACKING PLATE FCM
DISPLAY
Figure 2. FCM Fire Control Module. (a) Back view with mounting plate, (b) Side view mounting installation.
Installation: d. Screw two plastiC spacers to each of the mounting screws
1. Mount Fire Control Display to the 19.5-inch Three Module extending from the display panel through the backing plate.
Backing Panel: e. Install the retaining ring on the keyswitch.
a. Install the Display panel to the front of the three-module 2. Mount FCM board to display panel screw posts, above the
backing panel so that the holes for keyswitch and LEDs are plastic spacers.
aligned correctly, the mounting screw posts extend through 3. Connect 7-conductor ribbon cable from display to FCM board
the holes in the backing plate, and the ribbon cable fits connector PL 13.
through its slot in the backing plate. 4. Mount MPIM piggy-back to the FCM board using screws and
b. Insert the ID strip for the front touch-buttons. Insert the strip plastic standoffs.
into the slot in the back of the mounting plate and front 5. Connect the keyswitch to the MPIM keyswitch terminals.
display. Make sure that the correct label aligns with each 6. Connect the ribbon cables and make other wiring connections.
touch-button.
c. On the FCM board, remove keyswitch retaining ring from
the keyswitch and insert the keyswitch through the hole in
the three-module backing panel and the display. Make sure
to orient the keyswitch correctly (flat sides of switch an hole
together).
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 20
16-PIN CONNECTOR FCM DISPLAY
TO LCD
PL3
~~:-\t~;;~~~~~t-)r:~~~
,J 20 PIN LOCAL BUSTO
MAIN PROCESSOR
BOARD PL 1 or PL4
'\ 0
PL1 ! ;
14PIN I; !
8-CONDUCTOR RIBBON LOCAL BY,,! II
CABLE TO OPERATOR IN ! 0
DISPLAY MODULE
0 U
MPIM
~~g~~~~s ~
....... U
o 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 PERSONALITY
1:1
'J -- [' @' ~2~ I"
[~~=r,w,~L~
0 0" ~~O .. 0 0 0 "1
o.
'6
PL5 1 AUXILIARY
000000000000000
POWER FROM
PL6 SERIAL PORT KEY SWITCH RPS (IF NEED-
ED)
I 16PIN
POWER
BUS OUT
Figure 3. FCM Fire Control Module. All circuits and connections are power Iimited/Class2.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 21
=rogramming Notes i. At "Action Type," press F2 to select "Command (to
points). Press Return.
Jsing CONSYS program the MPIM for FCM operation. You will ii. "Action Enable" will be "AFTER Delay/Coincidence
1eed to make several changes to the default TFX operating Reached"
!)rogram. iii. "Force Broadcast" (if available) will be "Disabled."
iv. "Active Edge" will be "Rising Edge."
f""4\l BE SURE TO TEST ALL PROGRAM CHANGES v. Rising Edge Action" Will be "Switch On."
vi. Falling Edge Action" will be "No Action Taken."
lJ DURING SYSTEM COMMISSIONING!
vii. "Target/Group Short Code" will be OUnnn "FIRE
1. Add User-Defined Output Group "Fire Alarm Silenced." See ALARM SILENCED," the new user defined output
Figure 4. group." To select this group type "OU" in the "Target/
a. Select "Groups" menu option. Group Short Code" position, then select the new group
b. At the "Groups: screen, select "Add User Group." from the menu of user defined output groups.
c. Atthe "Add Group" screen, move the cursor to 'Type." Press viii. 'Target Area Type" must be "ZONE." Press F2 to see
the F2 key to select "OUTPUT USER DEFINED." Press a menu of target area types; select "Zone."
Return. ix. Target Area" must be setto "0." Either type "0" or press
i. The "Valid ~~umber Range will show the group F2 for a menu from which you select "0."
numbers that are appropriate for the group you are d. Save the new action and definition for group EA264.
adding.
ii. A "New Short Code" with the next available number will 3. Edit Event Action GroUD EA014. "Alarm OIP Control" crOUD
be assigned to the group you are adding. You may (See Figure 6) as follows: . , . ~.
change this number as long as it is within the "Valid a. Select the "Groups" menu option.
Number Range." b. Select "Edit Group Data."
iii. Move the cursor to the "Name" position. Name the i. At the "Group Type List" menu select "Event Action."
group "FIRE ALARM SILENCED." Move the cursor to group EA014, "Alarm O/P Control".
iv. Select the ADD box to add the group. Press RETURN.
v. Press F5 to save the new group. Return to the "Group" ii. At the Group Definition screen for group EA014, move
menu screen. the cursor to the "Number of Associated Actions."
Change the number from "11" to "12."
2. Edit Event Action Group EA264 , "Silence (points in alarm)" iii. Select the "EDIT ACTION" box. Move the the twelfth
group (See Figure 5) as follows: associated action.
a. Select the "Groups" menu option. c. Add a new "Associated Action" as follows:
b. Select "Edit Group Data." i. At "Action Type," press F2 to select "Command (to
i. At the "Group Type List" menu select "Event Action." points). Press Return.
Move the cursor to group EA264 "Silence (points in ii. "Action Enable" will be "AFTER Delay/Coincidence
alarm). Press RETURN. Reached"
ii. At the Group Definition screen for group EA264, move iii. "Force Broadcast" (if available) will be "Disabled."
the cursor to the "Number of Associated Actions." iv. "Active Edge" will be "Rising Edge."
Change the number from "1" to "2." v. Rising Edge Action" Will be "Switch Off."
iii. Select the "EDIT ACTION" box. Move the the second vi. Falling Edge Action" will be "No Action Taken."
associated action. vii. "Target/Group Short Code" will be OUnnn "FIRE
c. Add a new "Associated Action" as follows: ALARM SILENCED," the new user defined output
group." To select this group type "OU" in the 'Target!
/
Programmable Timers Name: [Fire Alarm Silenced 1
Pulsing Patterns
Reset Time
Ground Fault
I CANCEL II END
II ADD
I I EDIT
I
Power Failure Sig. D Note: Number automatically
Sensitivity Switching
assigned, but may be
changed (within valid range).
Figure 4. Adding User Defined Group for "Fire Alarm Silenced" output.
AUTOCALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 22
Project : untitled ( - ) 16:17 ~, Choose Required Group
~~
File I Edit I J Edit Group Data
....,,~ltle
Input Normal
Output Normal
T~
Input Special
Add User Group Output Special
'y.tem
Network Remove User Group Choose Required Group
Input User Def' ed
Edit Zones Output User fined --'"""-.-=:!o. EA ..
Addressabl
LBus
op Event Action
Super Group
~
~EA vr
... ~EA264 Silence
(points in alarm
RBus
Digital
Events
0 J All Groups
Group Definition
Bell Map Original Group Name: EA264 Silence (points in alarm)
Groups'
System Users Group Name: EA264 Silence (points in alarm)
System Options Group Scope Local/Network
Programmable Timers Group Activiation: Immediate
Pulsing Patterns Delay Time/Coincidence Level:
Reset Time Group Deactivation:
Ground Fault Trigger Type: All events
Power Fialure Sig. Delay Group Status on Powerup/Reset: Enabled
Sensitivity switching Point Status on Powerup/Reset: Armed
~I
Change Number of As-
Number of Associated Actions: 2
Action Definition
sociated Acions from
"1"to "2,"
I
k
Edit Second Associated
Associated Action: 2
I
Command (to points)
Action. --. I"EDlT ACTION I
Action Type:
Action Enable:
Forced Broadcast
AFTER Delay/Coincidence Reached
Disabled/Enabled
~-
Active Edge: Rising Edge
Rising Edge Action: Switch On
Falling Edge Action: No Action Taken
Target/Group Short Code: OUnnn Fire Alarm Silenced
Target Area Type: Zone
Target Area: 0
IL-~
Group Definition
Original Group Name: EA014 Silence (points in alarm)
Choose
::q.u.i.red G r o u p !
Group Name: EA014 Alarm O/p Control
EA ..
Group Scope Local/Network
EA . EA014 Alarm O~
Group Activiation: Immediate
Control
Delay Time/Coincidence Level:
Group Deactivation:
Trigger Type: All events
Group Status on Powerup/Reset: Enabled
Point Status on Powerup/Reset: Armed /"'" Change Number of As-
Number of Associated Actions: 12 sociated Acions from
"11"to "12."
Action Definition Edit Twelfth Associated I
Associated Action: 12 I Action. Ls::.....
r---A-c--t-i-o-n--T-y-p-e-:--------------------c-o-mm--a-n-d--(-t-o--p-o-i-n'tLs-)------------------}-~,,~~_~~
1.1 EDIT ACTION I
Action Enable: AFTER Delay/Coincidence Reached IV "
Forced Broadcast Disabled/Enabled
Active Edge: Rising Edge
Rising Edge Action: Switch Off
Falling Edge Action: No Action Taken
Target/Group Short Code: OUnnn Fire Alarm Silenced
Target Area Type: Zone
Target Area: 0
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 23
Group Short Code" position, then select the new group d. For TFX-500 "Zonal Display," program Expansion Bus I/O.
from the menu of user defined output groups. See Figure 8.
viii. "Target Area Type" must be "ZONE." Press F2 to see i. At the "Digital Inputs/Outputs" screen, select "Expan-
a menu of target area types; select "Zone." sion Bus."
ix. Target Area" must be set to "0." Either type "0" or press ii. At the "Digital I/O" screen, If 16 Indicator Module is
F2 for a menu from which you select "0." installed: remove "interleaved" Zonal Alarm Display
d. Save the new action and definition for group EA014. from point #9 and point #17. Next, program "Zonal
k (For TFX-500M ONLy) Edit the MPIM Local Bus, address 00, Alarm Display" at point #1 (non-interleaved):
personality '" OIB for operation with the FCM as follows: "Device Type," "Zonal Alarm
a. Select the "Digital I/O" menu option. (See Figure 7.) Display"
b. At the "Choose address with required Digital I/O" screen, "Device Opteration," 'Visual Indicator"
select "LBus 00 - OIB." "Group/Short Code," OS191 "Zonal
c. At the "Digital Inputs/Outputs" screen, program: Alarm Display"
i. Program "General Purpose Input 1" for device type "I/P
(Norm. Hi)," special input group IS010 "Lamp Test "Number of Outputs" 16
Button." (See Figure 7.) To do this, move the cursor to "First I/P Displayed" 1
"General I/P 1." Press Return. At the "Digital Inputs/ and program "Zonal Trouble Display" at point #17
Outputs" screen program: (non-interleaved) :
"Device Type," "liP (Norm. Hi) "Device Type," "Zonal Trouble
"Device Opteration," "No debounce" Display"
"Group/Short Code," "IS010 Lamp "Device Opteration," 'Visual Indicator"
Test Button" "Group/Short Code," OS223 "Zonal
"ZoneiSector": "0" Trouble Display"
"Norm->Act Event" INPUT ACTIVE
(not log'd) "Number of Outputs" 16
"Act->Norm Event CLEAR (non "First ijP Displayed" i
logging) e. Program Expansion Bus point #81 for "Fire Alarm Silenced"
ii. Re-Program the "Test Key" (See Figure 7) as follows: as follows:
"Device Type," "I/P (Norm. Lo) i. At the "Digital Inputs/Outputs" screen select "Expan-
"Device Opteration," "No debounce" sion Bus." At the "Digital I/O" screen, select "Point 81."
"Group/Short Code," "IS099 Buzzer "Device Type," "O/P (Norm. Off)
Silence I/P." "Device Opteration," "Visual Indicator"
Zone/Sector": "0" "Group/Short Code," "OUnnn "Fire
"Norm->Act Event" INPUT ACTIVE Alarm Silenced"
(not log'd) (User Defined
"Act->Norm Event CLEAR (non group)
logging) "Zone/Sector": "0"
"Number of Outputs" "1 n
Ei~:;~~~.
V
V
V
V
V
Key liP 1
Key riP 2
Alarm LED
Trouble LED
S
'" exponH0=--t\
Digital r/o
General rip 1
Not Attached ____ Norm Act Event: INPUT Active (not log'd)
Act Norm Event: CLEAR (non logging)
I/P (Norm. LO)/-- ~
I/P (Norm Hi
Sector liP (Norm. Lo)
Sector r/p (Norm. Hi) ---r~--~----------------------------------------------------_,
Digital rio
General liP 1
Figure 7. Editing Digital I/O Inputs/Outputs for (1) Generall/P 1 input, (2) Changes to Test Key operation.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 25
Choose address with required
Digital Ilo
CPU 00 - MPM
Proiect : Unti tIed ( - J
LBus 00 - OIB
IFile I Edit I Transfer RBUS# - XBB
System Type
Network
((
Edit Zones
Addressable Loop
LBus
RBus
LBus:
v
00
General lip 1
V V Supervisory LED
OIB - Operator IIF
I DiaitaJ. -.r/O I
Events
General liP 2 v Buzzer
Bell Map
Tamper rip v Fire Drill Key
Groups
V RS232 ONline Det. v Silence Key
System Users
V Key lip 1 v Reset Key
System Options V Key lip 2 v Test Key
v Alarm LED
~~'P'O"P'
F'alJit
~
Programmable Timers
Pulsing Patterns
Reset Time
V Trouble LED xpansion Bus V
I
Ground Fault
Power Failure
\Jf I
--
Sensitivity Swit
Digital Ilo
Point: 9 _ Note: Change TFX-500 16 Indicator
Expansion Bus
Module Display:
Device Type:
Device Operation:
'00.1 Diap1.y
Visual Indicator
:~ Point 9 Not Attached
Point 17 Not Attached
GrouplShort Code: OS191 Zonal Alarm Point 1 Zonal Alarm Display
zone/Sector: All
Point 17 Zonal Trouble Display
Number of Outputs: 16 '"
First liP Displayed: 1 Not Attached Remote Zonal Display
lip (Norm. Lo) Sector Display
Norm Act Event: lip (Norm Hi) Loop A Display
Act Norm Event: Sector lip (Norm Lo) ~
Expansion Bus Sector lip (Norm Hi) Loop K Display
olp (Norm Off) L Bus Display
Device: Zonal Display Point: 9 olp (Norm. On) R Bus Display
Zonal Display
- - - - - - - -
m
T
-
-
A -
-
A
T
-
-
A
T
-
-
A - A - - A - Note: Press F10 for Expansion
T - T - T - -
A
T
A
-
-
-
A
T
A
-
-
-
A
T
A
-
-
-
A
T
A
-
-
-
- Bus Map. Change 16 Indicator
Module from "interleaved" alarm
and trouble display to
T - T - T - T - "non-interleaved" display pattern.
-l Map Key:
Expansion Bus
Device: Zonal Display Point: 1 Zonal Display/Sector Display
A = Alarm
T = Trouble
~ A A A A A A A 0= Isolate
A A A A A A A A Z = Other
T T T T T T T T Point Display
Note: Program Point 81 for
T T T T T T T T a=Alarm
- - - - - - - - Output (Norm. Off), Visual
Indicator, OUnnn Fire Alarm t = Trouble
- - - - - - - - d = Isolate
- - - - - - - - Silenced" p = Other
- - - - - - - - Single Input Point
- - - - - - - - I = Input Point
- - - - - - - Single Output Point
0 - - - - - - - o = Output Point
Figure 8. Editing Expansion Bus of LBus 00 OIB for FCM operation. (1) for 16 Indicator Module, change display
from interleaved to non-interleaved; (2) Program Point 81 for Fire Alarm Silenced indicator.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 26
5. (ForTFX-800M ONLy) Editthe Local Bus and Remote Bus for Display" at point #1 (See Figure 10):
operation with the FCM as follows: "Device Type," "Zonal Display"
a. Select "LBus" menu option. Select Address "01." Change "Device Opteration," 'Visual Indicator"
"Board Personality" from "XBB" to "No board. (that is, "Group/Short Code," OS223 "Zonal
remove LB-01). Trouble Display"
b. Select "RBus" menu option. At Address "00," select "XBB"
for "Board Personality." "Number of Outputs" 80
c. Select the "Digital I/O" menu option. (See Figure 9.) "First I/P Displayed" 1
d. At the "Choose address with required Digital I/O" screen, iv. Program Expansion Bus point #81 for "Fire Alarm
select "LBus 00 - OIB." Silenced" as follows:
e. At the "Digital Inputs/Outputs" screen, program thefollowing At the "Digital Inputs/Outputs" screen select "Expan-
for LBus 00 - OIB: sion Bus." At the "Digital I/O" screen, select "Point 81."
i. Program "General Purpose Input 1"for device type "I/P "Device Type," "O/P (Norm. Off)
(Norm. Hi)," special input group IS010 "Lamp Test "Device Opteration," "Visual Indicator"
Button." (See Figure 9.) To do this, move the cursor to "Group/Short Code," "OUnnn "Fire
"General I/P 1." Press Return. At the "Digital Inputs/ Alarm Silenced"
Outputs" screen program: (User Defined
"Device Type," "liP (Norm. Hi) group)
"Device Opteration," "No debounce" "Zone/Sector": "0"
"Group/Short Code," "IS010 Lamp "Number of Outputs" "1"
Test Button" f. Atthe "Digital Inputs/Outputs" screen, program the following
"Zone/Sector": "0" for RBus 00 - XBB with 80 Indicator Module programmed for
"Norm->Act Event" INPUT ACTIVE "Zonai Alarm Display":
(not log'd) At the "Digital I/O" screen, If 80 Indicator Module is installed
"Act->Norm Event CLEAR (non on MPIM LB-OO: program "Zonal Alarm Display" at point #1
logging) (See Figure 10):
ii. Re-Program the "Test Key" (See Figure 9) as follows: "Device Type," "Zonal Display"
"Device Type," "I/P (Norm. Lo) "Device Opteration," 'Visual Indicator"
"Device Opteration," "No debounce" "Group/Short Code," OS191 "Zonal
"Group/Short Code," "IS099 Buzzer Alarm Display"
Silence I/P."
Zone/Sector": "0" "Number of Outputs" 80
"Norm->Act Event" INPUT ACTIVE "First I/P Displayed" 1
(not log'd) g. Save the new Digital I/O configuration.
"Act->Norm Event CLEAR (non 6. Follow the CONSYS programming manual to program the rest
logging) of the system site information. Save the program. Install the
iii. At the "Digital I/O" screen, If 80 Indicator Module is CONSYS program in the TFX panel.
installed on MPIM LB-OO: program "Zonal Trouble
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 27
Local Bus Addr.: 01 Note: For TFX-800M
Board Personality: No board
Change LB-01 to
Untitled
"No Board"
Edit:1 Transfer Configuration:
Change RB-OO to
"XBB Expansion Bus"
Remote Bus Addr.: 00
~:::n~~~n :ault ~-
Key lip 2
Alarm LED :::
V Trouble LED V Expansion Bus ~\
Digital I/O
\/
General I/P 1
Not Attached ____ Norm Act Event: INPUT Active (not log'd)
I/P (Norm. Lo) ~ Act Norm Event: CLEAR (non logging)
I/P (Norm Hi
Sector r/p (Norm. LO)
Sector I/P (Norm. Hi)
Digital I/O
General I/P 1
Figure 9. Editing TFX-800M LBus, RBus, and Digital I/O Inputs/Outputs for (1) Generall/P 1 input, (2)
Changes to Test Key operation.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 28
Module Position:, _ _ _ _ __
(See System Layout)
One single-module panel of a TFX-500M/800M 19-inch
door position
AUTOCALL Input Voltage: +5 VDC, + 12 VDC
Current Draw: Normal (LCD lighted) 32 rnA; Alarm 32 rnA
ODM Operator Display Module
Assembly No. 976128 Dimensions (wid): Display panel: 5.9 X 5.25 X 0.75 inches
LCD PIN 940506 LCD display: 3.8 X 2.4 X 0.75 inches
FAST
QUIT ACCESS
~~
Figure 1. ODM Operator Display Module.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 31
THREE
(a) THREADED MODULE
OPERATOR DISPLAY POST BACKING
FRONT PANEL
PLATE
6-32 THREADED NYLON
6-32 HEX NUT SPACER 3/8 INCH
LCD
PIN 940506 2-56 HEX NUT
c:::>., - - - - - - - - - - - - - -- ;-----------------'0
, '
[ ,
: - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - ;@
, ()
rB ,:-----------------;'l
(b)
6-32 THREADED NYLON
SPACER 3/8 INCH
MOUNTING SCREW MPIM MOUNTING SCREW
MOUNTING
POST WITH 2-56 NUT POST WITH 6-32 NUT
SCREW
10-32\ FCM
~7~940506 ~ \
....,
..;. . BE:llA.R.D-:::::::::::-~~II:::::.-- . . . .- -...." '
B
---
I~
Figure 2. ODM Operator Display Module. (a) Back view, (b) Side view with mounting plate.
Installation: c. Install the 2-56 nuts to secure the LCD to the display panel.
1 . Mount Operator Display Module to the front of the 19.5-inch 3. Install the other modules to the backing plate.
Three Module Backing Plate. 4. Connect the ribbon cables and make other wiring connections.
a. Insert the 8-conductor ribbon cable through the slot in the
backing plate. Table 2. Connections to Operator Display Module.
b. Fit the threaded posts through the holes in the backing
plate. Install the 6-32 nuts to the threaded posts. Terminal Description Function Connects to
2. Mount the LCD to the display panel.
a. Install the threaded nylon spacers to the four threaded screw PL12 8 Conductor Operator Touch- Fire Control Mod-
posts at the four corners of the LCD window on the Operator Cable buttons ule PL12
Display panel. PL3 16 Pin LCD Fire Control Mod-
b. Fit the LCD board to the screw posts. ule PL3
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 32
ODM CONNECTOR TO BLACK
(BEHIND) LCD
20 PIN
RIBBON CABLE TO
14PINffl
LOCALBH I
OPERATOR DISPLAY II
MODULE MPIM
~D I i
F9c::d U
bd()~
L -_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _---l16 PIN
RED AUX+fll
16PIN
L
Figure 3. ODM Operator Display Module. All circuits and connections are power Iimited/Class2.
Wiring Notes
1 . All conductors must be free of grounds.
2. Disconnect power before servicing systems.
3. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable
notes. All circuits contained in this module are classified as
power limited/Class 2 and shall be installed to comply with
N.E.C. Article 760, Part A and Part C.
4. Connect 8-conductor ribbon cable form Operator Display
module to PL 12 of the Fire Control Module (P/N 900963)
5. Connect the LCD 16-pin connector to PL3 connector of the Fire
Control Module (P/N 900963).
6. Refer to Fire Control Module Installation Guide, Publication No.
19700360 for further information.
7. Refer to MPIMlnstallation Guide, Publication No. 19700235for
installation, wiring, and programming information
8. All wiring is classified as power limited/Class 2 and restricted
to panel cabinet.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 33
Table 3. Fast Access Codes.
Note: Permission to access these functions is dependent upon the operator's Access Level.
Code TFX Menu Option Code TFX Menu Option Code TFX Menu Option
0001 Do you want to accept events? 0050 Do you want to de-isolate points? 0092 Force point off?
0009 View un restored events? 0051 De-isolate zone? (sensors only) 0093 Unforce point?
0010 Do you want to view the log? 0052 De-isolate zone? (sounders only) 0095 Do you want to set sensitivity?
0011 Oldest event first? 0053 De-isolate pOint? (addr. loop only) 0096 Point sensitivity?
0012 Newest event first? 0054 Engineer de-isolate? 0097 Zone sensitivity?
0013 Highest priority event first? 0055 De-isolate signalling? 0100 View system statuses?
0016 View system Health Report? 0060 View point analogue values? 0101 View system zones alarm st?
0020 Do you want to set the clock? 0061 View point statuses? 0102 View system zones troub. st?
0021 Do you want to set the time? 0062 View loop analogue values? 0103 View system zones isol. st?
0022 Do you want to set the date? 0063 View loop point counters? 0104 View system common alarm st?
0030 Do you want to test system? 0064 Do you want to view point or loop 0105 View system common troub. st?
data?
0031 View systaem AI. Cycle count? 0065 View point obscuration? 0106 View system common disa. st?
0032 Reset system AI. Cycle count? 0070 Open VFP? 1030 Do you want to solo test multi input
nnint?.
r-~"'~
I
0033 View system S/W Init. count? 0080 Do you want to print data? 1200 Do you want to commission system?
0034 Reset system S/W Init. count? 0081 Print point analogue values? 1201 Enable fast fault mode?
0035 Do you want to solo test zone? 0082 Print points isolated? 1202 Enable fast open circuit scanning?
0036 Solo test sounders? 0083 Print pOints untested/failed? 1203 Disable rate of rise processing?
0037 Reset point threshold comp'n? 0084 Print points out of compensation? 1204 Shut down Loop?
0039 View system issue numbers 0085 Print event log backtrack? 1205 Restart Loop?
0040 Do you want to isolate points? 0086 Print points forced? 1206 Single address loop poll?
0041 Isolate zone? (sensors only) 0087 Print verifying counts?
0042 Isolate zone? (sounders only) 0088 Print 10 test result?
0043 Isolate point? (addr. loop only) 0089 Print point obscuration data?
0044 Engineer Isolate? 0090 Do you want to force outputs?
0045 Isolate signalling? 0091 Force point on?
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience installing and testing fire detection
systems. These instructions do not purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment
described. Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection with installation,
operation, or maintenance. All specifications are subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems arise which are not covered
sufficientlyforthe user's purposes, the matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems
Company Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 8719900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 34
Module Position: _ _ _ _ __
(See System Layout)
One single (113 of one full 19.5-inch) door position
Input Voltage: +5 VDC, + 12 VDC
AUTOCALL Current Draw: Normal (no LEOs lighted) 9 mA
Alarm (all LEOs ON) 34 mA (2.81 mA per LED)
16-lndicator Module Dimensions (wId): Display panel: 6.75 X 5.25 X 0.75 inches
Assembly No. 976129 PCB No. 900964 Board: 5.25 X 5 X 0.5 inches
Publication Number 19700362 Installation:
Issue 3, January 1997 1. Make indicator labels and insert into label slots so that labels
are visible from panel front.
The 16-lndicator Module is used in the Autocall TFX-500M/800M 2. Mount 16-lndicator Display Panel to Three Module Backing
fire control system, to provide 16 alarm and trouble indicators. Plate.
Bi-color (red and yellow) LEOs respond to zone, sector, or other a. Fit the Display to the backing plate so that the threaded
alarm and trouble indications, as programmed. The 16-lndicator posts extend through the holes in the backing plate.
Module is driven from the Autocall TFX-500M/800M control panel b. Fitthe four 6-32 X 3/8-inch threaded nylon spacers over the
panel via an MPIM Expansion Bus connection. threaded posts.
Please refer to Autocall TFX-500/BOO CONSYS Programming 3. Mount the 16-lndicator Board.
Guide PIN 850463 for more information. a. Fit board to threaded posts, above the nylon spacers.
b. Install 6-32 nuts to secure the board to the posts.
Operation 4. Connect the ribbon cables and make other wiring connections.
LED indicators: Normally OFF; Pulsing Red ON indicates Alarm;
Yellow ON indicates Trouble in the zone, sector, or area pro-
grammed. If LED is on continuously, alarms have been SILENCED.
101
101
101 10 1
101
LAMP TEST
TOUCH-BUTTON 101
(b)
101
THREADED .--------------~...., SLOT FOR ZONE ID STRIP THREE MODULE BACK-
POST I c:::=:::> 6-32 THREADED NYLON
SPACER 3/8 INCH
ING PLATE
------------~;----------------o
_---------'1" 1
o "
o "
1
"
6,32 HEX NUT "
"
~
"
"
"
"
(c) 0 ~----------:-----;~----------------;J
- -
0 0
MOUNTING SCREW
POST WITH 6-32 NUT
THREE MODULE
BACKING PLATE 16-lndicator MOD- / 6-32 THREADED NYLON
FCM
ULE DISPLAY SPACER 3/8 INCH
DISPLAY
Figure 1. 16-lndicator Module. (a) Front view, (b) Back view, typical mounting to mounting plate (c) Side view.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 35
16-INDICATOR BOARD
, DS9 , DS1
, DS10 , DS2
, ,
DS11 DS3
DS12
,
DS4
, DS13
, DS5
, DS14 , DS6
, , 16 PIN
DS15 OS? EXPANSION BUS IN
, , XBUS ADDRESSES1-32
~ DS16 DSB NOTE 4
PL6
LAST BOARD
PL14 ~
JUMPER
..... ......... 1 NOTE 5
Figure 2. 16-lndicator Module. All circuits and connections are power Iimited/Class2.
Wiring Notes: 1. Edit the MPIM Local Bus, address 00, personality = OIB for
1. All conductors must be free of grounds. operation with the FCM as follows:
2. Disconnect power before servicing systems. a. Select the "Digital I/O" menu option.
3. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA b. At the "Choose address with required Digital I/O" screen,
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable select "LBus 00 - OIB."
notes. All circuits contained in this module are classified as c. At the "Digital Inputs/Outputs" screen, program the follow-
power limited/Class 2 and shall be installed to comply with ing:
N.E.C. Article 760, Part A and Part C. d. For TFX-500 "Zonal Display," program Expansion Bus I/O.
4. 16-pin ribbon cables connect Expansion Bus to the 16-lndica- See Figure 3.
tor Module. PL6 (XBus IN) is Expansion Bus connection for a i. At the "Digital Inputs/Outputs" screen, select "Expan-
16-lndicator Module or a 16-Status ontrol Module. PL 14 (XBus sion Bus."
OUT) connects to other modules on the Expansion Bus. All ii. At the "Digital I/O" screen, If 16 Indicator Module is
ribbon cables and their applications are listed in Publication installed: remove "interleaved" Zonal Alarm Display
Number 19700260, "Autocall TFX-500/BOO Spare Parts." from point #9 and point #17. Next, program "Zonal
5. JP1 Last Board Jumper Link-install jumper link if this is the Alarm Display" at point #1 (non-interleaved):
last board on the Expansion bus. Remove last-board link from "Device Type," "Zonal Display"
boards that precede on the Expansion Bus. "Device Opteration," "Visual Indicator"
6. All wiring is classified as power limited and restricted to the "Group/Short Code," OS191 "Zonal
panel enclosure. Alarm Display"
7. This wiring diagram is typical only. "Zone/Sector":
Programming Notes "Number of Outputs" 16
"First I/P Displayed" 1
and program "Zonal Trouble Display" at pOint #17
Using CONSYS program the MPIM for 16 Indicator Module (non-interleaved) :
operation. You will need to make several changes to the default "Device Type," "Zonal Display"
TFX operating program. "Device Opteration," "Visual Indicator"
"Group/Short Code," OS223 "Zonal
BE SURE TO TEST ALL PROGRAM CHANGES Trouble Display"
DURING SYSTEM COMMISSIONING! "Zone/Sector":
"Number of Outputs" 16
When programming the system for this module's operation, it is a "First I/P Displayed" 1
good idea to program the LEDs in sequence.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 36
Choose address with required
Digital I/O
CPU 00 - MPM
Proiect : Untitled
L ~
LBus 00 OIB
I I >Editl RBus 00 - XBB
File TransfV
- \. \..
r~
System Type
Network
Edit Zones
Addressable op LBus: 00 OIB - Operator I/F
LBus
RBus
I Diqital I/O "l
v General I/P 1 V Supervisory LED
General I/P 2 V Buzzer
Events
Bell Map Tamper I/P V Fire Drill Key
Groups V RS232 ONline Det. V Silence Key
System Users V Key I/P 1 V Reset Key
System Options v Key I/P 2 V Test Key
v Alarm LED
~XP""QO
Fflplt
Programmable Timers
Pulsing Patterns
Reset Time
V Trouble LED expanSion Bus
I
Ground Fault
Expansion Bus
Device Type:
Device Operation:
Group/Short Code:
Digital I/O
'00,1 Di,ploy
Visual Indicator
OS191 Zonal Alarm Dis
~
- --
Point: 9
Note: Change TFX-500 16 Indicator
Module Display:
Point 9
Point 17
Point 1
Point 17
Not Attached
Not Attached
Zonal Alarm Display
Zonal Trouble Display
Zone/Sector:
Number of Outputs: 16 ~
Not Attached Remote Zonal Display
First I/P Displayed: 1
I/P (Norm. Lo) Sector Display
l/P (Norm Hi) Loop A Display
Norm Act Event:
Act Norm Event:
Sector I/P (Norm Lo) ~
Sector l/P (Norm Hi) Loop K Display
Expansion Bus O/P (Norm Off) L Bus Display
O/P (Norm. On) R Bus Display
Device: Zonal Display Point: 9 Zonal Display
- - - - - - - -
l~
T - - T - T -
A - A - - A - Note: Press F10 for Expansion
T - T - T - -
Bus Map. Change 16 Indicator
A - A - A - A -
Module from "interleaved" alarm
T - T - T - T
L
A - A - A - A and trouble display to
T - T - T - T "non-interleaved" display pattern.
~
Map Key:
Expansion Bus W
Device: Zonal Display 1 Zonal Display/Sector Display
A = Alarm
T = Trouble
I2J A A A A A/A A D = Isolate
A A A A A A A A Z = Other
T T T T T T T T Point Display
T T T T T T T T a = Alarm
- - - - - - - - t = Trouble
- - - - - - - - d = Isolate
- - - - - - - - p = Other
- - - - - - - - Single Input Point
- - - - - - - - I = Input Point
- - - - - - - - Single Output Point
- - - - - - - - o = Output Point
Figure 3. Editing Expansion Bus of LBus 00 OIB for FCM operation. for 16 Indicator Module, change display
from interleaved to non-interleaved.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 37
2. When programming the 16 Indicator Module for single LEO
operation, it is a good idea to program the LEOs in sequence.
See Table 1. r - - - - - -16 Indi~ato-r - - - - -
Table 1. Typical MPIM Expansion Bus Addressing Scheme for ColumnA
16-lndicator Module LEOs. Panel #
Red LEO XBus I/O Ad- Yellow LEO XBus I/O Ad-
dress dress
OS1 1 OS1 17
OS2 2 OS2 18
OS3 3 OS3 19
OS4 4 OS4 20
:I OS5 5 OS5 21
OS6 6 OS6 22
OS7 7 OS7 23
OS8 8 DS8 24
OS9 9 OS9 25
OS10 10 OS10 26
u::;ii ii DSii ;a
OS12 12 OS12 28
OS13 13 OS13 29
OS14 14 OS14 30
0815 15 OS15 31
0816 16 OS16 32
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 38
Module Position: _ _ _ _ __
(See System Layout)
One 19.5-inch door position
Input Voltage: +5 VDC, +12 VDC
AUTOCALL Current Draw: Without MPIM: Normal (no LEOs lighted) 9 rnA,
Alarm 234 rnA (All LEOs ON); (2.81 mA per LED)
SO-Indicator Module In addition, each MPIM draws: Normal 19 mA,
Assembly No. 976136 (with 1 MPIM) Alarm 24 mA
Assembly No. 976137 (with 2 MPIMs) Dimensions (wid): Assembly, 19.5 x 5.25 x 1.25 inches;
Board, 17.25 X 5 X 1 inches;
Assembly No. 976138 (without MPIM)
Mounting Plate/Display, 19.5 X 5.25 X 0.2 inches
PCB PIN 900965
Installation:
Publication Number 19700366 1. If 80-lndicator Module is not already assembled, Attach the
Issue 3, January 1997 circuit board to the display/backing plate.
a. Fit six threaded 6-32 X 3/8-inch nylon space to the threaded
The 80-lndicator Module is used in the TFX-500M/800M fire post on the display/mounting plate.
control system, to provide individual address point Alarm and b. Fit the 80-lndicator circuit board to the threaded posts.
Trouble status. The 80-lndicator Module provides 80 bi-color LED c. Install six 6-32 nuts to secure the circuit board.
individual address output points. 2. Mount 80-lndicator Module to panel door with 4 10-32
mounting screws.
The 80-lndicator Module is driven from the control panel or display 3. Mount MPIM piggy-back to aO-lndicator Module using stand-
panel via MPIM Expansion Bus. offs and screws.
Operation 4. Connect the ribbon cables and make other wiring connections.
5. Make Zone LD. strips and insert into siots at the back of the
Bi-color (red/yellow) LEOs light for programmed event, zone, display apnel and backing plate. Align the strips so that zone
sector, or other reference point. They may be programmed as labels are visible from panel front and correspond to correct
normally-off or normally-on, and with pulse patterns. indicators.
Press Lamp Test touch-button to light programmed LEOs. 6. Apply system power and push Lamp Test touch-button to test
indicator LEOs.
(a)
ZONE ID.
STRIP
LED INDICATOR
(BICOLOR)
LAMP TEST
TOUCH-
BUTTON
G ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ E:3~ ~
~
~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~
~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~
0::: ~
0::: ~ ~ ~
:::0 ~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
POWER BUS IN
~ 900965 ~ ~ ~
~
~ ~ ~
~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~
0= 0= =0
POWER BUS OUT
~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~
~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~
~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~
~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~
~
~
~
~
~
,..........,. .
~
~
~
o
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
MOUNTING SCREW
POST WITH 6-32 NUT
6-32 THREADED NYLON
(c) SPACER 3/B INCH MPIM PIN 940502
MOUNTING BO-INDICATOR CIRCUIT
6-32 THREADED NYLON
SCREW BOARD PIN 900965 "'" SPACER 3/B INCH
10-32
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 39
TO MPIM PL9
G.P. liP 1
,=: DS1
TO RIBBON CABLE
TO DISPLAY
, -, POWER BUS IN
-PL10
-,
I _J 1
-, POWER BUS
DS80 ,=: r-:-;,~~:":':".,::.;;:.:~~:":':".,
.., 1 I_J
PL5 ,_E;'L 11
( ...............'. 11 OUT
16 PIN
16 PIN EXPANSION BUS IN
EXPANSION BUS IN
(ADDRESSES 1-80 YELLOW)
(ADDRESSES 1-80 RED)
Figure 2. 80-lndicator Module. All circuits and connections are power Iimited/Class2.
There are some limitations in how the output points are configured.
All points are not completely independent of each other. Please
refertoAutocall TFX-500/800 CONSYS Programming Guide PIN
850463 for more information.
1. One MPIM may be used to configure 80 Expansion Bus I/O
point addresses 1-80. Suggestion: use one MPIM to drive
LEOs 1-80 Red LEOs configured as Zonal Alarm, and a
second MPIM to drive LEOs 1-80 Yellow LEOs configured as
Zonal Trouble or Supervisory.
2. Program the MPIM "General Purpose Input 1" as an "Input
(Norm. Hi)," and configured in the Special Input group IS053
"Dual Lamp Test Button."
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 40
80 Indicator 80 Indicator 80 Indicator 80 Indicator 80 Indicator
ColumnA Column B Column C Column D Column E
Panel # Panel # Panel # Panel # Panel #
.- .- .-
,- ,- 1-
.- 1-
,- .- .- .- ,-
.- .- ,- .-
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 42
Module Position: _ _ _ _ __
(See System Layout)
One 19.S-inch door position
Input Voltage: +5 VDC, + 12 VDC
AUTOCALL Current Draw: Normal (no LEOs lighted) 8 rnA;
Alarm (all LEOs lighted) 96 rnA; (1.1 mA per LED)
40 x 2-lndicator Module In addition, each MPIM draws: Normal 19 rnA,
Assembly No. 976130 (with MPIM) Alarm 24 rnA
Assembly No. 976131 (without MPIM) Dimensions (wid): Assembly, 19.5 X 5.2S X 1 inches;
Board:17.25 X S X 1 inches;
PCB PIN 900966 Display/Mounting plate: 19.5 X S.25 X 0.2 inches
Publication Number 19700365
Installation:
Issue 2, January 1997
1. If 40 x 2-lndicator Module is not already assembled, Attach the
circuit board to the display/backing plate.
The 40 x 2-lndicator Module is used in the Autocall a. Fit six threaded 6-32 X 3/B-inch nylon space to the threaded
TFX-SOOM/800M fire control system for individual address point post on the display/mounting plate.
annunciation. The 40 x 2-lndicator Module provides 80 pluggable b. Fit the 40 x 2-lndicator circuit board to the threaded posts.
LEOs for system alarm, trouble, supervisory, or other indication for c. Install six 6-32 nuts to secure the circuit board.
zones, sectors, points, or other programmed operation. 2. Mount 40 x 2-lndicator Module to panel door with 4 10-32
The 40 x 2-lndicator Module is driven from the TFX-SOOM/800M mounting screws.
control panel or display panel via MPIM Expansion Bus. 3. Mount MPIM piggy-back to 40 x 2-lndicator Module using
stand-ofts and screws.
Operation 4. Connect the ribbon cables and make other wiring connections.
Pluggable LEOs may be programmed for operation as zone, 5. Make Zone 1.0. strips and insert into slots so that zone labels
sector, point, or other indication. Operation may be activated by are visible from panel front.
alarm, trouble, supervisory, or other event. 6. Apply system power and push Lamp Test touch-button to test
indicator LEOs.
Press Lamp Test touch-button to turn on LEOs in sequence
(un-programmed LEOs will not light).
(a)
LED INDICAT
II~
181
1181
IU~
II~ II~
II~ II~
I~
II~
II~
II~
II~
II~
II~
1181
II~
I~
1181
1181
IUI3
IU"
IU"
ZONE I.D. STRIP
~ ~ ~
40 x :;Wndicatar
~
~
~
0:: 0
BOAf)p PIN 9Q0966 ~ ~ ~ ~ ~
~ ~ ~ ~ ~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
B 6-32 NUT
~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~
0 0
~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ ~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~ 0:: ~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
:: 0
I ................. :
0
0
(c) ~ MOUNTING SCREW
40 x 2-INDICATOR CIRCUIT 6-32 THREADED NYLON MPIM PIN 940502 POST WITH 6-32 NUT
MOUNTING BOARD PIN 900966 ~ SPACER 3/8 INCH 6-32 THREADED NYLON
SCREW 10-32 SPACER 3/8 INCH
Figure 1. 40 X 2-lndieator Module. (a) Front view, (b) Back view, (e) Side view.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 43
TO MPIM GENERAL
PURPOSE INPUT 1
t::ZJ 1
PL9
~ OS37 ~ OS33 OS29 =:; 0825 ~ OS21 .=:; OS17 OS13 .::: OS9 .=:; OS5 .::: OS1
~ OS77 ~ OS73 ~ OS69 ~ OS65 ~ OS61 .=:; OS57 ~ OS53 .::: OS49 .=:; OS45 .::: OS41
OS38 .~ OS34 OS30 -, OS26 OS22 OS18 OS14 .::: OS10 OS6 .::: OS2
LAMP TEST
~ OS78 ~ OS74 ~ OS70 ~ OS66 ~ OS62 .=:; OS58 ~ OS54 ::: OS50 ~ OS46 .::: OS42
~ OS39 ~ OS35 ~ OS31 ~ OS27 .=:; OS23 .=:; OS19 ~ OS15 ::: OS11 ~ OS7 .::: OS3
~ OS79 ~ OS75 ~ OS71 ~ OS67 .= OS63 .= OS59 ~ OS55 .= OS51 ~ OS47 = OS43pL1 0r:1 POWER BUS IN
~ OS40 ~ OS36 ~ OS32 =:; OS28 .=:; OS24 .=:; OS20 .=:; OS16 ~ OS12 ~ OS8 .::: OS4 1tJ
~ OS80 ~ OS76 ~ OS72 ~ OS68 ~ OS64 ~ OS60 ~ OS56 ~ OS52 ~ OS48 .::: OS4~L11 r:1
POWER BUS
PL5 I ................ I IJ OUT
16P.r 1
L EXPANSION BUS IN
RIBBON CABLE TO MPIM
Figure 2. 40 x 2-lndicator Module. All circuits and connections are power limited/Class2.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 44
,------, ,------, ,------,
140 x 2 Indicator I
,------, 1I 40Column
x 21ndicator I
I 40 x 2 Indicator I I 40 x 2 Indicator I 140 x 2 Indicator I
I ColumnA I I Column 8 I I Column C I I Column D I E I
I Panel # I I Panel # I I Panel # I I Panel # I I Panel # I
I I I I I I I I I I
I I I I I I I I I I
I I I I I I I I I I
I I I I I I I I I I
I I I I I I I I I I
I- I I- I I- I I- I I- I
I I I I I I I I I I
I I I I I I I I I I
I- I I- I I- I I- I- I
I I I I I I I I
I I I I I I I I
I I I I I I I I
I- I I- I I- I I- I-
I I I I I I I
I I I I I I I
I- I I I- I I- I-
I I I I I I I
I I I I I I I
I I I I I I I
I- I I I- I I- I-
I I I I I I I
I I I I- I I I
I I I I I I I
I I I I I I I
I I I I I I I
I I I I I I I
I- I I I- I I- I-
I I I I I I I
I- I I- I I- I I- I-
IL _ _ _ _ _ _ -.II IL _ _ _ _ _ _ -.I I I I IL _ _ _ _ _ _ -.I IL _ _ _ _ _ _ -.I
L _ _ _ _ _ _ -'
r------------,
LFigure 3.
Zone 10 Labels. .J
------------
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 45
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience
installing and testing fire detection systems. These instructions do not
purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment described.
Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection
with installation, operation, or maintenance. All specifications are
subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems
arise which are not covered sufficiently for the user's purposes, the
matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company
Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 46
Module Position: _ _ _ _ __
(See System Layout)
One 19.5-inch door position
Input Voltage: +5 VDC, + 12 VDC
AUTOCALL Current Draw: Normal (no LEDs lighted) 7 mA;
Alarm (all LEDs ON) 25 mA (1.1 mA per LED)
16-Status Control Module In addition, each MPIM draws: Normal 19 mA,
Assembly No. 976134 (with MPIM), Alarm 24 mA
Assembly No. 976135 (without MPIM) Dimensions (wid): Assembly, 19.5 X 5.25 X 1.25 inches
Board: 17.25 X 5 X 1 inches
Publication Number 19700363 Display/Mounting plate: 19 X 5.25 X 0.2 inches
Issue 2, January 1997
Installation:
The 16-Status Control module is used in the Autocall 1. If 16-Status Control Module is not already assembled, Attach
TFX-500M/BOOM fire control system, to provide 16 touch-button the circuit board to the display/backing plate.
switches and 16 separately programmable indicating LEDs. The a. Fit six threaded 6-32 X 3/B-inch nylon space to the threaded
LEDs are removable for easy selection of LED color. post on the display/mounting plate.
The 16-Status Control Module is driven from the TFX-500M/BOOM b. Fit the BO-Indicator circuit board to the threaded posts.
control panel or display panel via MPIM Expansion Bus. c. Install six 6-32 nuts to secure the circuit board.
2. Mount 16-Status Control Module to panel door with 4 10-32
Operation: mounting screws.
The touch-button switches may control output devices or select 3. Optional MPIM mounts piggy-back to 16-Status Control
control options in the TFX-500M/BOOM system. The LEDs indicate Module using stand-ofts and screws.
the status for system output devices or control options. The 4. Connect the ribbon cables and make other wiring connections.
switches and LEDs can be programmed independentiy (there is 5. Make Zone i.D. strips and insert into siots in the back of the
no pre-defined switch to LED association) using CONSYS. indicator panel and backing plate. Align ID labels so that zone
labels are visible from panel front.
Press Lamp Test touch-button to iight programmed LEOs in 6. Apply system power and push Lamp Test touch-button to test
sequence. indicator LEDs.
(a)
ZONE 1.0. STRIP
LED
INDICATOR
STATUS CONTROL
TOUCH-BUTTON
LAMP TEST
TOUCH-BUTTON
01 01 01 01
01 01 01 01 POWER BUS IN
PL24
PL5
1
1 ... .. ...... 1
16-PIN EXPANSION BUS 16-PIN CONNECTOR
NOTE 5 EXPANSION BUS IN
LEOS DS1-DS16 = XBUS ADDRESSES 1-16, SWITCHES
SW1-SW16 = XBUS ADDRESSES 17-32
OR
LEOS DS1-DS16 = XBUS ADDRESSES 33-48,
SWITCHES S\'Nl-SWI6 = XBUS ADDRESSES 49-64.
Figure 2. 16-Status Control Module. All circuits and connections are power IimitedjClass2.
PL5 16 Pin Expansion Bus In MPIM Expansion DS5 5 (37) SW5 21 (53)
Bus DS6 6 (38) SW6 22 (54)
PL24 16 Pin Expansion Bus MPIM Expansion DS7 7 (39) SW7 23 (55)
pass-through Bus
DS8 8 (40) SW8 24 (56)
PL14 16 Pin Expansion Bus MPIM Expansion
pass-through Bus DS9 9 (41) SW9 25 (57)
PL10 PL1 0-1 DCC Power Bus IN DS10 10 (42) SW10 26 (58)
PL 10-2 +5VDC
PL10-3 +5VDC DS11 11 (43) SW11 27 (59)
PL10-4 DCC
I I I I I uv
nC-i""l
IC- 12 (44) SV'.J12 28 (60)
I
PL 11 PL 11-1 DCC Power Bus OUT
3213 13 (45) SW13 29 (61)
PL11-2 +5VDC
PL 11-3 +5VDC DS14 14 (46) SW14 30 (62)
PL 11-4 DCC
DS15 15 (47) SW15 31 (63)
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 49
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience installing and testing fire detection
systems. These instructions do not purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment
described. Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection with installation,
operation, or maintenance. All specifications are subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems arise which are not covered
sufficiently for the user's purposes, the matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems
Company, Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 50
Module Position: _ _ _ _ __
(See System Layout)
One 19.5-inch door position
Input Voltage: +5 VDC, + 12 VDC
AUTOCALL Current Draw: Without MPIM-Normal (no LEDs lighted) 7 rnA;
Alarm 51 mA (1.1 mA per LED)
40-Status Control Module In addition, each MPIM draws: Normal 19 mA,
Assembly No. 976132 (with MPIM), Alarm 24 mA
Assembly No. 976133 (without MPIM) Dimensions (wid): Assembly, 19.5 x 5.25 X 1.25 inches
Board: 17.25 X 5 X 1 inches
PCB No. 900968 Display/Mounting plate: 19 X 5.25 X 0.2 inches
Publication Number 19700364
Installation:
Issue 2, January 1997
1. If 40-Status Control Module is not already assembled, Attach
The 40-Status Control module is used in the Autocall the circuit board to the display/backing plate.
TFX-500M/800M fire control system, to provide individual address a. Fit six threaded 6-32 X 3/8-inch nylon space to the threaded
point status and control. post on the display/mounting plate.
b. Fit the 40-Status Control circuit board to the threaded posts.
The 40-Status Control Module is driven from the TFX-500M/800M c. Install six 6-32 nuts to secure the circuit board.
control panel or display panel via MPIM Expansion Bus. 2. Mount 40-Status Control Module to panel door with 4 10-32
Operation: mounting screws.
3. Optional MPIM mounts piggy-back to 40-Status Control
The touch-button switches may be prgrammed using CONSYSto Module using stand-ofts and screws.
control output devices or select control options in the 4. Connect the ribbon cables and make other wiring connections.
TFX-500M/800M
------,------ svstem.
-,;------- The
---- LEOs
- - - - mav
-----,; be
- - oroorammed to
r--.:r----------
5. rviake Zone LD. strips and insert into siots on the back side of
provide indicators of the status for system output devices or control the panel and backing plate. Align the strip so that zone labels
options. The switches and LEOs can be programmed independent- are visible from panel front and line up with correct zone.
ly (there is no pre-defined switch to LED association).
LAMP
TEST
PUSH
L-~~_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _~
BunON --+---1
40-STATUS CONTROL DISPLAY PANEL/BACKING PLATE
(b)
o
~ OJ OJ []
o
~
OJ OJ OJ OJ [] 0
~
OJ OJ
OJ
OJ
OJ
OJ
OJ
[]
[] o
OJ OJ OJ OJ [] 0
OJ []
o OJ []
OJ
40-Status CONTROL BOARD PIN 900968 ............... I~
o o o
o
MOUNTING SCREW
(c) 6-32 THREADED NYLON POST WITH 6-32 NUT
40-STATUS CONTROL CIR- SPACER 3/8 INCH
CUlT BOARD PIN 900968 " 6-32 THREADED NYLON
SPACER 3/8 INCH
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 51
LAMP TEST RIBBON CABLE
RIBBON CABLE TO MPIM GENERAL TO FRONT PANEL
TO FRONT PANEL PURPOSE INPUT 1 DISPLAY(TOUCH-
DISPLAY(TOUCH- KEYPAD
BLACK RED
KEYPAD
PL30
40-STATUS CONTROL MODULE PCB NO. 900968 PL9
1 ~~I/ 14PIN
SW31[J] OS31 SW25[J] OS25 SW19[J] OS19 SW13[J] OS13 SW7 [J] OS7 SW1 [J] OS1 Pl2 =:
\
I' ~::' 1 SW37 [J] OS37 SW32[J] OS32 SW26[J] OS26 SW20[J] OS20 SW14[J] OS14 SW8 [J] OS8 SW2[J] OS2
SW38 [J] OS38 SW33[J] OS33 SW27[J] OS27 SW21 [ ] OS21 SW15[J] OS15 SW9 [J] OS9 SW3[J] OS3 0 PL10 ~~~I~
SW34[J] OS34 SW22[J] OS22 SW16[J] OS16 ~
l
SW28[J] OS28 SWH[J] OS10 SW4[J] OS4 1
SW39 [J] OS39 SW35r;). SW29[J] OS29 SW23[J1 OS23 SW17[J1 OS17
L:.I OS35 SW11[J] OS11 SW5[] OS5 PL1 16 PIN
Figure 2. 40-Status Control Module. All circuits and connections are power Iimited/Class2. ~~~p~~(TOUCH-
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 52
40 Status 40 Status 40 Status
ColumnA Column B Column C
Panel # Panel # Panel #
40 Status
Column G
Panel #
,-
i _
,- ,-
1-
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 54
Module Position: _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(See System Layout)
Space Requirement: One B1 or BPI, Main Processor Board
position
AUTOCALL Dimensions (Iwd): 10.S x 6.3 x 2.S inches
MP-500 Main Processor Board Electrical Specifications
PCB No. 940500 Input Voltage 24 VOC
+26 Voc@200mA
The MP-SOO Main Processor (MP) board is required for all Current Draws
AUTO CALL TFX-SOO/SOOM and TFX-800/800M systems. It is the
Standby Alarm
signal processing unit forthe system. All alarm, trouble, and system
supervisory signals are sent to the MP. From +5 VOC 200 mA 420 mA
Install in accordance with NFPA 70, National Electrical Code; From 26Voc
Board 16mA 16mA
NFPA 72, Installation, Maintenance, and Use of Protective Each data Circuit (TFXSOOISOOM) SmA 4mA
Signaling Systems.
From 24 VOC (Common Alarm Sdr Circuits) 1 A max 1 A max
The Main Processor EEPROM must be programmed with
site-specific configuration data. Only Grinnell authorized
ft_ .... +._; .. ft..a _80."' __ ".1"'1.1 ...... _u ....."'ft ..a .... fhft
a i n.. i.ia.liw... joi'vivViili;r;;;;;; ;;;;;,;.y rilV::;;;;;;iliil iiil'W
AIITnt"AI I
6"'ii.W i ...........Fi. _ _
Remote Bus communication (RS48S) connects remote
~~.;~I..~.~I "I~,,;~~~
tJ;:;1 itJi i;:;1 Cii U;;:;Vj\.r'\JU.
Two common alarm indicating circuits (SDR "A" and SDR Occupied Premises Input provides for programming the
system to respond differently depending upon whether the
"B") are activated to signal Alarm and Fire Drill.
premises are occupied or not.
Two Local Bus ports provide for serial communication to
Multi-Purpose Interface Modules (MPIMs) and for Electrical supervision is provided to NFPA 72 standards.
connection to the Expansion Motherboard (in AUTOCALL
TFX-800/800M applications only).
o ,..-PL6
~ ~ l.-'.J T
I;"rl.:: ~ H4
lJ m
INPUT POWER ;
CONNECTORS ~ ~
PL5 +5VLlNK
TB2
MICROPROCESSOR
CO~~~~
SDR. B ~ ~ 20 H2
PL11 [QQJ
SIGNALLING SDR A :;: (9 119
78
CIRCUITS . NIC ~ 16 SPECIAL
ALARM { COM (9 15 TEST
ALARM/FAULT (9 jtg 14 IC-5
RELAY CONTACTS FAULT { COM ~ 1~ MP-500
+~~~ ~ 11 PIN 940500
ov 0 ~o
:;:~~ ~ ~
:;:~t ~ ~
LOOP B'
MULTIPLEX
COMMUNICATIONS +~~ ~ 4
LOOP A -AL (9 ~ JUMPER IN
+:L (9
&B-
1
PL 10
~. 8
Z
po;;W~~\c;;;;[Q]
H3
MICROPROCESSOR
zc~~
001 ...... ~
-'- RUN LED
i:i 00 H6 : 0 PROCESSOR
TB1 Q OK PL4
FAULT LOOP { FAULT [[](9
is)
4-
3+ ~Ij::0 0 1 ~
INPUT TAMPER 0 t+ ~
OCCUPIED
PREMISES [[] t+ ROM CONFIG
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 55
INPUT POWER
CONNECTORS NOTE 20 NOTE 19
:;:tTE 4)
/ /
bf ~ !F SUPERVISED
CIRCUIT
STYLE *
+fF- , H4
,- - (SEE TABLE 1)
UL LlSTED3~OL ALARM SIGNAL DEVICES
c~oom '-------j~,,~--+-__t~{S)
T62
20 - }
+5V LINK
H2
,-----+-+--t---fINX 19 + SDR. B ~
,------t-+--+---lINX 1R - "'\ (NOTE 5) PL11 00
IX 1; + jSDRA NOTE 4 SPECIAL
v
(~ :: ~~M {'~"M
TEST
(
tSHIELD i
I If 0
.-++----++--------.1 I NOTE 6 .I~ ~ ~~ ~~M
' - 6) 11 NIO
JF,',ULT
PIN 940500
\\
\\
v
\\
\\
.... III A
NOTE 7
6)
{ 61
10 +24V
9 OV
8
7 +BR
-BR
MULTIPLEX
COMMUNICATIONS
MICROPROCESSOR
LOOP DEVICE 6 -BL
LOOP '6'
+ - 5 +BL
(NOTE 8)
4 -AR
NOTE 8 3 +AR MULTIPLEX
..ISHIELD
.---+--__t-+---+-__tIC'r..,;} 2 -AL COMMUNICATIONS
r-I---Iyr+--+-.---+p~N10 ~
II
II
II
II
v SUPERVISED
c ~
e-e
1 +AL
NOTE 18
0 LO}OP'A'
~
~
JUM,pp~~~' !A'J,t~ I
POSITION ,,', .
CIRCUIT ~(f) ~IOOI H6 ~ : -;; NOTE 23 NOTE 13
\\ \\ STYLE * I
\\ \ \
(SEE TABLE 1) 00 NOTE 14 ~ PROCESSOR
PL4
v v ~ ~ 0 OK
rH-I-h L'--..A-.,A-'A--+---I{'X~
It2> ~ I
14 :
4 - FAULTJ@MICROPROCESSOR
LOOP DEVICE VVy ,~3 + NOTE 9 RUN LED (NOTE 21) : 5
~
6)
:~ ~
SHIELD UL LISTED 2 - TAMPER
+ - 10KOHM ~ 1+
TFX-500/500M
TODCC
OCCUPIED -[[12-
:r-?
NC E 1,
(j)
PL7 L.c- ~ :
CONNECTION TO 150 OHM
I , 1 1 ;L1
REMOTE UNIT UL LISTED EOL \ '--.
_____________ ~RE~M~O~T~E~N~E~TW~O~RK~~~~'TE~R~F~A~CE~-~'----.~
WHEN REQUIRED PIN 976064 SUPERVISED EEPROM _ / '\.
_/ '- NOTE 16
NOTE 15
Figure 2. Typical circuits, Main Processor Board, PIN 940500. All circuits and connections are power limited/Class 2.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 56
Table 1. TFX-500/BOO, TFX-500M/BOOM Main Processor Board 8. TFX-500/500M application ONLY-Two multiplex communica-
Circuit Characteristics (all circuits are power limited/Class 2). tions circuits (Loop "A" and Loop "B"): Maximum line resistance
is 75 ohms; maximum line capacitance is 0.5 microfarad
I Circuit Current Voltage Circuit supervision (mutual); maximum line inductance is 1.5 millihenry (total);
Rating Rating Style
maximum continuous distance is 6500 feet. Use UL listed,
Common Alarm 1 A max 24 Voc Style Y YES (E.O.L) shielded wire pair that allows for these parameters. Connect
Sounders AlB the shield to the common shield connection point that is
connected to DC Common of the main power supply.
Multiplex 2way data 1Amax 24 Voc Style' YES
circuits AlB 9. Fault inputs.
maximum dislance a. Optional fault loop input (TB1-3/TB1-4) may be connected
6500 It (TFX-500 only) to digital dialer communications fault output. When this input
Remote Bus (RS485) YES
is not used, UL listed 1O-k ohm resistor must be installed
maximum distance across TB1-3 and TB1-4.
4000 It b. Ground Fault (" Tamper") loop (TBH/TB1-2) may be used
YES
to receive input from a ground fault detection signalling
Local Bus (data
communications) point.
10. Occupied Premises Input (TB4-1/TB4-2) may be connected to
Voltfree relay (alarm) 1Amax 24 Voc Coil supervised, output not an "occupied premises" input device.
supervised
11. Remote Bus usually connects to Remote Ops/Dis panel
Voltfree relay (fault) 1 A max 24Voc Coil supervised, output not terminal block (see Publication Number 19700257 or
supervised 19700258). Install UL listed, 150 ohm end-of-line resistor (P/N
976064) across TB3-3 to TB3-4. Remote Bus wiring parame-
Fault loop TB13/TB1-4 5mA 24 VDC YES (E.O.L. 10 kohm)
ters; 100 ohms total maximum line resistance, 30
Tamper/GF YES picofarad-per-foot (mutual) maximum capacitance, 4000 feet
f----. _.-
.. maximum distance. Use shielded, twisted pair wiring that
Occupied Premises NO
I meets these parameters. Connect the sheilds to a common
24 VDC Output 1A 24 VDC NO point connected to DC Common on the main power supply.
12. Header H1 , Remote Bus Master, is configured for jumpers 1-2
AC/DC Power PL5 YES and 3-4 to be installed for TFX-500/800 and TFX-500M/BOOM.
*Complies with operation characteristics for NFPA Style 6. Complies with 13. Header H3, EEPROM Programming Header, should be
operation characteristics for NFPA Style 7 when a line isolater (CAA-500Ll) configured as follows:
is connected adjacent to and via conduit, to the input and output of each a. No jumper link installed for normal operation.
addressable device. b. Jumper link installed only during EEPROM programming.
Notes: 14. H6, "Earth Links," provides a short to earth ground. It is used
1. All references below refer to both AUTOCALL TFX-500/500M when the "Ground Fault Detection" option is not used. Set
and AUTOCALL TFX-800/800M applications unless explicitly jumper links as follows:
stated otherwise. a. Ground Fault Detection enabled-No jumper links (default).
2. All conductors must be free of grounds. b. Install jumper 1-2 and 3-4 for ground fault selection disable.
3. Disconnect power before serviCing system. 15. EEPROM must be installed and programmed for normal
4. (a) Input power connections (UL listed regulated 24 V power operation.
limited)-Using cable PIN 19600206 connect JP1 of the 16. Remote network interface, PL7, accommodates network and
RPS-424 Power Supply/Battery Charger (P/N 976957) to PL5 offsite communications modules.
(see Publication Number 19700323). Connect cable PIN 17. Local Bus connection PL 1 and PL4 connect to MPIM (P/N
19600190 from PL5 of the Main Processor Board. Terminal 940502) Local Bus connectors. See Publication 19700235. For
PL5-6 is not used. Power to the Main Processor Board may be TFX-BOO/BOOM, Local Bus connection to PL7 of Expansion
removed by disconnecting the connection to PL5 (Caution: Motherboard. See Publication number 19700277, ''AUTO-
this does not disconnect AC to the RPS-424). CALL lAM-BOO Expansion Motherboard" PIN 940562.
(b) PL6 is not used. 1B. PL 10, "Earth Ground" tab is the earth ground connection point
(c) PL 11 is not used. for add-on boards.
5. Supervised common alarm indicating circuits, "SDR A" and 19. Header H2, Test--No jumper installed for normal operation.
"SDR B," are rated at 1A maximum. UL listed end-of-line device 20. Header H4, Test +5 V Isolate--Jumper link 1-2 and link 3-4 are
PIN 900937 must be connected across terminals when circuits installed for normal operation.
are not connected. EOL must be connected to last device in the 21. "Microprocessor OK," green LED--"ON" indicates normal
circuit. All indicating appliances must have EMI suppression microprocessor operation.
installed. 22. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA
6. Four volt-free relay outputs are rated at 1A maximum, and are 70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable
to be connected to UL 864 listed power limited sources only. notes. All circuits contained in this module are classified as
(a) "Alarm" relay contacts are normally-open (N.O.) or power limited and shall be installed to comply with N.E.C.
normally-closed (N.C.) Article 760, Part A and Part C.
(b) "Fauit" reiay contacts (N.O. and N.C.) 23. Con 10 and Con 11 are not used. Jumpsis ai6 factory installed
7. Terminals TB2-9 (0 V) and TB2-1 0 (24 V) provide supervised on positions 1-2 and 4-5 for normal operation.
24 VDC for powering peripheral devices.
506SDA 900989 976378 0.35 mA 99 TB2-10 +24 VDC PL6-2 + 24 VDC (Not Used)
OXA-504SDA 940574 976216 0.18 mA 99 TB2-11 Fault Relay N.O. PL10 Earth Ground Tap
*Not addressable
**Not addressable, does not connect directly to 2-way data circuit; requires input This document is written for skilled technicians with experience
from OXA-500SD
installing and testing fire detection systems. These instructions do not
purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment described.
Detector Model, Part Standby Current Base Model, Part No. Max. No. per Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection
No. (Head + Base) data circuit with installation, operation, or maintenance. All specifications are
ISA-412P 940518 0.22mA IBN-512A 940522 99 subject to change without notice.
IHN-135920097 0.25 mA 99
IHN-135920097 0.33 mA 99
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 58
Module Position: - : 7 " - - - - - - - - - - -
(See System Layout)
Space Requirement: Power Supply location
Input Voltage: 120/240 VRMS, 50/60 Hz (Auto-ranging)
AUTOCALL Input Current: 1.5ARMS
Output Voltage: 24Voc regulated (+10% / -5%)
RPS-424 Power Supply/Battery Battery Charging Capacity: 5 to 85 Ah
Charger Battery Charging Voltage: 27.6 Voc
Battery Charging Current: 2.5 A Max
PIN 900957 Assembly No. 910683 Regulated Panel Circuits (For panel only; power limited/ Class 2):
One +24 Voc circuit at 4 A - Non-resettable
Publication Number 19700323 One +24 Voc circuit at 2 A - Resettable
Issue 3, January 1997 One +15 Voc output at 100 mA
5 Voc@4A
The AUTOCALL RPS424 Power Supply is a regulated 24 Voc 4 Regulated Output Circuits (For field connections only; power
amp, isolated switching power supply that can operate from limited/Class 2): Two +24 V oc , each rated
120-240VAC 50/60Hz. The RPS-424 power supply provides at 2 A (one resettable)
power for a wide range of AUTOCALL fire and access control Total current limited to: 2.5 A (standby), 5 A (alarm)
system devices. This supply can be used as the primary power Maximum Ripple voltage: maximum 2% of output Voc
supply or as an auxiliary power supply. Current Draw: 100 mA standby; 100 mA Alarm
Dimensions (Iwh): 4.5 x 7.5 x 2 inches
Features o
z
Brownout or loss of AC power causes immediate (9
)(
,
Battery fault sensing circuit monitors battery charging
(
,c
voltage for low battery voltage, missing or reverse battery
(
, C=::=:~) cC::===:=;l
and shorted battery wire. Also has battery charge current
limiting.
c
C , c:::=: ) (
~)C
C )
)
Resettable +24 Voc circuit-The resettable 24 Voc output c: ) C::==:::::J) ( )
will remain at its regulated voltage when system RESET
, c ~~~~)
,~
( )
input is high (open). When RESET is held low, the
resettable 24 Voc output is pulled down and power removed c ) C
(
)
from peripheral devices. C ) C ) ( )
The RPS-424 may be used as an auxiliary power supply. C:::=:~)
C c::c: ===:=;l
Meets FCC Class "An emission standards.
Power limited/Class 2 24Voc outputs. C:::=:~) c::c: ===:=;l
GROUND
Supplies panel power-regulated 5V oc @ 4amps. DETECT
RESISTOR TB4 TB3 1 J1
leH~ID
(SEE NOTE B)
Install in accordance with NFPA 72, Installation, Maintenance, and 000001
100000
use of Protective Signaling Systems; NFPA 70, National Electrical 0 1 0
Code.
REMOTE
RESET
WARNING: Electrical Hazard! Panel contains high (SEE NOTE 10)
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 59
Installation-Auxiliary Supply (See Figure 3) Notes:
1. Remove AC power and disconnect battery. 1. All wiring to be in accordance with N.E.C. Article 760 (National
2. Remove metal cover. Electrical Code), local authorities, and applicable notes.
3. Mount auxiliary power supply to top left-hand option module 2. Designated circuits and connections are power limited/Class
position using appropriate mounting hardware. 2 and must be installed to comply with N.E.C. Article 760, Part
4. Connect AC wiring to TB1. See Figure 1. A and Part C.
3. Auxiliary Power Supply Wiring: 3. Supply side wiring per N.E.C. Article 760. AC input L1 and L2
a. 1 6 AWG wire between TB 1-1 of primary power supply and are interchangeable.
TB 1-1 of the auxiliary supply. 4. Connect DC Common (0 Voc) to DC Common (0 Voc) of the
b. 16 AWG wire between TB1-2 of primary power supply and AC Power Module at the main control panel. Maximum ripple
TB1-2 of the auxiliary supply. voltage less than 2% of output.
c. 16 AWG wire between TB1-3 of primary power supply and 5. Caution: To avoid possible electrical shock, disconnect
TB1-3 of the auxiliary supply. power before removing cover.
d. Connect earth ground to TB1-2 of primary power supply. 6. Make sure that all power-limited wiring is separated at least
6. Replace metal cover on each power supply. 0.25 inch from any wiring that is not power limited. Use cable
7. Connect standby battery leads to auxiliary power supply board. ties to secure wiring. (See Figure 2)
TB4-1 (+) and TB4-2 (-). Observe proper polarity for correct 7. Make standby battery connections BATT -VE to negative
operation. battery terminal and BATT +VE to positive battery terminal.
Install Battery Fuse Assembly PIN 910691 between battery-1
Table 1 TB1 Connections, AC terminal (-) and batterv-2 terminal (+). Select the correct
battery capacity for the' syst~m u~ing 'th~ -Sia~dby Battery
Terminal Function
Capacity Table.
TB1-1 AC Line 1 (line or neutral) 8. When used as an auxiliary power supply, remove Ground
TB1-2 Earth Ground Detector Resistor. (See Figure 3)
TR1_q 9. When used with an auxiliary power supply, the reset line (T83)
! -Ar. I in",
~ ....... -"-"
? {Ii!",!'!
....... "'- '"~ ,- or
_. nell ,tr"!!\
, ............. - .....-,
of each supply should be connected together. (See Figure 3)
10. Non-supervised, power limited/Class 2 remote reset connec-
Table 2 TB2 Connections, Non-resettable 24Voc tion is normally high when function is not activated. Connect
Terminal normally-open switch to DC Common. Remote reset must be
Function
held closed for at least six seconds to activate reset.
TB2-1 +24 Voc 2A power limited/Class 2
TB2-2 DC Common
Table 5. J1 Connections
PIN FUNCTION
-1 +15 Voc
-2 Reset
-3 DC Common
-4 ACOK
-5 + 24Voc
-6 Ground Fault
-7 DC Common
I
BATTERY FUSE _ NONPOWER LIMITED
-8 Battery Monitor ASSEMBLY PIN 910691
-9 + 5V oc
-10 +24Voc Resettable Figure 2 Typical TFX cabinet wiring showing
separation of power limited/Class 2
wiring from non-power limited wiring.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 60
o o
Z Z
::J ::J
o o
a: a:
Cl Cl
AC INPUTS (AC L1, AND AC l2) :r:
ARE INTERCHANGEABLE ~ (SEE NOTES 1, 3,6)
Ec (SEE NOTES 1, 3, 6)
~ L5 ~ ~ L5 ~
120/240 VAC
INPUT
:;
:: C )C )C :;
) C .ow => = :, t :)
:; L~ c O)C--~=>
:= :)
:;
C
(.
)~,
c .,, C ,
)
,=
.,.5 (" ~)
- ::;,
;)
c-=__) ,
,: ::::> c ::; C
0) c:::~~~~
)
GROUND
c :: ,c C
,
.# C
C
:;
:;1
c :::> c=:=: --, ,~---~
---> DETECT c ;,
GROUND
DETECT =====') c=:=: LIMITEDPOWER
~
RESISTOR
(SEE NOTE B) :> c: LIMITED
-,
-'
(S~~~!i6?:8) --f====.'
,------,
TB4 , TB2 TB2 TB3
NONPOWER
LIMITED
D ~
(SEE NOTE 6)
NON,POWER
LIMITED
(SEE NOTE 6)
POWER
LIMITED/CLASS 2
WIRING
(SEE NOTES 2 & 6)
BATTERY FUSE
ASSEMBLY PIN 910691
III
~., ~'11
A-
RPS-424 POWER
I~
SUPPLIES
MOUNTED IN MODULE
POSITION 6
ACWIRING
NON-POWER LIMITED
BATTERY WIRING
NON-POWER LIMITED
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience installing and testing fire detection
systems. These instructions do not purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment
described. Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection with installation,
operation, or maintenance. All specifications are subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems arise which are not covered
sufficiently forthe user's purposes, the matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems
Company, Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 62
Module Position: -:-:-_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(See System Layout)
Space Requirement: Mounts to top cover of an RPS-424 Power
Supply/Battery Charger using power supply cover mounting holes;
AUTOCALL or, mounts to a sub-plate with similar hole spacing.
Power Monitor Normal Input: +24 VDC @ 62 mA (Battery Requirement)
500PSM TFX-Addressable Power Supply Monitor Regulated Output Circuits (Available from RPS-424 Power
PCB PIN 900960, Assembly No. 976122 Supply) :
+24 VDC circuit at 4 A
PSM Power Supply Monitor
+ 12 VDC output at 100 rnA
PCB PIN 900961, Assembly No. 976123 +5 VDC@4A
Maximum Ripple voltage: maximum 2% of output VDC
Publication Number 19700340
Issue 3, January 1995 Relay Contact Rating: 1 A @ 30 VDC resistive
Dimensions (Iwh): 415/16 x 21/4 x 1 inches
The PSM Power Supply Monitor Board (P/N 976123) allows the
RPS-424 Power Supply to be used with compatible AUTOCALL Table 1. LED Indicators
products by providing visual trouble indicators and field wiring
Normal
connections.
LED Function Condition
The 500PSM TFX-Addressable Power Supply Monitor (P/N DS1 Yellow o Volt Ground Fault OFF
976122) provides interface to the TFX data circuits for the RPS-424
DS2 Yellow AC Fault OFF
Power Supply/Battery Charger so that the RPS-424 can be
-r ......... r=nnnc-.I..t _ .......... :-1 ..... _ . DS3 Yellow OFF
_ .. __ .... : __ -l .............. ",L.. ......... ..J-J ............. _ ..... L..I ..... 1.......... _
i::JUpt:i Vi5t:iU UV\::I ii It: QUUI Ci~~CiUit: IUUfJ. i i it' ~UUluiVi pi UVIUt:!i) iUi
&.........
+VDC Ground Fau!t
an address on the TFX, TFX-M, TFX-MV, DirecTone 500 analog DS4 Yellow Battery Fault OFF
addressable loop. In some Remote Bus power applications it can DS5 Green DeOK ON
be used in place of a DC PM for power to an MPIM.
(a) (b) 8)
8 J1
J1
IXA-501 CM MODULE
WITH ADDRESS 00 00
INPUT POWER SUPPLY CON-
SWITCHES NECTOR TO RPS-424 USE
00 ./ INPUT POWER SUPPLY CON-
00 NECTOR TO RPS-424 USE
CABLE ASSEMBLY PIN CABLE ASSEMBLY PIN
19600199 00 19600199
~~
(1) 8 (1)
7 (1)
(1)
0 6
5 (1) T' DS4
TB1
5
(1)
( 4 (1)
<2> 500PSM PIN 976122 TFX
( o DS3 4
(1)
(1)
PSM PIN 976123 POWER
SUPPLY MONITOR
3
o 3
"~t
(1) ADDRESSABLE POWER (1)
-1
DS2
2 SUPPLY MONITOR 2 (1)
LEDS (1)
~
0DS1 1
~S024
_ K1 3 ~ TB2 NOT USED
2 ~
~)) 10
~
I Ip1
Figure 1 Power Supply Monitor Boards (a) 500PSM TFXAddressable Option Assemby No.976122, PIN 900960,
(b) PSM Power Supply Monitor Assembly No. 976123, PIN 900961.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 63
MOUNTING HOLES
a) 0)
(b) (2) PLACES
lXA-501 CM MO DULE
WITH ADD RES
SWITCHES S \ ~ J1
00
1~O INPUT POWER SUPPLY CON- 00
00
1\= 00
V NECTOR TO RPS-424 USE
CABLE ASSEMBLY PIN
INPUT POWER SUPPLY CON-
NECTOR TO RPS-424 USE
"""" 00 19600199 CABLE ASSEMBLY PIN
""""
;~
tEe 19600199
~ I, , +24v
7
0
I-o-----..J! +24V
~t
TB16 DC C
0 DCC
5 +12 v
0 TB1 FIELD ~ DS4 TB1 5 +12V
4 +5 v WIRING
{"i' m:ti]
I'
~"~{ o
I'
3 0 DC C DS3 4 +5V
S,
0 RE LAY N.O. DE-ENERGIZE DCC TB1 FIELD
LEDS o S 2 0 RE LAY N.C. DE-ENERGIZE 0. DS2
3
2 RELAY N.D. DE-ENERGIZE
RELAY N.C. DE-ENERGIZE
WIRING
RE LAY COM
DS1 1 RELAY COM
DATAOUT(+} }
d 5 ~ 3 @ DATAOUT (-) /"'\DS~2 4 @
--
1_'~3@ TB2 NOT USED
~i~~ l" 8~
DATAIN (+) \
~e>e>
2
: DATAIN (-)
18 :
MOUNTING I I P1
HOLES (2)
~14
1 TB2 TO TFX-500/800, 14 PIN CONNECTOR (TFX)
PLACES POWER FOR REMOTE BUS
TFX- 500M/800M 2-WAY 14
14 PIN CONNECTOR (TFX) - - " DATA CIRCUIT (ANALOG MPIM (PLl OR PL2)
POWER FOR REMOTE BUS ADDRESSABLE LOOP)
0!""" ' ~
~
MPIM (PL1 OR PL2) MOUNTING SCREW
(e) 4-40 (2)
~~ POWER MONITOR BOARD
Figure2 Power Supply Monitor Boards (a) 500PSM TFXAddressable Option Assemby No. 976122, PIN900960,
(b) PSM Power Supply Monitor Assembly No, 976123, PIN 900961, (e) Side view of mounting hardware.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 64
(a) PLASTIC STAND-OFF MOUNTING SCREW (b) ADDRESSABLE LOOP
(BELOW) POWER LIMITED
~~ ~ ~~~~ ~~ ':o~;"'!f
0::00
-, 00
00
~~
~[}
f--
..
..
gjCD-
f-- ..
0
~ \ MOUNTING SCREW
PLASTIC I
STAND-OFF (BELOW) RPS-424
POWER SUPPLY POWER LIMITED
BATTERY
CHARGER
ACINPU
NON-POWER LIMITED
============~I~
L':::II
Figure 3 Typical installation of Power Supply Monitor Board to top cover of RPS-424 Power Supply (a)
Mounting Power Monitor to RPS-424; (b) Wire routing for separation of power limited/Class 2 wiring from
non-power limited wiring in remote TFX cabinet on addressable loop.
Table 2. Terminal Block Connections Notes (See Figure 4):
1. All wiring to be in accordance with N.E.C. Article 760 (National
Terminal Function Electrical Code), local authorities, and applicable notes.
TB1-1 Relay Common 2. All circuits and connections to the Power Supply Monitor Board
TB1-2 Relay Normally Closed (De-Energized) are power limited and must be installed to comply with N.E.C.
Article 760, Part A and Part C.
TB1-3 Relay Normally Open (De-Energized)
3, Make sure that all power-limited wiring is separated at least
TB1-4 DCC 0.25 inch from any wiring that is not power limited. Use cable
TB1-5 +5 V ties to secure wiring.
TB1-6 +12 V 4. All conductors must be free of grounds.
5. Disconnect power before servicing systems.
TB1-7 DCC
6. Do not loop wires. Break wire run to provide supervision.
TB1-8 +24 V 7. Connect relays to UL listed power limited source suitable for
TB2-1 Data Circuit IN (-) fire protective signalling service.
TB2-2 Data Circuit IN (+) 8. Use appropriate UL listed end-of-line resistor as required by
TB2-3 Data Circuit OUT (-)
monitoring device.
9. The total load on the power supply 24 V outputs should not
TB2-4 Data Circuit OUT (+) exceed 2.5 A (standby) or 5 A (alarm).
500PSM Programming
high voltage! Disconnect electrical power before
, servicing. Electric shock could cause injury or death.
The 500PSM is programmed as an IXA-501 CM Mini Contact
Monitoring Module in CONSYS.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 6S
AUTOCALL
(a) TFX-500/800, TFX-500M/800M (b)
TFX-500MV/800MV, DirecTone 500
CONTROL 2-WAY DATA CIRCUIT TO RPS-424
UNIT ANALOG ADDRESSABLE LOOP POWER SUPPLY/
BATTERY CHARGER
+~------------------------~ ~------4
TO NEXT SUPERVISED
DEVICE POWER LIMITED
+ CLASS 2
ON
ADDRESS
?iuuul
1
SWITCHES
TO RPS-424
POWER SUPPLY/ SUPERVISED
BATTERY CHARGE POWER LIMITED
CLASS 2 SUPERVISED
TO RPS-424
POWER LIMITED
POWER SUPPLY/
CLASS 2
BATTERY CHARGER
TB1
POWER SUPPLY MONITOR BOARD
ASSEMLBY NO. 976123 '---H--' TB1
PIN 900961 ENERGIZED
POWER SUPPLY MONITOR BOARD
ASSEMLBY NO. 976123
L*-,
PIN 900961 ENERGIZED
Figure 4. Typical Wiring Diagram (a) 500PSM TFX addressable loop application. (b) 500PSM Local Bus TFX Configuration.
Other applications (c) PSM Alarm Configuration, (d) PSM Trouble Configuration.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 66
Module Position ---",...--_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(See System Layout)
Space Requirement: DCPM power module location
Input Voltage: 24 VDC (nominal)
AUTOCALL Output Circuits: Special bus application only (two outputs)
Supervisory Current Draw: 50 mA (unloaded)
DCPM DC Power Module Alarm Current Draw: 50 mA (unloaded)
Dimensions (Iwh): 3.6 x 5.4 x 2.1 inches
PCB PIN 940503 Assembly No. 976040
Publication Number 19700252
Issue 4, January 1997
DCPM
POWER MODULE OUTPUT CIRCUITS
PIN 940503 (NOT USED)
(NOTE 7)
TB2
Figure 1. DCPM DC to DC Converter Module PIN 940503. All circuits and connections are power limited/Class 2.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Paga67
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience installing and testing fire detection
systems. These instructions do not purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment
described. Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection with installation,
operation, or maintenance. All specifications are subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems arise which are not covered
sufficiently for the user's purposes, the matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems
Company, Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
TURN COUNTER-CLOCKWISE
.~ "~- .. ..
~ ~---,, .. ...
Tn It\Jt:RI=AC:::i= r:nNTQAC:::T
.,.. 1fl.Ir'lTI= 11:;\
''--';
\'~'-"'-
CONNECTION TO LCD
XBUS CONNECTOR, PINS 15 AND 16 NOTE 5, TABLE 2
(NOTE 13)
PL7 PL5
MPIM
JACK FOR RIBBON
PIN 940502 (f)
::J CABLE TO EXPANSION
JACK FOR CONNECTOR <D BUS MODULES - 16 PIN
TO TOUCHPAD/DISPLAY Z (WITHIN CABINET MAX. 2 FT)
(BELOW) (20 PIN) (NOTE 8)
o
POWER ~ (NOTE 8)
[G]!-=:::J-~
i'!i tt-+t--- POWER LED
(NOTE 6)
16
NOTE 4, TABLE 1 ~~~~APL~6F===+--------NOTE7
PL 9
~~~ fI
PL1 EOL 1200HM
14 U.L. LISTED PIN 976048
JACK FOR RIBBON CABLE LOCAL BUS
TO MAIN PROCESSOR OR (j) b..j ADDRESS
OTHER LOCAL BUS MODULE
(14 PI N) (NOTE 8)
i \\ I[J I ITI]
u
'-------------T-----------...1 0;
~ NOTE 5, TABLE 2
DETAIL SERIAL
PORT CONNECTOR
(NOTE 12)
Figure 1. Multi-Purpose Interface Module (MPIM) PIN 940502. All circuits and connections are power limited/Class 2.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 69
~otes: a. Not installed for personalities OIB and XBB.
I. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA b. Installed for PIB personalities only.
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable 11. Supervised Remote Bus connects to TFX MP-500 Main
notes. All circuits contained in this module are classified as Processor Board TB3, remote bus. Bus wiring parameters:
power limited/Class 2 and shall be installed to comply with 100 ohm total maximum line resistance, 30pF/foot (mutual)
N.E.C. Article 760, Part A and Part C. maximum capacitance, 4000 feet maximum distance. EOL is
2. Disconnect power before servicing the system. UL listed 120 ohm (P/N 976048). Use shielded, twisted pair
3. All conductors must be free of grounds. wire. Connect shield to common shield connection pOint that
4. The personality header, H2, uses jumpers to enable the connects to DC Common of main power supply.
functions for each personality. See Table 1. 12. Serial Port, PL3, connects to PIM-550 Printer Interface
5. Hi and H3 Address Headers-Use header Hi (local) or H3 Module, PL5 (within cabinet). For cable connection, see
(remote) depending on whether the MPIM is used as local or "Thorn AUTOCALL TFX-500/800 Spare Parts," publication
remote interface. See Table 2. number 19700260 or TFX-500M/BOOM Spare Parts, Publica-
3. LEDs-uPower ON" LED, seen from front panel, indicates tion Number 19700373,.
system power status. "Fault" LED indicates trouble in the 13. In Front Panel application, OIB-L personality, connect PL 10 to
system. Expansion bus Connector of LCD board, pins 15 and 16.
7. Buzzer operates to alert operators of alarm or trouble status. 14. PL9 provides for two N.O. switch inputs. Terminals are +VE (2)
Buzzer produces pulsed tone for Trouble, continuous tone for and Ov.
Alarm 15. To increase contrast of LCD alpha-numeric display, turn
9. Refer to Cable Application Chart in AUTOCALL TFX-500/BOO potentiometer counter-clockwise.
Spare Parts," Publication Number 19700260 or 16. Connect the Earth Ground Tab PL11 to the nearest convenient
TFX-500M/BOOM Spare Parts, Publication Number 19700373, chassis ground pOint for protection of the Remote Bus
for details. electronics.
9. Parallel Port is not used.
CAUTION: Connect the MPIM either to the Local Bus (PL1, PL2)
10. Serial Interface, IC8 should be configured as follows:
OR to Remote Bus (PL4), not both.
MPIM Personality:
"Personality" is jumper=enab!ed configuration of the MPltv1 module that permits or excludes specific board functions, such as serial printer
interface.
Table 1. MPIM Personality Headers
X = Jumper link installed
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
* See Note 10
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 70
Table 2. H1, H3 Address Headers. Set address according to
site plan.
Jumper Address
Installed Value
No link o
AD
A1 2
A2 4
A3 8
Functions
Personality Header Keypad Display Local Remote Expansion Serial Parallel
Links Bus Bus Bus Port Port
OIB-L Operator Interface Board (Local) P 1,5,6 v v v v v ~~
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 71
rable 4. MPIM Connectors and Terminals
MPIM Local Bus PL1 and PL2
PL1/2-1 OV PL 1/2-6 -RS232 PL1/2-11 SS2
PL 1/2-2 MISO PL1/2-7 +RS232 PL1/2-12 SSO
PL1/2-3 SCK PL1/2-S +26V PL1/2-13 MOSI
PL1/2-4 SS1 PL1/2-9 N/C PL1/2-14 OV
PL 1/2-5 SS3 PL1/2-10 +5V
MPIM Remote Bus PL4
PL4-1 (+) PL4-3 (+)
PL4-2 (-) PL4-4 (-)
MPIM Expansion Bus PL5
Expansion
PL5-1 Data PL5-7 PL5-13 OV
1--16
PL5-2 AO PL5-8
Expansion
17--32
I PL5-14 +5V
Expansion
PL5-3 Ai PL5-9 PL5-15 Ident
33--4S
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 72
Module Position -."._ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(See System Layout)
Space Requirement: One PB3, Expansion Motherboard position;
Optional DCPM (see Note 5), ALXM positions (2 minimum, S
lAM-SO~ Expansion Motherboard maximum)
Input Voltage: 24 VDC, regulated, power limited
PCB PIN 940562 Order PIN 976063 Output Voltages (Optional DCPM): (see Publication No.
Publication Number 19700277 197002S2, DCPM DC Power Module.)
Current Draw (lAM-BOO board):
Issue 4, January 1997 22 rnA supervisory
20 rnA alarm
The AUTO CALL IAM-800 Expansion Motherboard is used in the Addressable Loop Capacity: Ten 2-way data circuits, connected
AUTOCALL TFX-SOO/800, TFX-SOOM/800M, TFX-SOOMV/800MV, to S ALXM boards
DirecTone SOO ("TFX") fire control panels. It provides for mounting Relay Contact Rating: 1A@ 24 VDC, 0.6 Power Factor
of the DCPM DC power module and the IIB-800 ALXM Loop Dimensions (/wd with ALXMs installed): 1O.S x 7.62S x 4 inches
Expansion Boards. The IAM-800 motherboard provides signal and
power interconnections between the Main processor (MP),
ALXMs, DCPM, and the 2-way data circuits (addressable loops).
Alarm and Fault relays are provided for fail-safe alarm and fault
signalling should communications to the Main Processor board be
lost. If communications to the MP-SOO Main Processor are active,
these relays will not switch. The relays will switch only if
communications to the Main Processor are lost.
"
1
[ t' JI
li I
Figure 1. IAM-800 Expansion Motherboard PIN 976063.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 73
Installation: 10. See Publication Number 19700260, "Autocall TFX-500/S00
1. The IAM-800 mounts to the subplate in the backbox (primary Spare Parts," or Publication Number 19700373, "Auto call
box) of the main control panel using plastic stand-offs. TFX-500M/800M Spare Parts," for cable designations.
2. A DCPM power module is required if three or more ALXM
boards are installed.
3. Ten 2-way data circuits are wired to screw-type terminal blocks
at the right-hand side of the board, as follows: Table 1. Compatible Devices-The following Grinnell
TB1-Loop A TB6--Loop F devices are UL listed for use on the two data loops.
TB2-Loop B TB7-Loop G
Model Part ASS'y Standby Max. No. per Addr. Loop
TB3-Loop C TBS-Loop H No. No. Current
TB4-Loop D TB9-Loop J
TB5-Loop E TB1 D-Loop K IXA-500DM 940523 976022 20 mA 99
4. Five IIB-800 ALXM loop expansion boards connect to the
IXA-500DMA 940576 976093 20 mA 99
IAM-800 motherboard and control pairs of 2-way data circuits
(loops). IXA-500CM 940528 976027 0.27 mA 99
Board Associated
ALXM Connector Loops IXA-500CMA 940575 976092 0.27 mA 99
1 PL2 A and B
IXA-502CMA 940581 976185 0.27 mA 99
2 PL3 Cand D
3 PL4 E and F iXA-501 Civi 940573 976081 0.27 rnA 99
4 PLS Gand H
5 PL6 J and K OXA-500SD 940526 976023 8.2mA 99
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 74
SUPERVISED TYPICAL 2-WAY
lAM-aDo CIRCUIT DATA CIRCUITS A & B
Expansion Motherboa~d 7 STYLE *
PIN 94056/
LOOP/J.
MULTIPLEX
COMMUNICATION
Location of LOOPS
DCPM ATHROUGH K
(NOTE S) NOTE 6
LOOPE
JACKWVOR RIBBON
RELAYS
NOTE 8
CABL 0 OPTIONAL
DCPM DC POWER
MODULE
c;==:;:;==u
NOTES
[IJ ElSIG
ElRTN SHIELD
~~
SHIELD
PL8 ER SIG CONNECTION
ER RTN NOTE 6
) II~ I~~~J~ I
'1
II
CD GR RTN
~~UI em
~ I PL3 HlRrN
HR SIG
HR RTN
CONNECTORS
FOR
ALXMLOO~~---+------__
EXPANSION
BOARDS
r~===================='-'
r
L..!::::====================!..-
PL4 ,I CD JlSIG
CD JlRTN
JR SIG
JR RTN
KlSIG
NOTE 4 KlRTN
KRSIG
~ PLS KRRTN
j"""_ _ JACK FOR RIBBON
~
CABLE TO LOCAL
PL6 BUS MAIN PROCESSOR
BOARD
NOTE 7
PL9
P17
I. ~~
c:..
ALARM FAULT NOTE a JACK FOR RIBBON CABLE
TO LOCAL BUS CONNECTOR NOTE 9
Figure 2. lAM-BOO Expansion Motherboard PIN 940562. All circuits and connections are power limited/Class 2.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 75
Table 2. Compatible Devices-The following 550 Series
detectors are UL listed for use on the two data loops.
ISA-4121940517 0.18mA 99
I
ISN-5121940519 0.18mA 99
IHN-135920097 0.25 mA 99
IHN-135920097 0.33 mA 99
..
IHN-200 920098 0.33 mA 99
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience installing and testing fire detection
systems. These instructions do not purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment
described. Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection with installation,
operation, or maintenance. All specifications are subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems arise which are not covered
sufficientlyforthe user's purposes, the matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems
Company, Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 75
Module Position---;;--_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(See System Layout) . ..
Space Requirement: One ALXM, Loop ExpanSion Board posItion
Input Voltage: +5 VDC and +26 VDC (regulated, power limited)
IIB-800 ALXM Loop Expansion Board Input Current: 60 mA and 50 mA respectively
Data Bus Supervisory Current Draw: 60 mA
PCB PIN 940563 Order PIN 976062 Data Bus Alarm Current Draw: 60 mA
Publication Number 19700278 Addressable Loop Supervisory Current Draw: 20 mA per loop
Addressable Loop Alarm Current Draw: 24 mA per loop
Issue 2, January 1997 Dimensions (Iwd): 3.625 x 6.125 x 0.5 inches
Notes:
The AUTOCALL IIB-800 ALXM Loop Expansion Board is used to 1. All conductors must be free of grounds.
expand the capacity of the AUTOCALL TFX-aoo. (T~X-aOOM, 2. Disconnect power before servicing systems.
3. Green LED, 016, "Processor OK," should be ON for normal
TFX-aOOMV). Each ALXM monitors two 2-way data circuits and up
operation. Yellow LED, 027, "Fault," ON indicates a micropro-
to 5 ALXMs can be fitted in an AUTOCALL TFX-800/aOOM panel.
cessor fault, or communication of an external fault to the
This enables it to handle up to ten 2-way data circuits (multiplex
motherboard.
loops). Each ALXM monitors and processes signals fro~ d~,:,ices
4. Hi, Special Test, no jumper is installed for normal operation.
on those 2-way data circuits. The ALXM communicates significant
5. H2, EEPROM Write Enable, should be configured as follows:
events on the 2-way data circuits to the main processor board
a. No jumper link installed for normal operation.
(MP-500). Commands from the MP-500 are also communicated to
b. Jumper link installed only during EEPROM programming.
the 2-way data circuits (for example, zone walk test commands).
6. EEPROM must be installed and programmed for normal
Each ALXM is also connected to common Alarm and Fault relays operation.
on the Expansion Motherboard, to provide failsafe external 7. PL 1 connects the ALXM to the Expansion Motherboard
signalling only in the event of failure of the ~v1ain Processor. PIN 940562. Refer to Publication No. 19700277, "Autoca!!
IAM-aOO Expansion Motherboard". This connection provides
If more than two ALXMs are installed, an additional DCPM DC power to the ALXM board, communication of microprocessor
Powei tv10dule must be installed on the Expansion rv1otheiboaid to information to/from the 2-way data circuits, alarm relay drive,
provide power to the additional ALXMs. and fault relay drive.
a. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, .NFPA
Installation: 70 state, and local building code requirements and applicable
1. Orient the ALXM board so thatthe component-side of the board notes. All circuits contained in this module are classified as
faces the top of the enclosure. power limited/Class 2 and shall be installed to comply with
2. Loosen the retainer clips on the board guides so that the board N.E.C. Article 760, Part A and Part C.
slips along the tracks. 9. H3 Ground Links. No links installed for normal operation. Do
3. Secure the board retainer clips. NOT install jumper links .
.,..--- ~~~rJ~6~RMWTHERBOARD
NOTE 4
PL1
H3
D Note9
D H1
NOTE 4 f~~fIAL
THORN AUTO CALL IIB-800
ALXM LOOP EXPANSION BOARD
PIN 940563 EEPROM
NOTE 6
If ana
m
."
C;; :;:
u '~"'L!J LJ
NOTE 3
00
D16
EEPROM
_ LEDS WRITE
' - - - - ENABLE
Figure 1. IIB-800 ALXM Loop Expansion Board PIN 940563.AII circuits and connections are power limited/Class 2.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 78
Module Position
(See System Layout)
Space Requirements: Position B4 or BS (maximum 5 per MPIM)
or "piggy-back" to any MPIM
ARM-500 Auxiliary Relay Module Input Voltage: 24 VDC
Supervisory Current Draw: 5 mA plus 27 mA per energized relay
PCB PIN 900928 Assembly No. 976014 Alarm Current Draw: S mA plus 27 mA per energized relay
Publication Number 19700236, Maximum Current: 221 mA
Contact Rating: 5 A @ 30 VDC or 277 VAC
Issue 3, January 1997 Dimensions (Iwh): 6.6 x 3.6 x 0.90 inches
The AUTOCALL ARM-SOO Auxiliary Relay Module is an optional
board that provides eight zonal dry contact relay outputs for the Installation Notes:
AUTOCALL TFX-SOO/800, TFX-SOOM/800M, TFX-SOOMV/800MV, 1. Disconnect system power.
DirecTone SOO ("TFX") fire control systems. The ARM-SOO 2. Install ARM-500 module using stand-ofts.
interacts with the AUTOCALL TFX Main Processor (MP-SOO) via 3. Make MPIM cable connection.
an additional Multi-Purpose Interface Module (MPIM, any person- 4. If installing multiple ARM-500 modules, connect Output Pin 1
ality). Eight relay contacts may be set normally-open (N.O.) or of first module to Input Pin 16 of second module. A maximum
normally-closed (N.C.), selectable (by jumper). The ARM-SOO may of five ARM-SOO modules may be connected to one MPIM.
be used to switch either power limited or non-power limited circuits S. Install header in JP9 of the last board of the MPIM Expansion
(or both) Bus.
6. Make field wiring connections.
7. Make power connections.
-
~ .J1
IN
TO ADDITIONAL
ARM-SOO
ARM500
PIN 900928
~
"U
Z
Ul
is
Z
OJ
C
Ul
JACK FOR CONNECTION
FROM MPIM EXPANSION
BUS
1
JP1
IQQil]
N.O.N.C.
8 K1
D
LASTBD
16 OF INPUT (ABOVE); PIN 16
BELOW TO PIN 1 ABOVE.
01
COM NC 19I!'a r-:::-l
02
NOI2I"'~ INPUT
2
COM
~r-:::-l
03 N.O.N.C.~
n
3
COM NCl'-i:-l
04 NO~:;!2~
OUTPUT
4
COM
JPS
[i&Q)
0 K5
OUTPUT Ul 16 16
7
06
COM
07
JP7
[QQQ]
N.O. N.C.
c:J []]
K7
TB1
1
o vdc
+24V
COM
08 N.C. " 1'- r-::-I
8
COM N.o.~cil~
Figure 1. ARM-500 Auxiliary Relay Module PIN 976014 (PCB No. 900928). Installation. When installing mumtiple
ARM-500 modules, connect output of first ARM-500 to input of next ARM-500. Use correct polarity.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 79
LEOs
POWER LED (1 PER OUTPUT)
NOTE 8 NOTES
Table 1. ARM-SOO Contacts,
-
OUT
~
J
089 1
OS11~
oS21
oS31:)
ARMSOO
PIN 900928
~
z
(J)
6
z
J1
-IN
Output
Number
1
Contact
Select
JP1
~
TO ADDITIONAL IJJ
C
ARMSOO NOTE S, 7 oS41:) (J)
o NCIgI~ I 6 JP6
00
~O
COM
02
COM
N.O.lJ"
~
'--;===-.. .
1
K2
7 JP7
;:! 0 03 N.O. N.C. K3 B JPB
~O COM N.Cl<-1
~O 04 N.O.[gJ~ K4 n .. +_.I+
Indicating Viol'..,""
00 JP;~
1l
COM
LED Terminals
co~~r6~ lQQ]
N.O. N.. ,C:;,.'-==;---'
KS
DS1 01/Com
NOTE~9 ~ N.C.~ ~ 1'-
O
-00 COM K6
~O 06 N.O.o '" -;::=::::'..~ TB1 DS2 02/Com
I I 00 'I
L....
INPUT POWER
~ I f'\~<! n"l!('""r'V'r,
~ I
~O
!EO COM o VDe NOTE 3
07 N.'Q'N'.c.1 '" +24V
-:?'"
DETAIL "A" ::;0 C. OM DS4 04/Com
~ ~ ~O N.C~H
Qt ~ "..,,..
08 K8
~?']I
u.;);) 05iCom
1 1 COM I DS6 06/Com
N.C. N.O. DS7 07/Com
(NORMALLY (NORMALLY FOR JP1 THRU JP8:
CLOSED) OPEN) INDIVIDUALLY SELECT 'NORMALLY OPEN' DSB OB/Com
JUMPER JUMPER OR 'NORMALLY CLOSED' OUTPUT CONTACTS
1-2 2-3 (SEE DETAIL "A") NOTE 9
Figure 2. ARM-500 Auxiliary Relay Module PIN 976014 (PCB No. 900928).
Wiring Notes: 11, All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA
1. Disconnect power before servicing the system. 70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable
2, All conductors to be free of grounds. notes. When installed to comply with N.E.C. Article 760, Part
3. Typically connects to 24 VDC output of AC Power Module. A and Part B, these circuits are classified as non-power
4. Wiring to terminal blocks TB2 may be connected to non-power limited. When installed to comply with N.E.C. Article 760, Part
limited sources. Make sure that all power-limited/Class 2wiring A and Part C, these circuits are classified as power limited.
is separated at least 0.25 inches from any wiring that is not 12. For non-power limited applications, remove the "POWER
power limited, Use cable ties or other permanent means to LIMITED" label from the terminal block.
secure wiring.
5. See Publication Number 19700260, "AUTOCALL
TFX-500/800 Spare Parts," or Publication Number 19700373,
''AUTOCALL TFX-500M/800M Spare Parts," for cable connec-
tion applications.
6. Jumper JP9 is installed only on the last board of the expansion
bus.
7. Up to four additional ARM-500 modules may be connected
"piggy-back" to the first. Connect expansion bus from one to
expansion bus of the other. A maximum of five ARM-500s may
be connected to one MPIM. When making the connection,
connect Pin 1 of first ARM-500 to Pin 16 of the next.
8. The status of each re!ay is visuaUy indicated by the red LEDs I This document is written for skilled technicians with experience I
DS1 through DSB. The green LED, DS9, "ON" indicates +5 installing and testing fire detection systems. These instructions do not
VDC power. purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment described.
9. Jumpers are used to select contacts as either normally-open Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection
(N.O.) or normally-closed (N.C.). Jumpers JP1 through JPB with installation, operation, or maintenance. All speCifications are
subject to change without notice.
correspond to contacts 1 through B. (See Table)
10. It is necessary to program the AUTO CALL TFX Main Should further information be desired or should particular problems
Processor EEPROM for ARM-500 operation. Include for each arise which are not covered sufficiently for the user's purposes, the
relay: XBus address, device type, device operation, zone, and matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company,
Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
other information that may relate to relay operation.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page8C
Module Position: _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(a)
EADER
HEADER NOTE5
NOTE5
()
LAST MODULE
LKI AUTOCALL OAA-16
NOTE 6 Expansion Output Module (XIOM)
PCB PIN 940564
G liP
OIP
NOTE 7 Ass'/ No. 976066
NOTE 7
rtj2lIIP
~OIP
OUTPUT 10
01
TERMINAL BLOCKS 100 OUTPUT
SUPERV~~~ \ ~
02 0
TERMINAL BLOCKS
NOTES 7, 8, 15 ~~ ~ NOT
:go SUPERVISED
NOTES 7, 8, 15
b~ ~
LED ::!-t. 10 0
NOTE14 -L 06 0
~~TE9
OV ITED. MAINTAIN 0.25 INCH SEPARATION FROM ALL
o
NOTE 9 POWER LIMITED WIRING BY MEANS OF WIRE TIES OR
+5V OV OV +V }
~_ _ _ _(O_Un
___ (IN_)_ _ _ _ _~INP~UT~~L~
NOT SUPERVISED
NOTE 10
Figure 1. (a) OAA-16 Expansion Output Module PCB 940564, Ass'y No. 976066, (b) Separation of power limited!
Class 2 circuits from non-power limited circuits.
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience installing and testing fire detection
systems. These instructions do not purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment
described. Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection with installation,
operation, or maintenance. All specifications are subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems arise which are not covered
sufficiently for the user's purposes, the matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection systems
Company, Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 82
Module Position:
(See System Layout)
---------------------
Space Requirement: Requires one MPIM per five XIOMs;Posi-
tions 04--08, OB2--0B6, etc.; boards may be "piggy-backed" and
IAA-16 XIOM 16 Input Module connected "daisy-chain" within the same enclosure.
Input Voltage: +5 VOC (regulated, power limited)
PCB PIN 940564 Assembly No. 976067 Input Current: 11 rnA
Output Voltage: +5 VOC
Publication Number 19700286 Output Current: Current limited at 120 rnA
Issue 2, January 1997 Current Draw Data Bus, Supervisory: 5 rnA per active switch input
Current Draw Data Bus, Alarm: + 5 rnA per active switch input
The AUTO CALL IAA-16 XIOM Expansion 161nput Module is used Dimensions (Iwd): 5.625 x 3.375 x 0.75 inches
in the AUTOCALL TFX-500M/800M, TFX-500MV/800MV, Oirec-
Tone 500 ("TFX") fire control systems to provide communication Installation:
functions such as accepting volt-free contact inputs. 1. Check the IAA-16 XIOM module header configurations for
The IAA-16 XIOM connects to the Expansion Bus of an MPIM. Up correct input function. See Notes.
to five XIOMs may be connected ("daisy-chained") to an MPIM. The 2. Attach terminal blocks (supplied). Wire input connections.
XIOM may be mounted "piggy-back" to the MPIM or mounted on 3. Install module on nylon stand-ofts "piggy-back" to MPIM or
the sub-plate within the same enclosure. The XIOM modules may another XIOM or on sub-plate in same enclosure as the MPIM
be "piggy-backed" as space permits. driving it.
4. Connect the ribbon cables and power cables.
o o OIP~
JACK FOR CABLE
CONNECTION
FROM
EXPANSION BUS
JACK FOR CABLE OF MPIM OR
CONNECTION TO XIOM
EXPANSION BUS NOTES 3,4
OFXIOM
NOTES 3,4 PL2
LED
LKI LAST MODULE AUTOCALL IAA-16 NOTE 10
NOTE 6
::[J Expansion Input Module (XIOM)
PCB NO. 940564
rtiil liP NOTE 7 NOTE 7 r;l OIIP
LJ OIP ASS'Y NO. 976067 EJ IP
Ir-~.---. 10
01
INPUT TERMINAL BLOCKS 10
0
02
10
NOTES 7, 8, 16 03
10
04 INPUT TERMINAL BLOCKS
10 NOT SUPERVISED
05
10
06
10 ...--1"'---,---,
~~ I F5 1
II--::::~ 08
NOTE 12
OV
~~
e ovO
OV
NOTE 12
(b)
s TERMINAL BLOCK WIRING MAY BE NONPOWER
LIMITED. MAINTAIN 0.25 INCH SEPARATION FROM
ALL POWER LIMITED WIRING BY MEANS OF WIRE
INPUTS! OUTPUTS OUT IN INPUTS! OUTPUTS TIES OR OTHER PERMANENT MEANS
NOT SUPERVISED
.L-_ _ _---:;N~OT:..::E~14.:..__ _ _ _ _ NOTES 9,16
NOTE 15
I
EXPANSION BUS
CABLES POWER LIMITED REMOTE BUS AND LOCAL BUS
CONNECTIONS POWER LIMITED
Figure 1. (a) IAA-16 Expansion Input Module PGB No. 940564, PIN 976067, (b) Separation of power limit-
ed/Glass 2 circuits from non-power limited circuits ..
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 83
Notes:
1 . All conductors must be free of grounds.
2. Disconnect power before servicing systems.
3. See Publication Number 19700260, "AUTO CALL
TFX-500/S00 Spare Parts," or Publication Number 19700373,
"AUTOCALL TFX-500M/SOOM Spare Parts," for cable connec-
tion applications.
4. PL 1 and PL2, 16-pin Expansion Bus connection from MPIM to
XIOM and from XIOM to XIOM, are power limited/Class 2. A
maximum of five XIOMs may be connected to one MPIM.
"Piggy-back" the modules a maximum of three boards deep;
install all boards in the same cabinet.
5. Headers H3 and H4 are factory configured with jumper
installed across the liP header for normal IAA-16 operation.
6. Header Link LK1-install jumper link to the last board on the
expansion bus "daisy chain."
7. Headers H1 and H2 are factory configured with jumper
installed across header1-2 on both H1 and H2 for normal
operation.
S. Terminal blocks TB1, TB2, TB4, and TB5 connect to input
circuits. Typical connections are to input relays. Use wire
gauge No. 22 to 14 AWG. Wiring to terminal blocks may be
connected to non-power limited sources. Make sure that all
power-limited/Class 2 wiring is separated at least 0.25 inches
from all wiring that is non-power limited. Use cable ties or other
permanent means to secure wiring. Remove "power limited"
label from non-power limited terminal blocks.
9. T83 provides a +5 VDC supply for use with volt-free contacts.
10. "Power On" LED is lighted when the protected +5 VDC supply
is present.
11. Fuse FS1, UL listed 2.0 amp PIN 1S400355. Warranty void if
fused improperly.
12. TB6 and TB7 are not used in IAA-16 application.
13. It is necessary to program the AUTOCALL TFX-500/S00 and
TFX-500M/SOOM for IAA-16 XIOM digital input operation.
Include for each: XBus address, device type, device operation,
zone, and other information that may relate to digital input
operation.
14. Typical normally-low configured input (Normally-Open con-
tact).
15. Typical normally-high configured input (Normally-Closed con-
tact).
16. These are restricted inputs, and as such, all wiring to/from the
inputs must remain within the same room.
17. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable
notes. When installed to comply with N.E.G. Article 760, Part
A and Part B, these circuits are classified as non-power
limited. When installed to comply with N .E.G. Aritcle 760, Part
A and Part C, these circuits are classified as power limited.
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience installing and testing fire detection
systems. These instructions do not purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment
described. Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection with installation,
operation, or maintenance. All specifications are subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems arise which are not covered
sufficiently for the user's purposes, the matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems
Company Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 84
Module Position
(See System L a y o - u 7 . " t ) - - - - - - - - - - - - -
Space Requirement: Requires one MPIM per five XAA-16s;
Positions 04-08 or DB2-D6, etc.; boards may be "piggy-backed"
XAA-16 8-lnput/8-0utput Contact and connected "daisy-chain" within the same enclosure.
Standby Current: 4 mA
Monitor/Relay Driver Module (XIOM) + 9 mA per active LED output
PCB PIN 940564 Assembly No. 976098 + 50 mA per active relay output drive
+ 5 mA per configured input
Publication Number 19700338 Alarm Current: (same as Standby)
Issue 2, January 1997 +5V Output Current: (TB3-1) Limited to 120 mA
Input Supply Voltage: (TB3-4 to drive relay output drivers)
The AUTOCALL XM-16 8-lnput/8-0utput Contact Monitor/Relay 5 V to 24 V, regulated and limited to 2 A
Driver Module is used in the AUTO CALL TFX-500/BOO, Output Ratings: LED, 10 mA max
TFX-500M/BOOM, TFX-500MV/800Mv, DirecTone 500 ("TFX") fire Relay Coil Drive, 100 rnA max
control systems to provide the following input/output communica- Dimensions (Iwd): 5.625 x 3.375 x 0.75 inches
tion functions:
Installation:
Drive relay outputs 1. Check the XM-16 module for correct input/output configura-
Accept digital inputs. tion by checking header jumper links. See Notes.
Monitor volt-free relay contacts 2. Attach terminal blocks (supplied). Wire input/output connec-
The XIOM connects to the Expansion Bus of an MPIM (any tions.
personality). Upto five XIOMs may be connected ("daisy-chained") 3. Install module on metal stand-ofts "piggy-back" to MPIM or
to an MPIM. The XIOM may be mounted "piggy-back" to the MPIM another XM-16 or on sub-plate in same enclosure as the
or mounted on the sub-plate within the same enclosure. The MPIM driving it.
XAA-16 moduies may be "piggy-backed" as space permits. 4. Connect the ribbon cabies and power cabies.
The XAA-16 is configured for 8 outputs and 8 inputs.
HEADER
POWER ON
LED
LAST MODULE
LH1.
HEADER HEADER
=0: AUTO CALL XAA-16
rm II/Pp 8 INPUT I 8 OUTPUT MODUL~ liP
LJO PIN 940564 ~o/
INPUT
TERMINAL BLOCKS
OUTPUT
TERMINAL BLOCKS
10
09
t--ir-t--t
IISSSSI
3T~3 I ( j
ov 4
~
1
+5V ov OV +V(IN)
(ouT)
{WJ ov
Figure 1. AUTOCALL XAA-16 8-lnput/8-0utput Module PCB No. 940564, Ass'y No. 976098.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 85
Table 1. XAA-16 Terminal and Header Designations 7. Terminal blocks TB1, TB2, TB4, and TB5 connect to input/out-
put circuits. Typical connections are to LEOs, input relays, or
,
Function / Mode Terminal Input/Output Pori Header Jumper Link output relays. Use wire gauge No. 22 to 14 AWG. (See Figure
I Input-volt free TB1-1 to TBl-4 1-4 (Input) H1link 1-2, 2). Wiring to terminal blocks may be connected to non-power
limited sources. Make sure that all power-limited/Class 2wiring
TB2-1 to TB2-4 5-8 (Input) H41ink 1-2 is separated at least 0.25 inches from all wiring that is
Output-relay driver TB4-1 to TB4-4 9-12 (Output) H21ink 3-4, non-power limited_ Use calbe ties or other permanent means
to secure wiring. Remove the "power limited" label from the
TB5-1 to TB5-4 13-16 (Output) H31ink 3-4 non-power limited terminal blocks.
8. TB3 provides a 120 mA current limited output +5 VDC supply
Notes: for use with volt-free contacts.
1. All conductors must be free of grounds. 9_ "Power On" LED is lighted when the protected +5 VDC supply
2. Disconnect power before servicing systems. is present.
3. See Publication Number 19700260, "AUTOCALL 10. Fuse FS1, UL listed 2 amp PIN 18400355. Warranty void if
TFX-500/BOO Spare Parts," for cable connection applications. fused improperly.
4. PL 1 and PL2, 16-pin Expansion Bus connection from MPIM to 11. It is necessary to program the AUTOCALL TFX conatrol panel
XAA-16 and from XAA-16 to XAA-16 are power limited. A for XAA-16 digital input/output operation. Include for each:
maximum of five XAA-16s may be connected to one MPIM. XBus address, device type, device operation, zone, and other
"Piggy-back" the modules a maximum of three boards deep; information that may relate to digital input/output operation.
install all boards in the same cabinet. 12_ All circuits connected to the XAA-16 are classified as power
5. Header Link LK1-install jumper link in LK1 into the last board limited/Class2. .
on the Expansion Bus "daisy chain." 13. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA
6. Headers Hi , H2, H3, and H4 configure terminal blocks for input 70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable
or output functions. See Table 1 for header position related to notes. When installed to comply with NEC. Article 760, Part
terminal block operation. A and Part B, these circuits are classified as non-power
limited. When instaiied to compiy with NEG. Article 760, Part
A and Part C, these circuits are classified as power limited.
!(b) - - - - - - - - - - - - - - T~R::::O~K:IR~
(a) , -_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _---, MAY BE NON-POWER LlM-'
IoOl
~ SEE TABLE 1
H4
NOTE 6
H3
SEE TABLE 1 ~
NOTE 6
fOOl I
SEPARATION FROM ALL
POWER LIMITED WIRING
I
ITED. MAINTAIN 0.25 INCH'
TO AUXILIARY
POWER (COMMON)
NOT SUPERVISED
POWER LIMITED
NOTES
Figure 2. (a) Typical AUTOCALL XAA-16 Wiring_ (b) Separation of power limited/Class 2 circuits from non-
power limited circuits.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 86
Module Position
(See System Layo-u"';';t)-------------
Space Requirement: Location 04 or 05 ("piggyback" to MPIM on
front panel or auxiliary housing)
PIM-550 Printer Interface Module Input Voltage: regulated and power limited;+5 VOC@80 mA max,
-12 VOC @ 5 mA max, +12 VOC @5 mA max
PCB PIN 940545 Assembly No. 976018 Supervisory Current: 20 mA
Data Communications: RS232 serial
Baud rate = 4800
Publication Number 19700253 Dimensions (Iwh): 6.6 x 3.6 x 0.75 inches
Issue 4, January 1997
o o
PIM-550
PIN 940545
PL1
CONNECTION
JACK FOR TO MPIM
RIBBON CABLE (NOTES 4& 5)
CONNECTION TO MPIM
(NOTE 3)
o 0c::;::::::;:)
CONNECTION
JACK FOR
TO PRINTER
RIBBON CABLE
(NOTES 4 & 5)
CONNECTION TO MPIM
(NOTE 3)
NOTE?
Figure 1. PIM-550 Printer Interface Module (PCB P?N 940545, Ass'y No. 976018). All circuits and connections
are power limited/Class 2.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Paga87
B. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable
notes. All circuits contained in this module are classified as
power limited/Class 2 and shall be installed to comply with
N.E.G. Article 760, Part A and Part C.
Table 1. PIM-550 Printer Interface Connections
PL1 and PL3 PL2 and PL4
Pin Function 1 Ov
I 1 OV 2 TXO
!
12 MISO 3 RXO
3 SCK 4 CTS
4 SS1 5 OSR
5 SS3 6 OTR
6 -12V
7 +i2V PLb t:arth Ground Tag
8 +26V PL5 Earth Ground
9 N/C
10 +5V
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 88
Module Position: _ _ _~======
(See System Layout)
Space Requirement: One Module position B2 or PB2
Input Voltage: regulated and power limited; 24 VDC at 1.5 A max,
CEB-500 City Box Transmitter 5 VDC at 20 mA
PCB PIN 940524 Assembly 976031 Supervisory Current: 5 mA
Maximum Current: City Box load 1.5 A max
Publication Number 19700249 Maximum Output Voltage: 2B.5 VDC
Issue 4, Jafnuary 1997 Maximum Wiring Impedance to City Box: 4.5 ohm
Dimensions (/wd): 3.5 x 4.6 x 1 inches
The AUTOCALL CEB-500 City Box Transmitter provides an
interface between the TFX (TFX-500/BOO, TFX-500M/BOOM, Install in accordance with NFPA 70, National electrical Code, NFPA
kTFX-500MV/BOOMV, DirecTone 500) fire control panel and a 72, Installation, Maintenance, and use of Protective Signaling
standard coded municipal transmitter. The CEB-500 sends a Systems.
'System Alarm' signal from the control panel to the city box and
generates a 'Signalling Started' event when the city boxtrips.ltalso
monitors for a 'Coil Fault' at the city box and causes a 'Signalling
Fault' message at the fire control panel.
EARTH TAG
...
NOTE 7
PL1
CEB-500
PIN 940524 LEDs
TO CITY BOX -I+--HW J NOTE 6
NOTE 5 +
TB1
NON-POWER UMITED
NOTES 1,8 D3
ALARM
o 0
20
SK1 ~1=======;;;::::::::=n==========ll
~
Figure 1. CDB-500 City Box Transmitter Module (PCB P?N 940524, Ass'y No. 976031).
Notes: 7. Connect PL1, "Earth Tag," to PL 10, "Earth Ground Tag, on the
1. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA M P-500 Main Processor board for the TFX control panel. See
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable "AUTOCALL TFX-500/BOO Spare Parts," Publication Number
notes. 19700260 or "AUTOCALL TFX-500M/BOOM Spare Parts,"
2. Disconnect power before servicing systems. Publication Number 19700373 for cable designation.
3. All conductors to be free of grounds. B. The field wiring connections to TB1 of this module are
4. Fit plastic stand-offs to the TFx-500/BOO, TFX-500M/BOOM non-power limited. These wires must be routed and secured to
Main Processor board. Carefully match the 20-pin connector maintain a minimum of 0.25 inch separation from power
on the CEB-500 board to the 20-pins of PL7 remote network limited/Class 2wiring. Refer to "Wiring Guidelines," Publication
connector on the MP board. Lower the board until connectors No. 19700259 and wiring diagram No. 19700243 for connec-
are firmly seated and plastic stand-offs snap into holes in the tion details.
board.
5. Connect TB1 to a UL Listed City Box having the following
ratings: Trip Current 250 mA, Coil Resistance 14.5 ohms.
(Circuit not supervised for shorts.) Refer to Wiring Diagram No.
19700243 for connection details.
6. The red "Alarm" LED indicates Alarm and activation of the
output circuit. The yellow "Fault" LED indicates Trouble.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 89
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience installing and testing fire detection
systems. These instructions do not purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment
described. Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection with installation,
operation, or maintenance. All specifications are subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems arise which are not covered
sufficiently forthe user's purposes, the matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems
Company, Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 90
ModulePosition:_-.--_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(See System Layout)
Space Requirement: One position B2 or PB2. Cannot be installed
if City Box Transmitter module is installed.
eV8-S00 Reverse Polarity Transmitter Input Voltage: 24 VDC (regulated, power limited/Class 2)
PCB PIN 940525 Order PIN 976030 Output Voltage: 24 VDC
Maximum Current Draw: 10 mA (Alarm)
Publication Number 19700250 Maximum Output Circuit Inpedance (Includes wiring and
Issue 4, January 1997 receiver impedance): 15 k-ohm
Maximum Source Current: 6.5 mA
The AUTOCALL CVB-500 Reverse Polarity Transmitter provides Dimensions (/wd): 3.5 x 4.625 x 1 inches
an interface between the AUTOCALL TFX (TFX-500/BOO,
TFX-500M/BOOM, TFX-500MV/BOOMV, DirecTone 500) fire control
panel and a municipal or commercially operated central alarm
receiving station. The CVB-500 transmits "System Alarm" and Install in accordance with NFPA 72, Installation, Maintenance and
"System Trouble" signals. It also generates a "Signalling Started" use of Protective Signaling Systems, and NFPA 70, National
message at the control panel when the CVB-500 trips. Electrical Code.
EARTH TAG
/
J..-
NOTE 6
PL1
SUPERVISED CV8-500
PIN 940525 LEDs
//
NOTE 3 NOTES
+
T81
D3' D1 '
ALARM FAULT
o 0
20
SK1 I=F====~=n========Il
~
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 91
eVB-SOO Output Wiring Parameters For example, if your receiver requires 4.5 mA and has 1000 ohm
input impedance, find the corresponding impedance for 4.5 mA on
ro determine maximum allowable wiring resistance, first determine the chart; subtract the input impedance. The maximum wiring
"eceiver current requirements and receiver imput impedance. Then impedance is
Jse the graph in Figure 2 to determine the maximum wiring 4200 ohms - 1000 ohms == 3200 ohms
"esistance.
7~--------------------------------------------------------------~
.
5
......
c:
Q)
....
....
:J
()
(])
....
()
4j
:J
0
i.fj
0
0 3
10
cD
>
()
o+---~--~--~--~--~--~--~--~--~--~--~--~--~--~~
o 2000 4000 6000 8000 10000 12000 14000
Output Circuit Impedance (Ohms) -includes receiver and wiring
Receiver Current Requirement Maximum Circuit Inpedance
(Receiver + Wiring)
6.5mA 2700 ohms
6.0mA 3000 ohms
5.0mA 3650 ohms
4.0mA 4650 ohms
3.0mA 6350 ohms
2.5mA 7200 ohms
1.25 mA 15,000 ohms
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 92
ModulePosition: _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(See System Layout)
Space Requirement: One position B2 or PB2. Cannot be installed
if City Box Transmitter module or Reverse Polarity Transmitter
SRA-550 Digital Alarm Communicator module is installed.
Transmitter (DACT) Interface Module Standby Current Draw: 10 mA
Alarm Current Draw: 30 mA
PCB PIN 940572 Assembly No. 976080 Output Voltage: +24 VDC @ 1.0 A
Publication Number 19700292
Issue 3, January 1997 Dimensions (Iwd): 3.5 x 4.625 X 1 inches
20-PIN CONNECTOR
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 93
SRA-550 SK5128 UL LISTED
TB1-l 24V _ Red 24 V, optional Relay COM COMMUNICATION CABLE _ _ UL LISTED PRIMARY
TBI-2 DCC - Black DCC TELCO STATION PROTECTOR
TBI-3 OPI SIG Alarm - Gray Fire Alarm SUPERVISED
TBI-4 OPI COM _ Violet Gnd UL LISTED PRIMARY
TBI-5 OP2 SIG Superv~ory - Yellow Supervisory TELCO STATION PROTECTOR
TBI-6 OP2 COM - Orange Gnd
TBI-15 OP7SIG Trouble - Blue Trouble LOCATED AT
TB1-16 OP7 COM -- Green Gnd BUILDING ENTRANCE
Optional Relay NC OF PROTECTED PREMISES
TBI-17 Fault liP - NOTE 10
UL LISTED
COMMUNICATION
CABLE
NOT SUPERVISED CONNECTTO SUPERVISED
I I RESTRICTED
ALL WIRING
CABINET
GROUND
NOTE; WITHIN
h
CABINET
2)
NOTE 7 II/ EARTH
~loOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOO~~ '-R
Fl l~[G]l~0
P1 DC POWER GROUND
'- BLAC
[===:JCXi=:::i 0; cJi ::;::C:;:;~:::::: C;<Dco-JO"lO'l-l=>- (.,;)1'0 ......
YELLO
P4
PROGRAMMING
TELCO #1 RING (j) +t-t+-'-=--,
omZlZ~Z~ ~~~~~ 0 0 0 a ~~
() 0 0 zllZI ORANG CABLE PIN 920245 (j) +HH---,
~.n
000 (") 00 - 0 - ...... TELCO #1 TIP
~:::
(NOT SUPPLIED) TO
~ ~
i
c 00
I 0 MODEL 5230 REMOTE
ANNUNCIATOR HOUSE #1TIP (j)
B r-
-J I GI
0> OJ
VIOLET
NOTES 6, 9
HOUSE #1 RING
(j)
BLUE P2
(j) +t-f--T"~""i
~
w"''
NC_ BLACK
0
0
0
0
910688
P3 AC MONITOR
HOUSE#2TIPI (j)
TELCO #2 TIP (j)
+t+--I-"'-"==-'
RED
TELCO #2 RING (j)-I+t+--'-'="'--
ALTERNATE
PHONE LINE
PIN 940572 NC
OPTIONAL NC -
SEE NOTE 11
COM RELAY TERMINALS
NOTE 6
NO L.J._"--_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _.....I
Figure 2. Wiring SRA-550 to SK5128 DACT Module. All circuits and connections are power limited/Class 2.
Wiring Notes (Figure 2): 9. Connect programming cable (available separately under
1 . Disconnect power before servicing the system. PIN 920245) to Model 5320 remote annunciator. This is a
2. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA temporary connection for programming only. Program the
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable SK5128 with the following functions:
notes. All circuits contained in this module are classified as a. Zone inputs-UNSUPERVISED
power limited/Class 2 and shall be installed to comply with b. Alarm Input-Active Low
N.E.C. Article 760, Part A and Part C. c. Trouble Input-Active Low
3. All conductors must be free of grounds. d. Supervisory Input-Active Low
4. Use wire gauge No. 14 to No. 18 AWG to connect to SRA-550 e. AC Failure-Active High (To prevent AC fail from activating,
Terminal TB1. leave the AC monitor terminals unconnected; AC failure will
5. Install jumpers to relay headers Hi through H7for desired relay be reported as a Trouble after specified delay).
operation (Normally-Open, N.O., or Normally-Closed, N.C.) 10. Circuits leaving the building must be connected to a UL listed
See Table 1. Connect relays to UL listed power limited source primary protector at the point the wiring exits the building.
suitable for fire protective signalling service. 11. Optional supervision of SK5128 can be incorporated by
6. See Publication Number 19700327, "AUTO CALL SK5128 connecting the relay output as shown in Figure 2 and
Digital Alarm Communicator Transmitter," for installation, programming the SK5128 for trouble reporting. This will report
wiring, and programming instructions. dialer trouble as well as system trouble. TheTFX control panel
7. Terminals TB1-7 through TB1-14 not used. must also be programmed to monitor input at Terminal 17 of the
8. Connect PL1, "Earth Tag," to PLiO, "Earth Ground Tag," on the SRA-550 module.
Main Processor board. See "AUTO CALL TFX-500/BOO Spare
Parts," Publication Number 19700260 or "AUTO CALL
TFX-500M/800M Spare Parts," Publication Number
19700373 for cable designation.
Table 1. SRA-550 Relay Operation; CONSYS default configuration (not user configurable).
RL1 H1 N.O. OIP Norm. OFF Gen. Purpose OIP ON188 Alarm All
RL2 H2 N.O. OIP Norm OFF Gen. Purpose O/P OS178 Supervisory All
RL7 H7 N.O. OIP Norm. OFF Gen. Purpose OIP OS221 Trouble All
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 94
Module Position: -:-:-_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(See System Layout)
Space Requirement: Firequest 30G-Large Enclosure, One
left-hand rail position X1 0-X15; Standard Enclosure, Side position
SK5128 Digital Alarm Communicator TFX-500/800: Door mount
TFX-500M/800M, TFX-500MV/800MV, DirecTone 500
Silent Knight Model 5128 Fire Slave Communicator Side position or one rear module space
PIN 910688 AL-1500 One rear module space
Input Voltage: 18-40 VDC (regulated, power limited)
Publication Number 19700327 Current Draw (standby): 143 mA max. with annunciator at-
Issue 3, January 1997 tached; 84 mA max. without annunciator attached
Current Draw (alarm): 227 mA max. with annunciator attached;
The SK5128 Digital Alarm Communicator Option PIN 910688 154 mA max. without annunciator attached
employs the Silent Knight Model 5128 Fire Slave Communicator. Watchdog Response Time: 50 seconds maximum
This unit features: Relay Rating: 1 A @ 24 VDC, 1A @ 24VAC
UL 864, NFPA 71 listing for Central Station Fire-Protective Dimensions (Iwh):
Signaling Systems service, UL 864; and NFPA 72 listing for Model 5128 (mounts inside Firequest 300 cabinet): 8-5/8 X 4 X
Remote Station Fire-Protective Signaling Systems and 1-3/8 inches
Proprietary Protected Premises. Mounting Hardware options:
@! Four channel inputs: fire alarm, system trouble, supervisory, (a) Velcro 1M strips (P/N 19240322/19240323-included)
user-configurable channel. (b) Five (5) 6-32 x 1/4 inch self-tapping screws (not
Can transmit information in 8 different formats included)-four for mounting, one for earth ground to cabinet.
Programmable two-number dialing with same or different
account codes and reporting formats.
Dual phone line monitor circuits; built-in dual phone It is necessary to have the Silent Knight Model 5128 Fire
iine-seizure circuit. Slave Communicator programmed with site-specific
English-language programming using Model 5230 Remote
information. Programming requires Silent Knight Remote
Annunciator.
ReaHime programmable 24-hour communicator test; lL\nnunciator ~,,1odel 5230 (Grinnell PIN 920157).
manual communicator test.
Power loss reporting. The AC report delay time can be Refer to Silent Knight Model 5128129 Fire Slave
programmed as 0 or in the range of 6-15 hours. Communicator Installation Manual (Silent Knight PIN
150805.
For NFPA 71 , AC report time must be 6-12 hours.
RED EARTH GROUND
1- P1 0 POWER 0 TROUBLE (/)
BLACK LED
DC POWER LED
YELLOW ~
Model SK5128 Fire Slave Communicator
ORANGE ~
P4 PROGRAMMING CABLE SILENT Grinnell PIN 910688 RED
RED
BROWN -
'--
KNIGHT PIN 130294 (INCLUDED) TO
MODEL 5230 REMOTE ANNUNCIATOR
Grinnell PIN 920157
GREEN
GRAY
VIOLET
BLUE
-
'"="
~
0 PHONE LINE 2
LED
0 PHONE LINE 1
LED
TELEPHONE
GRAY
BROWN
GREEN P2
YELLOW
ORANGE
RED
- CHANNEL INPUTS
CONNECTIONS
CD
BROWN
BROWN
CD GRAY
WHITE
BLACK
RELAY N.C.
RELAY COMMON
i=
1\
~
~~
P3 AC MONITOR HEADER
P4
~ Jumper Factory Instalied
RELAY TERMINALS
Do Not Remove 0 CD
GREEN
RED
DETAIL A
r---------------,I
~
ED
I GREEN~
I ~ I
I B-OW" I
I '-.....~IG~y" I
I ~~~~EN I
I I
I If only one phone line is used, place jumpers to corre- I
I sponding colored wire of the alternate phone line: Green-I
I to-green, red-to-red, gray-to-gray, brown-to-brown. I
L _______________ ~
Figure 1. Model SK5128 Fire Slave Communicator. All circuits and connections are power limitedlClass2.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 95
Telephone Requirements 4. The telephone company may make changes in its facilities,
1. If requested by the telephone company, the following informa- equipment, operations, or procedures that could affect the
tion must be provided before connecting this device to the operation of the equipment. If this happens, the telephone
phone lines: company will provide advance notice to allow you to make the
a. Manufacturer: Silent Knight Security Systems necessary modifications to maintain uninterrupted service.
b. Model Number: 5128 Table 1. Model SK5128 LED Indicators
c. FCC Registration Number: AC6USA-75160-AL-E
d. Ringer equivalence: 0.98 LED Color Description Normal Condition
e. Type of jack (to be installed by the telephone company):
RJ31 X. Yellow Trouble OFF
2. This device may not be directly connected to coin telephone or Green DC Power ON
party line services.This device cannot be adjusted or repaired
in the field. In case of trouble with the device, notify the Red Phone Line 1 OFF
installing company or return to: Red Phone Line 2 OFF
Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company
835 Sharon Drive
Westlake, Ohio 44145
(216)871-9900
3. If the Model 5128 causes harm to the telephone network, the
te!ephone company wi!! notify the user in advance that
temporary discontinuance of service may be required. If
advance notice is not practical, the telephone company will
notify the user as soon as possible. The user has the right to
file a complaint with the Federal Communications Commissi-
son if he or she believes it is necessary.
Red Power Non-resettable (Non-switched) +24 VDC. Red Telco #1 Ring Telco #2 Ring
P2 Channel Inputs Control Panel Connection Gray House #1 Tip House #2 Tip
Gray Fire Alarm Channel System Alarm pulldown (N.O.) Brown House #1 Ring House #2 Ring
Violet Circuit Ground Optional Relay Contacts (Rated at 1A @ 24 VDC, not supervised)
Orange Circuit Ground P4 Programmer Connection Connection to Silent Knight Model 5230 (tem-
porary, for programming and troubleshooting
only)
Red Undefined Alarm User Defined. Typically connects to another Yellow SKIN to Yellow, SK IN
Channel Supervisory Zone, Alarm/Supervisory Pull-
down.
P3 AC Monitor Control Panel Connection Red Annunc. Power to Red, Annunc. Power
White AC loss reporting AC Failure, Active High (+24 VDC) Brown Annunc. Ground to Brown, Annunc. Ground
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 96
(b) OPTION "A",
Fire Slave Communicator TYPICAL CONTROL PANEL
Model SK5128 INSTALLATION ON FRONT PANEL
(DOOR). EARTH GROUND TO
STUD ON DOOR. FOR TFX500/800
WIRING REFER TO
CASE SRA550 DIGITAL ALARM
COMMUNICATOR
TRANSMITTER INTERFACE
MODULE PUBLICATION
NO. 19700292
LINES
II
(c)
Firequest300 \. II---::l~
Standard Cabinet ~I PS I CF
DACT co""~rTII"'"
~~~;~~i~~~~~~~T~~i~ ~
(d) TFX-500M/BOOM
1
TFX-500MV/800MV AUTO CALL AL-1500, AL -1500E
REQUIRES THAT BAT I ~II Firequest 300
~cTone500
TERIES BE INSTALLED IN
I X31 Large cabine~ GI~CFI c::::i:I -
SEPARATE ENCLOSURE
G 1~I~wlm X1 1
~
SO THAT SK5128 WIRING
ON RIGHT HAND WALL
OF CABINET DOES NOT .---.=1 mm~lm X2 1
INTERFERE WITH NON- X151i mm~lm X3 1
POWER LIMITED WIRING.
Xi411 ~WWWI X41
BE]
EARTH GROUND TO CAB-
INETWALL X13 !I mmm~1 X5 I
X1211mmmmX61
J. X11 Ii XI 1 RELAY MODULE
MAKE SURE ALL WIRING
MAINTAINS SUFFICIENT OPTION "B" / / I X10 l i X8 1
CLEARANCE FROM ALL TYPICAL LARGE ENCLO- U U 1 X9 1
NON-POWER LIMITED SURE INSTALLATION ON
CIRCUITS NOTE 16 OPTION "A",
LEFT-HAND RAIL ~ ~ TYPICAL STANDARD ENCLOSURE INSTALLA-
TION ON RIGHT-HAND CABINET WALL. EARTH
GROUND TO CABINET GROUND STUD.
Figure 2. Typical mounting in AUTOCALL systems for the Model SK512B Fire Slave Communicator. (a) SK5128
mounting, (b) TFX-500/BOO application, (c) Firequest 300 application, (d) AL-1500 / AL-1500E, TFX-500M/BOOM,
TFX-500MV/BOOMV, or DirecTone 500 application.
Installation
1. Disconnect power and batteries from the control panel. 6. Connect wiring to 5128 Slave Communicator circuit board (see
2. Slide off the front face plate of the Model 5128 unit. Figure 3).
3. Carefully remove the circuit board from the Model SK5128 by 7. Connect Phone lines.
applying pressure to the sides of the module to release the 8. Connect the programming cable.
board from its holding slot. 9. Install the circuit board in the Model 5128 case. Be careful to
4. Mount the Model 5128 case in the control panel cabinet (see seat the board in its slot. Install the face plate.
Figure 2). 10. Install earth ground connection. Use rail mounting connection
a. Option "A" using four Velcro strips PIN 19240322 (hook)
1M of an adjacent board or dilll hole in Firequest 300 cabinet, clean
19240323 (nap). or sand paint for good connection, and use self-tapping screw.
b. Option "B"- Drill mounting holes in the control panel 11. Apply power.
cabinet. Mount the Model SK5128 case in the control panel 12. Program the Silent Knight Model 5128 unit. Refer to Silent
cabinet using four 6-32 x 114 inch self-tapping screws (not Knight Model 5128/29 Fire Slave Communicator Installation
included). Manual, Silent Knight Part Number 150805.
5. To enable optional auxiliary relay, install optional relay PIN 13. Disconnect programming cable from the Model 5128 unit.
17400078 on the Silent Knight Model 5128 circuit board (see 14. Perform communications test as applicable.
Figure 1). Observe correct orientation and polarity.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 97
SK5128 DIGITAL ALARM
COMMUNICATOR PIN 910688 NOTE 10
ULLISTED
NOTE 6 P1 DC POWER EARTH COMMUNICATION CABLE
GROUND SUPERVISED
SEETABLE2
NOTE 11 P4
PROGRAMMING CABLE (NOT SUPPLIED) TELCO #1 RING
PIN 920245 TO SEE TABLE 2 TELCO #1 TIP
MODEL 5230 REMOTE ANNUNCIATOR
P2 HOUSE #1 TIP
CHANNEL INPUTS TELEPHONE HOUSE #1 RING
NOTE 7 CONNECTIONS
RESTRICTED SEE TABLE 2 NOTE 8 HOUSE #2 RING
ALLWIRING g~~~~JRE 1, HOUSE #2 TIP
WITHIN P3 AC MONITOR
CABINET TELCO #2 TIP
SEE TABLE 2
NOT SUPERVISED tELCO #2 RING NOTE 1,
NOTE 9
SEE TABLE 2
I ~ I RELAY TERMINALS Zcr:
(J) NOT SUPERVISED ULLISTED 00
COMMUNICATION
CABLE
~&3
Wf-
00
SUPERVISED ucr:
--,"-
UJ
f-
~
NOTE 7
NOTE 12
Zcr:
00
~t5
~~
00
uct:
--,"-
UJ
f-
NOTE 13
100000000000000001 P2
900951.
SERIALD_ ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOP
TERMINA 0
TBI TB2
o
BLOCK
FOR EXTERNAL 0 o 0 0
CABLE 10 0 0 0 0 0 0
01
0 o 0 010 0 0 0 0 0 0 010 o 0 0 a 0 a 001
CONNECTION 000 0 0 0 0 o 0 0 0 0 0 o 0 0.0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0.0 o 0 0 a 0 0 _
A B C D E F G H I J K L M N 0 P ABC D E F G H I JKLMNOP
I~ ~ ~ ~I~
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 o 0 0 0 0 0 001
o 0 0 0 000 0 o 0 0 a 0 a .
TERMINAL
BLOCK TB3 TB4 0
FOR EXTERNAL 0
CABLE
CONNECTION
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNDP
P3 100000000000000001 P4
Figure 1. AfS-800 Expnasion Bus Cable Converter Board. All circuits and connections are power limited/Class 2.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 99
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 100
Module Position: _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(See System Layout)
Space Requirement: In TFX (TFX-SOO/BOO, TFX-SOOM/BOOM,
Network Interface Module TFX-SOOMVIBOOMV, DirecTone SOO), installs piggy-back to
MP-SOO Main Processor Board or TLB-S30,TFXnet Baseboard
PCB PIN 125-585-200
TU-530 Assembly 976165 Input Voltage: 24 V DC , +S VDC
TLX-500 Assembly 976121 Supervisory Current: 12S mA
Alarm Current: 12S mA
Fault Pulldown Output: Rated for +S V DC @ SO mA
Publication Number 19700344 Dimensions (fwd): 3.S x 4.6 x 1 inches
Issue 4, January 1997
The AUTO CALL network interface modules (TLI-S30 and Table 1. LED Designations
TLX-SOO) provide an interface for network connection for a variety
of applications. The TLI-S30 is used to connect networked TFX LED Function LED Function
control panels. The TLX-SOO is used with an XAI module to allow DS1 Processor Run DS4 Network Port L Receive
TFX-SOO control panels to communicate on Auotcall XA multiplex green (Normally ON) red (ON when receiving)
loops.
DS2 Network Ground Fault DS5 Network Port R Receive
Features yellow (Normally OFF) red (ON when receiving)
DS3 Network Port L Transmit DS6 Network Port R Transmit
Non-volatile memory and intelligent processor.
red (ON when transmitting) red (ON when transmitting)
Multiple "personality" configurations.
Most applications require no programming of the TLI-S30
other than setting switches and jumpers.
SEE DETAIL A
INSTALLATION NOTE 2 CONNECTION FOR OPTION BOARD
/ SEE INSTALLATION NOTE 4
TERMINAL BLOCKS
TBl ANDTB2
SEE TABLE 4
PL1 LK
TB2
12345
ggggg
A
00000 B
...--....
Jl'--_ _ _ _-,(.
2
1
LEDS
~ ~ IQ~~~~~~~~ ~:1
SEE TABLE 1
DSl 0
SWITCHES SW1
DS20
DETAIL A
3
1 2 3 4 5 DS40
00000 A 2
DS50
/ 0
LINK LKl
0000
0000
B
3
4
5
DS60 RESET
PUSH TO RESET
INSTALLED PROCESSOR
6 SW3
IN POSITION "B"
7
TBl
PL2 F Pl C'
10
T
1 P1A
C'
10
1
SEE TABLE 5 SEE INSTALLATION NOTE 3
Installation Notes: S. Connect field wiring as required for the application. Be careful
to observe correct polarity on all connections.
1. Disconnect power before servicing the system.
6. PL2 provides RS232 connection. Make cable connection as
2. Set switches and jumpers on network interface module.
required for the application (See Table S). Observe correct
3. For TFX application, install piggy-back to the MP-SOO Main
polarity and pin connections. May be used for temporary
Processor Board (PCB PIN 940500) or on TFXnet Baseboard,
connection to serial communication port of a PC for program-
TLB-S30 (PCB PIN 900962). Carefully match the 20-socket
ming the EEPROM of the module.
connector (P1, P1 A) on the network interface board to the 20
pins of PL7, remote network connector of the Main Processor Switch Settings
board or J2, J3 of TLB-530. Gently press the connectors
together until the stand-ofts snap into the holes in the lower Switches SW1 and SW2 Configure the module for a variety of
board. applications.
4. Connector J1 is provided for connection to an XA Interface For the TLX-500 TFX-to-XA interface application, only switches
Board, XAI (PCB PIN 900959) in TLX-SOO applications. Be 1-1, 1-2, 1-3; and 2-B are used. See Tables 2 and 3.
careful to observe correct polarity on cable connections.
For TLI-S30 TFXnet application, all switches are used.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 101
Table 2. Switch SW1 Designations NOTE THAT OFF =VALUE (1 =OFF, 0 = ON)
Switch Position Switch Position Switch Posi-
Application Network BAUD tion Network Topology
Rate
1-1 1-2 1-3 1-4 1-5 1-6 1-7 1-8
ON OFF OFF Not Used OFF OFF ON 19200 OFF OFF Redundant Star
Table 3. Switch SW2 and SW3 Designations. NOTE THAT Table 6. LK Header Configuration
OFF = VALUE (1 OFF, 0 ON) = =
Header LinkA Link B Header LinkA Link B
Switch SW2-1 through SW2-7 are Switch 2-8
binary address values (Value with 1 Network discon- Normal 4 Not Used Normal
nected; data sent Operation Operation
Switch OFF) to TB2-1-4
.. ..
::;witcil Value - Switch Vaiue i-'osition t-unction 2 Not Used Normal 5 Not Used Normal
Pos. (OFF) Pas. (OFF) Operation Operation
n f.1_J. I 1...,._-1 ". __ ~I
1 1 5 16 ON (i..Jormai
Operation)
TFXTTL Port I'WLU~"'U I"all ""~
Operation II
2 2 6 32 Ot-F RS232 Port
(PL2) Programming for Network Module Applications
3 4 7 64 Switch SW3 When used in TFXapplications, the MP-500 Main Processor needs
to be programmed for network interface module operation. Refer
4 8 Momentary Switch PUSH to to TFX-SOO/BOO CONSYS Programming Guide, Publication No.
RESET the board processor 850463 for complete programming information.
Table 4. Terminal Block Designations (Not Used in TLX-SOO Ap- For TFXnet Bridge application use Bridge Configurator Software
plication) PIN 976223. Refer to publication 19700404.
For other applications, the module itself needs to be programmed.
Terminal Function Terminal Function
For TLX-500 XA interface applications, use the TFX-to-XA Utility
TBI-1 +24 VDC IN (NOT TB2-1 RS-485 Net Port L+ Software Program; Refer to Publication No. 850514.
USED)
Wiring Notes TLX-500 Application (See Figure 1):
TBI-2 +5 VDC IN (NOT TB2-2 RS-485 Net Port L-
USED) 1. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable
TBI-3 DC Common IN TB2-3 SHIELD (See Wiring notes. All circuits contained in this module are classified as
(NOT USED) Note 6) power limited/Class 2 and shall be installed to comply with
TBI-4 +5 VDC OUT TB2-4 RS-485 Net Port R+ N.E.C. Article 760, Part A and Part C.
See Network Wir- 2. Disconnect power before servicing systems.
ing Note 9 3. All conductors to be free of grounds.
4. TB1 and TB2 Not used in XA interface application.
TB1-5 DC Common OUT TB2-5 RS-485 Net Port R-
See Network Wir-
5. TLX-500 application-Connect 26-conductor flat cable PIN
ing Note 9 8646-101 from J1 on the TLX-500 to J1 on the XA Interface
board. Observe correct orientation-the cable connectors are
TBI-6 Fault OUT keyed (pin 8 is plugged at each end). A pin/pin header adapter
TBI-7 G/P OUT (NOT (P/N 16400135) is required at the TLX-500 end of the cable.
USED) This is also keyed.
6. Connect PL 1, "Earth Tag,"to PL10, "Earth Ground Tag," on the
Table S. PL2 Pin Connector Configuration MP-500 Main Processor board. See "AUTOCALL
TFX-500/800 Spare Parts," Publication Number 19700260 or
Pin Designation Pin Designation "AUTO CALL TFX-500M/800M Spare Parts," Publication
Number 19700373 for cable deSignation.
1 Signal Common 4 RTS TO TLI-530 7. PL2 TLX-500 configuration connector (RS232) port connects
to the serial communications port of a personal computer via
2 Data IN 5 CTS FROM TLI-530 RJ-11 style connector. The connection is temporary for loading
3 Data OUT 6 (Not Used) of configuration data to the EEPROM of the TLX-500. You may
need to use a 9-pin-to-25-pin adaptor if the computer has a
2S-pin connector.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 102
FROM PREVIOUS TFXnet NOTE 7
TFX-500/800 PANEL
PL1
J1
SUPERVISED
POWER lIMITED/
CLASS 2
CABINET
GROUND
TO EARTH
GROUND
SUPERVISED
POWER LlMITED/
CLASS 2
CONNECTION TO MAIN PROCESSOR BOARD
NOTE 7 SEE INSTALLATION NOTE 3.
SHIELDS I I ,
NOTE6~ cl::::!::J PL1 i
TB2 J1
r" I ~
1
2
3
I I If
--
~
4
5
CABINET
GROUND
TO EARTH
GROUND
#----
I I
TO NEXT TFXnet
SHIELDJ
NOTE 6
SllPFRVISFn
POW-ER LIMITED/
CLASS 2
1
2
3
4
5
TFX-500/BOO PANEL 6
~
7
Pl2
Wiring Notes Network Application (See Figure 2): 7. Connect PL 1, "Earth Tag," to PL 10, "Earth Ground Tag," on the
1. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA TFX-500/800 Main Processor board or earth ground tags on
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable the TLB-530 baseboard. See "AUTOCALL TFX-500/BOO
notes. All circuits contained in this module are classified as Spare Parts," Publication Number 19700260 for cable desig-
power limited/Class 2 and shall be installed to comply with nation.
NEC. Article 760, Part A and Part C. 8. TU-530 fault pulldown output capable of sinking up to 75 rnA
2. Disconnect power before servicing systems. from TFX-500/800 panel 24-VDC power supply. Normal
3. All conductors to be free of grounds. condition is current sink. TU-530 fault condition opens the
4. Terminal biockTB1 wiring specifications-Use wire size No. 24 current sink. Typically used to energize an external relay coil.
to 12 AWG wire, solid or stranded. 9. The +5V output (+5Vand DC Common Out, TB1-4 and TB1-5)
5. TFXnet wiring specifications-Use good quality twisted, is only used to power TLD-530 Line Dirvers (Assembly No.
shielded pair wire. Maximum wiring distance between panels 976167, PCB PIN 920197). Refer to Publication 19700401 for
depends upon the TFXnet baud rate and physical properties of further information.
cable chosen. Wire parameters: 10. For the panels located at the end of a bus or spoke of a star, the
Maximum resistance", 75 ohms (all baud rates) network wiring should be termnated at the RS-485 Network
Maximum wire-to-wire capacitance: Port L (TB2-1, TB2-2). The unused Network Port R should be
Baud Rate Capacitance terminated with a UL listed end-of-line 120-ohm resistor (P/N
38400 0.3 f!F 976048.
19200 0.6 f!F
9600 1.2 f!F
2400 1.2 f!F
1200 1.2 f!F
Network cabling may share the same conduit as any other TFX
related fire alarm cabling. TFXnet cabling is power limited.
6. The shield for each network link should be tied to Earth Ground
at one end only. This is accomplished by landing one shield at
TB2-3 and then connecting another wire from TB2-3 to the
common chassis earth ground point
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 103
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience installing and testing fire detection
systems. These instructions do not purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment
described. Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection with installation,
operation, or maintenance. All specifications are subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems arise which are not covered
sufficientlyforthe user's purposes, the matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems
Company, Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 104
MODULE POSITION
(See System Layout)
Space Requirement: TFX-500/800 cabinet mounting: 1
position 83-85; 3800 System mounting: 1 rear module
XAI XA Interface Board space and 1 door module space (rear mount)
(for TLX-500 interface module application) Supervisory Current: 20 mA
PIN 900959, Assembly No. 976124 Alarm Current: 20 mA
Publication Number 19700345, Dimensions (whd): 5 13/16 X 35/8 X 3/8 inches
Issue 2, January 1997
Installation Notes
Description 1. Disconnect power before servicing the system.
The XAI Interface Board (PCB 900959) is used along with a 2. All wiring must be free of grounds.
TLX-500 network interface module (PCB 900958) to allow TFX 3. LEDs indicate point activity on the XA loop: Red, Alarm, nor-
(TFX-500/800, TFX-500M/800M, TFX-500MV/800MV, and Direc- mally OFF; Green, Normal, normally ON (the LEDs will
Tone 500), and AUTO CALL XA/TXA Input Module systems to appear to pulse with the sequential point activity).
communicate ..."ith each other using the the analog-addressable 4. Install board in cabinet using four 4-40 X 3/8 inch screws
loops ofthe TFX and the XA multiplex loops of the AUTO CALL sys- (supplied).
tem. 5. Connect 26-conductor fiat cable PIN 8646-101 from J1 on
the XA Interface board to J1 on the TLX-500 network inter-
Features face module. The cable connectors are keyed (pin 8 is
Up to 250 points (alarm/trouble combination) may be transferred plugged at each end). A pin/pin header adapter (P/N
from a TFX control panel to an XA/TXA Input Module (P/N 16400135) is required at the TLX-500 network interface
module end of the cable. This is also keyed.
5200-422).
Up to 250 XA commands may be used to activate TFX groups. For correct operation, this board must be connected to a
Field programming of the TLX-500 network interface module and TLX-500 network interface module that has been pro-
TFX-500/500M via a PC permits the offsite mapping of TFX grammed with system configuration information.
points to XA points and XA commands to TFX groups to meet
changing system requirements.
XA2 XA1
6-SIG 1-SHLD REMOVEABLE
7-REF 2-CLK TERMINAL BLOCK
8-CMD 3-CMD (2) 5-POSITION
9-CLK 4-REF
10--SHLD 5-SIG
00000
10 0 0 0 0 0 MOUNTING
FOUR (4) 4/40 x
3/8 INCH SCREWS
@)
3 o
0 0 ALARM W
c@
@)
c:::::: ~ o
000 NORMAL @
D
KEY IN POSITION 8
RIBBON CABLE CONNECTOR
TO TLX-500 NETWORK IN-
TERFACE MODULE
USE CABLE PIN 8646-101
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 105
NON-POWER LIMITED
SUPERVISED
NOTE 4
NOTES 5, 6, 7, 9
NOTES 5, 6, 7, 9
XA2 XA1
SIGNAL ---1~------' SIGNAL
REFERENCE CLOCK
COMMAND COMMAND
CLOCK REFERENCE
SHIELD SHIELD
WIRING NOTES 9. XA loop terminals are internally connected: 1-10, 2-9, 3-8,
1. Disconnect power before servicing system. 4-7, and 5-6. Loops may be connected in Style 4 or Style 6.
XA loops terminate at an XA/TXA Input Module (5200-422).
2. All conductors must be free of grounds. Refer to Publication No. MP-24.
3. All wiring is to be in accordance with N.E.C. (National Electri- 10. This drawing is typical only.
cal Code), local authorities, and applicable notes.
4. When installed to comply with N.E.C. Article 760, Part Aand
Part C, these circuits are classified as power limited. When
installed to comply with N.E.C. Article 760, Part A and Part
B, these circuits are classified as non-power limited. Maintain
at least 0.25 inch clearance from all power limited wiring with
cable ties or other permanent means.
5. Supervised Circuits. This document is written for skilled technicians with experience
6. Maximum loop resistance 100 ohms, maximum capacitance installing and testing fire detection systems. These instructions do not
1.5mF ( one conductor to all other conductors tied to shield). purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment described.
Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection
7. Circuit limitations: 24 VDC; normal supervision current is 250 with installation, operation, or maintenance. All specifications are
mA; maximum alarm current is 250 mA; frequency is 250 Hz, subject to change without notice.
ripple voltage 100%. Should further information be desired or should particular problems
8. Shields must be tied to DC Common only as shown on field arise which are not covered sufficiently for the user's purposes, the
wiring drawing (one end at control unit only). Must be free of matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company,
Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
grounds.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 106
Device Location _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(See System Layout)
Space Requirement: Two top or bottom ( or three center) 19-inch
by 5.5-inch rear module spaces
TFX-AutoPlex Control Panel Assembly
Input Voltage: 120/240 VRMS, 50/60 Hz (auto-ranging), 1.5 ARMS
Assembly No. 976096 Current Draw:
Supervisory Alarm
Publication Number 19700346 Mp500 Main Processor 200 rnA * 420 rnA*
Board
Issue 2, Revision A, May 1997
TLX500 Network Interlace 150 rnA 150 rnA
Board
The AUTOCALL TFX-AutoPlex Control Panel Assembly provides
a TLX-500 network interface board, XAI XA interface board, and XAI XA Interlace Module 20 rnA 20 rnA
MP-500 main processor board; powered by an RPS-424 power MPIM 19rnA 24 rnA
supply/battery charger. The MP-500 main processor board pro-
RPS424 Power Supply 100 rnA 100 rnA
vides for two 99-device analog-addressable loops. The TLX-500
and XAI allow the TFX-500 to communicate with an XA/TXA Input LCD backlight 150 rnA (keyswitch ON) 150 rnA (keyswitch ON)
Module PIN 5200-422 over the standard Autocall XA multiplex
loop. * Rrefer to Publication No. 19700247.
Dimensions (Iwh): 11.75 X 19 X 3.5 inches
Front Panel Assembly provides local alarm and/or trouble annunci-
ation for 16 zones (LCD display). It provides internal buzzer and
80-character (4-line X 20 characters) LCD message display. The
touch-pad provides for service and diagnostic operation.
(a) PLB - - - - - - - , ; ; : r - - - . . J
IJDC/DC POWER
mACiDC POWER
(b)1 .1 _____ -- -- _I. I
~D-
- ---- - -~ ----
lJ PL5 MAIN PROCESSOR
BOARD
I
- - ---:
- ~
I
. I
e
XAI
XA
eND C1L) GO c::YS3 INTERFACE [
MODULE
DELETE ENTE
900959
o
POWER (l) c=J QUIT
@ c=J IFAST eel
(I) @ ACCESS
----- - ----.
r - - - - - - - - - -
NOTE 6
TFX-AutoPlex CONTROL PANEL
SUB-PLATE REQUIRES (A) TWO
TOP MODULE SPACES, OR (B)
TWO BOTTOM MODULE SPACES.
Figure 1. TFX-AutoPlex Control Panel Assembly (a) Panel sub-plate
assembly, (b) Sub-plate spacing in control panel cabinet.
Installation Notes: Installation Guide, Publication No. 850462 or TFX-500M/
1. Disconnect power and batteries before servicing system. BOOM Operator's Manual and Installation Guide, Publication
2. Install TFX-AutoPlex Control Panel Assembly to the cabinet No. 850515.
rails. g. XA/TXA Input Modules and programming, refer to Publica-
3. Refer to the following publications for individual module tion No. MP-24.
specifications and application information: 4. Connect field wiring
a. RPS-424 Power Supply/Battery Charger Installation Guide, 5. Program the modules (Refer to the following publications:
Publication No. 19700323. TFX-500/BOO CONSYS Programming Guide, Publication No.
b. MP-500 Main Processor Board Installation Guide, Publica- 850463; TFX-AutoPlex Configuration Utility Software Manual,
tion No. 19700247. Publication No. 850514.
c. MPIM Installation Guide, Publication No. 19700235. 6. All ribbon cables and their applications are listed in Publication
d. TLX-500 Network Interface Board Installation Guide, Publi- Number 19700260, "Autocall TFX-500/BOO Spare Parts" or
cation No. 19700344. Publication Number 197002373, "Autocall TFX-500M/BOOM
e. XAI XA Interface Module Installation Guide, Publication No. Spare Parts."
19700345.
f. TFX-500/500M analog-addressable loop ancililary mod-
ules, refer to TFX-500/BOO Operator's Manual and
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 107
TO STANDBY BATTERIES
SUPERVISED NON-POWER LIMITED
o o
DETAIL "A"
o OttC/DC POWER
.t PL5
YELLOW MAIN
AC/DC POWER
PROCESSOR MODULE
940500
BLACK
,
~~i910l :,:18~/24V
POWER LIMITED
TFX-500 SR -
SR + 8
ADDRESSABLE BL - '" ",8
LOOP CIRCUITS SL +
ff~
AR - TO LIB BOARD
NOTES 4,5 AR + J1 XAI XA
-- INTERFACE
AL-
AL+ 8 MODULE TOXA
EARTH LOOPS
GROUND ., 900959 NON-POWER
KEYED
"DETAIL A" PIN 8 LIMITED
:'" SUPERVISED
~~
0
LOCAL BUS
NOTE 4 TB1 o
o
NOTE 4
j! / 0 ~
' 0 CO',"CHO'
NOTE 4
l TB2
0
0
e
0
0
0
0
III
e
0
0
0
0 J1
PL2
2~26
1 25 0
00'000 00000000
KEYED
PIN 8
TLX-500 LIB
LINE INTERFACE BOARD
~ P1 0
900958
0
DETAIL "Pi.'
AC POWER MODULE TO PROCESSOR BD WIRING
POWER SUPPLY
(DC COMM)
(+24V) 53
J1
1===;~==1t==t
0-
CABLE ASSEMBLY 19600206
~~~CESSOR BO
1
2
PL5
TB1 0 DO 0
9 I (BATT MON) 8 0-1---"""':"""1:.--++--+ 4
(AC OK) 4 5
TO MP BOARD PL7 (GND FAULT) 6 6 (NO CONNECTION)
, TB1-2
CABLE SEE TABLE 1,
H'~',:; :f;
Figure 2.
Wiring connections for TFX-AutoPlex Control Panel Assembly
Wiring Notes: (mutual); maximum line inductance 1.5 millihenry (total);
1. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code (NEG), maximum continuous distance 6500 feet. Use shielded wire
NFPA 70, state, and local building code requirements and pair that allows for these parameters. Connect shield to the
applicable notes. All circuits contained in this module are common shield connection point that is connected to DC
classified as power limited and shall be installed to comply with Common of the main power supply,
NEC Article 760, Part A and Part C. 6. Connect XA loop wiring to XA/TXA Input Module PIN
2. Disconnect power before servicing the system. 5200-422. Refer to Publication MP-24. Maximum line resis-
3. All conductors to be free of grounds. tance 100 ohms; maximum line capacitance 1.5 microfarad
4. Refer to the following publications for individual module wiring (one conductor to all other conductors tied to shield). Connect
and application information: shield to DC Common only as shown on applicable Autocall
a. RPS-424 Power Supply/Battery Charger Installation Guide, 3800 System field wiring drawing.
Publication No. 19700323. 7. Connect 26-conductor flat cable PIN 8646-101 from J1 on the
b. TFX-500/800 Main Processor Board Installation Guide, TLX-500 board to J1 on the XAI interface board. Observe
Publication No. 19700247. correct orientation-the cable connectors are keyed (pin 8 is
c. MPIM Installation Guide, Publication No. 19700235. plugged at each end). A pin/pin header adaptor (P/N 16400135
d. TLX-500 network interface Installation Guide, Publication is required at the TLX-500 end of the cable. This is also keyed.
No. 19700344. 8. Connect PL1 "Earth Tag" on the TLX-500 to PL 10 "Earth Tag"
e. XAI XA Interface Module Installation Guide, Publication No. on the Main Processor Board.
19700345.
5. Connect TFX-500 addressable loops (2-way data circuits) to
Main Processor board terminals TB2-1-8. Maximum line
resistance 75 ohms; maximum line capacitance 0.5 microfarad
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 108
9. PL2 TLX-SOO configuration connector (RS232) port connects "Enabled." Set "Outgoing Zonal Alarm Status to Sub-net"
to the serial communications port of a personal computer via and "Outgoing Zonal Trouble Status to Sub-net" to Dis-
RJ-11 style connector The connection is temporary for loading abled."
of configuration data to the EEPROM of the TLX-SOO. You may (S) Leave"Network String Fetch" as "all."
need to use a 9-pin-to-2S-pin adaptor if the computer has a (6) Leave "NET Module Parameters" as default settings.
2S-pin connector. (7) Leave "NET Module Fault Reporting as all "Enabled."
Table 1. TLX-500 PL2 Pin Connections and Cable Connector c. Program LBus, RBus, and 10 information
Equivalents d. Program Groups, Zones, Addressable Loops.
e. Program other system functions.
TELCO 089 Connector 0825 Connector 2. Program the TLX-SOO for TFX-AutoPlex Configuration data
transfer using TFX-AutoPlex Configuration Utility Software
Pin 2 (Data IN) Pin 3 Pin 2
(Refer to TFX-AutoPlex Configuration Utility Software Manual,
Pin 3 (Data OUT) Pin 2 Pin 3 Publication No. 8S0S14.
a. Create the TFX-AutoPlex data file using the software utility.
Pin 1 (Signal Common) Pin 5 Pin 7
b. Tranfer the data to the TLX-SOO using a PC and
10. Refer to Figure 3 for correct wire routing to maintain separation communications program.
of power limited from non-power limited system wiring. All (1) Connect Cable to PL2 on the TLX-SOO board. Connect
power limited wiring must maintain separation of at least 0.2S the cable to a PC (use an adaptor if necessary).
inches by means of wire ties or other permanent means. (2) Set TLX-SOO switches: SW1-1 OFF (OPEN), SW1-2
ON (CLOSED), SW1-3 OFF (OPEN), SW2-8 ON
Programming Notes (CLOSED).
1. Program the TFX MP-SOO Main Processor using CONSYS (3) Set up your communications program for: 1200 Baud, no
. (refer to TFX-500/BOO CONSYS Programming Guide, Publi-
parity, 8-bit word, 1 stop bit.
cation No. 8S0463.
(4) Use communications software to transfer the configura-
a. Program "System Type."
tion data file to the TLX-500. (The yellow LED on the
b. Program "LNet" information
TLX-500 will be ON for this operation)
(1) Select "HBus Parameters", ("TFXnet")
(S) After successful transfer, set SW1-3 to ON (CLOSED)
(2) "Sub-net Map"-set "0" for "own address,"
and press S'vV3 on the iLX-500 to RESET.
with all other addresses as "5" for "sub-net node."
(3) Set "Incoming Logging of Broadcasted Sub-net Events" Panel Operation
as "Enabled." During normal operation the panel needs no operator intervention.
(4) Set "Outgoing Broadcast of Events to SUb-net" to
POWER LIMITED
MAINTAIN 0.25 AUTOCALL BACKBOX:
INCH SEPARATION 8099-510, -511, -512.
TFX-500j800 ANALOG-AD- -513, -514
DRESSABLE LOOPS AND /
OTHER FIELD WIRING TO MAIN ~--~----------~
PROCESSOR BOARD ACINPUT
POWER LIMITED NON-POWER
LIMITED
XALOOPS
NON-POWER
o
LIMITED
o
BATTERY
WIRE BEHIND MOUNT-
ING PLATES
Figure 3. TFX-AutoPlex typical wire routing to maintain 0.25 inch NON-POWER LIMITED
separation of power limited and non-power limited wiring.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 109
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience installing and testing fire detection
systems. These instructions do not purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment
described. Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection with installation,
operation, or maintenance. All specifications are subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems arise which are not covered
sufticientlyforthe user's purposes, the matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems
Company, Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 110
MODULE POSITION
(See System Layout)
Space Requirement: 1 rear module space and 1 door module
space (rear mount) for 4-inch deep cabinet
Input Voltage: +24 Voc Nominal
AUTOCALL TFX-XA Interface Module Current Requirements: 100 mA for TFX-XA Interface Module
Assembly PIN 976382 PCB 900997 (150 mA with Expansion Board) plus 1 mA for each XA transmitter
TFX-XA Expansion Board address and 1 mA for each XA receiver address
Assembly PIN 976383 PCB 900998
Maximum XA Loop Resistance per wire = 100 ohm. Maximum Ca-
Publication Number 19700476 pacitance 2.0 mf line-to-line or line-to-ground.
Issue 1, Revision A, May 1997 Dimensions with Loop Exp. Bd. (hwd): 5.25 X19 X 2 inches
TFX-XA Interface Module PIN 976382
The AUTOCALL TFX-XA Interface Module allows a TFX address- TFX-XA Intertace Module with optional TFX - XA Ex
able loop to "speak" to XA addressable devices. The TFX-XA PIN 976382 pansion Board PIN 976383
Interface Module supports connection to six TFX addressable Battery Requirements:
loops: three TFX loop interface circuits are contained on-board and Standby Current 100* 150* mA
three TFX loop interface circuits can be added via a plug-in option
Alarm Current 100* 150* mA
module. These six loops can provide enough TFX addressable
loop points to map the 255 XA input devices and 255 command * Plus 1 mA for each XA transmitter address and 1 mA for each XA receiver address
points which may reside on an eXisting XA loop. A configurator is Addressable loop Currents:
required to set up the mapping and functionality of the module (for
Input Device Output Device mA
more information see "Operation").
Ident. Current 3.0 - 4.0 16.2 -19.9 mA
The TFX loops will normally be dedicated to the TFX-XA Interface
Module connection, but this is not a requirement. The TFX-XA In- Normal Condition 4.7 - 7.5 Operated: 4.4 - 6.5 mA
Not operated: 2~O - 4.4
terface Moduie oniy responds to those TFX ioop addresses for
which it has been configured. OtherTFXdevices may be placed on Fault/Invalid Condition 3.0 - 4.7 Greater than 6.5 mA
the TFX loop as long as there are addresses available. Alarm Current 7.5 - 20 -- mA
The multiple TFX loops do not need to come from the same TFX Addressable loop Load:
panel. Unused loop addresses may be used by other devices. Each TFX-XA TFX Loop Circuit is equivalent to 20 Unit Loop Loads (See "TFX Addressable Loop
Circuit Load" section on page 3 for sample calculation.)
TFX-XA Expansion Board PIN 976383
The optional TFX-XA Expansion Board increases the capability of
the TFX-XA Interface Module to six TFX TFX addressable loops.
(a) XA LOOP
TERMINAL
TFX TERMINAL
BLOCK
BLOCKS
TFX ADDRESSABLE
~.H-+---OO- i~rf:INAL
BLOCKS
000
GENERAL PURpOSE
XASTYLE 4/6 OPEN COLLECTOR
TFX ADDRESSABLE LOOP OUTPUTS
JUMPER INDICATORS
SEE TABLE 2
(b) o o 0
TFX ADDRESSABLE LOOP
TERMINAL
BLOCKS
J1 L . I_ _---I TFX-XA Expansion ~ iii
Board I~ f-
I PIN 900998
ASSEMBLY 976383
I~
I~ ~
CONNECTOR ~---a:lT'+-- TFX ADDRESSABLE LOOP
TO
TFX-XA INTERFACE INDICATORS
MODULE
o
OS130S140S150S16 OSH OS18
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 111
DOOR MODULES: EXPANSION MOTHERBOARD
WITH ALXMs AND DCPM
FCM MODULE, OOM MODULE, 16 INDICATOR MODULE, 80 INDI-
POWER-LIM ITED
CATOR MODULE, 40 STATUS CONTROL MODULE, 40 X 2 INDI-
CAOTR MODULE, 16 STATUS CONTROL MODULE', MPIM
ALL POWER-LIMITED
: : I
MAIN PROCESSOR
BOARD
POWER-LIMITED
D:I
POWER-LIMITED
~-----I
POWER-LIMITED
POWER-LIMITED
XA LOOPS AND OTHER
FIELD WIRING
NONPOWER-LiMITED
NONPOWER-LiMITED
NON POWER-LIMITED
AC INPUT NON-
POWER-LIMITED STANDBY
BATTERY
STANDBY
BATTERY o
/
BATTERY WIRING TO AUXILIARY
CABINET MUST BE IN CONDUIT
~ o
o
OPTIONAL AUXILIARY STANDBY STANDBY
BATTERY CABINET BATTERY BATTERY
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 112
.,
o
NON POWER
520~516 B
LIMITED
D { ) TFX LOOP CIRCUITS
NONPOWER POWER SUPPLY GOWER LIMITED/CLASS 2
LIMITED
NONPOWER
LIMITED
STANDBY STANDBY
BATTERY BATTERY
., .,
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 113
TFX-XA INTERFACE MODULE TFX-XA EXPANSION BOARD
(a) PIN 976382 PIN 976383
T81
PL110
1~D~
0000
o DS2
STAND OFF
6 PLACES
~
I 2 I JUMPERLlNK00
STYLE 4 (CLASS B)
OPERATION
~
(b)
STAND OFF
TFX-XA INTERFACE TFX-XA Expansion Board 6 PLACES
MOUNTING MODULE P/N976383 ~
PLATE PIN 976382
..".",- MOUNTING
,/ SCREWS
"M............M..........~~..II~__~4PLACES
J-__. .~. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Figure 4. TFX-XA Interrace Module with TFX-XA Expansion Board (a) Top View, (b) Side View.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 114
TFXAddr. POWER CONNECTIONS
SEE NOTE 11
NONPOWERLlMITED Loop
Number 4 +24 V DCC Gn~~.p
DETECTION
k
Shield INPUT
SHIELD CABLE PIN 976291
FOR COMMISSIONING
Note 6
!oC p
NOTE 6
TFX-XA Interface a
TBl 0- -
'---
.--- -D
2~DIN
o XA
CMDOUT
nPL1
Module
----;;:::
TB2
~
- - 0
XA
ClKIN Board
Number4
~ -TB L- TFXAddr.
Loop
Jl ~ L+ Number 1
XA L+
a
- - o ClKOUT
a L- r==
L-
Shield
TFXAddr. L+
9 SHlD Loop TBS a L+ TFXAddr. Note 6
Number 5 a L- Loop
L- TB4 Number 2
..n :FIN '=== a -----j t-- L+
a L+ ~
L-
o ~FOUT L-
o SHLD
XA III!i1I J2
II TFXAddr.
Loop
Number 6
TB9
a
a
a
L+
L- TBS
c==
L+
TFXAddr.
L- Loop
Shield
Note 6
- L+ Number 3
.n SIG IN
~
~
L-
XA
..n SIG OUT r==
PD#2
PD#1 PULLD OWN (2)
TB6
~ SHLD COM
'-
I ~ ~~OTE:
SHIELD JUMPER INSTALLED FOR STYLE 4
XA LOOP OPERATION
I NOTE 6
NONPO'vVER~LiivjITED
Figure 5. Typical System Wiring for TFX-XA Interface Module and Expansion Board.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 115
fable 2. Connectors Operation
The TFX-XA Interface Module performs mapping between XA loop
Jumper Function Connector Operation
devices and TFXaddressable loop addresses. The XA devices can
TFX-XA Interface Module only signal three states: normal, alarm, and fault. The fault signal
J1 Expansion Board Con- Connects to Expansion is the same as "no response."
nection Board Jl
TFX devices use analog signaling. On the TFX-XA Interface Mod-
J2 XA Class A Jumper Jumper ON XA Loop Style 4 ule, XA devices mapped to a TFX addressable loop will "look like"
Jumper OFF (NORMAL) XA Loop Style 6 IXA-500CM Contact Monitoring Modules for input and
OXA-500RM Addressable Relay Modules for output.
PL1 RS232 Communications Connects to PC for Pro- Pin Outs:
gramming
1 Ground
When a mapped XA input signals ALARM, the associated "CM" sig-
Programming Cable nals an ALARM condition.When the XA signal restores, the "CM"
2 RS232 RXD
PIN 976291
(Baud = 1200, no parity,
3 RS232TXD condition current is returned to normal. If an XA address indicates
4 Not Used
8 bits, 1 stop)
5 Not Used
FAU LT, the "CM" does not report-this generates a "No Response"
6 Ground Fault at the TFX control panel.
Expansion Board An output command from the TFX is mapped to the XA Command
addresses. Activating the associated TFX device will cause the
J1 TFX-XA Interface Mod- Connects to TFX-XA In-
ule Connection terface Module J1 mapped XA Command to become active. When the TFX output is
restored, the associated XA Command will be restored_
Table 3. Terminals Table 4. Indicators
Terminal Function II Terminal Function
Indication
TFX-XA Interface Module
TB1-1 XA Command In TB3-1 TFX Channel 1 Loop In + I Hed LED '1 0 N when Class A relay Is acilvated
(a) Shunt is installed on J2
In~ Relay closes due to problem on XA
TB1-2 XA Command Out TB3-2 TFX Channell Loop In -
,.... vl"
TBI-5 XA Clock Out TB4-1 TFX Channel 2 Loop In + DS3 Red LED ALARM: OFF
ON during for ALARM condition at an XA
TBI-6 XAShield TB4-2 TFX Channel 2 Loop In - loop address.
Main Processor RAM Failure:
TBI-7 XACOM TB4-3 TFX Channel 2 Loop Out + ON steadily with DS6
- _.. , ~---- -. Main Processor ROM Failure:
TBI-8 XA Reference In TB4-4 TFX Channel 2 Loop Out - Blinking ON with DS6
TBI-9 XAShield TB5-1 TFX Channel 3 Loop In + OS4 Green LED Normal Mode: ON
ON for NORMAL operation of TFX-XA
TB1-l0 XASignalln TB5-2 TFX Channel 3 Loop In Interface Module
TB1-11 XA Signal Out TB5-3 TFX Channel 3 Loop Out + Configure Mode:
Blinks when module is in Configure Mode
TB1-12 XAShield TB5-4 TFX Channel 3 Loop Out -
OS5 Yellow LED Normal Mode: OFF
TB2-1 +24 Voc TB6-1 PD#2 External Pulldown #2 Blinking ON indicates configuration data er-
ror.
TB2-2 +24 Voc TB6-2 PD#1 External Pulldown #1 Configuration Mode:
Blinking ON indicates configuration data
TB2-3 DCC TB6-3 COM External Relay Common being loaded.
TB2-4 OCC DS6 Red LED XACommand: OFF
ON during activation of an XA Command
TB2-5 EGND Ground Detection Input
Main Processor RAM Failure:
Expansion Board ON steadily with OS3
Main Processor ROM Failure:
TB7-1 TFX Channel 4 Loop In + TB9-1 TFX Channel 6 Loop In + Blinking ON with OS3
TB7-2 TFX Channel 4 Loop In - TB9-2 TFX Channel 6 Loop In - DS7, DS9, Green LED Flashes when TFX scans addressable OFF
OS11,OSI3", loop address "0"
TB7-3 TFX Channel 4 Loop Out + TB9-3 TFX Channel 6 Loop Out + DSI5', DSI7*
TB7-4 TFX Channel 4 Loop Out - TB9-4 TFX Channel 6 Loop Out - OS8, OSlO, Yellow LED TFX-XA inter-processor communications OFF
OSI2,OSI4', fault
TB8-1 TFX Channel 5 Loop In + OSI6',OSI8'
TB8-2 TFX Channel 5 Loop In - LSI Buzzer Turns on during ALARM or FAULT OFF
TB8-3 TFX Channel 5 Loop Out + 'On the Expansion Board
TBB-4 TFX Channel 5 Loop Out -
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 116
Notes for Programming the TFX Control Panel Using You transfer a configuration file (*.BIN) to the TFX-XA Interface
CONSYS Module by loading it through an RS232 port on the TFX-XA
The TFX control panel(s) must be programmed so that the XA de- Interface Module. Use an RJ-to-OB9 or RJ-to-OB25 communica-
tions cable. Connect the RJ connector to the PL1 connector on the
vices are mapped to corresponding TFX TFX addressable loop
TFX-XA Interface Module. See Figures 6 and 7 . Connect the OB9
addressed "pseudo CM" and "pseudo RM" devices. Refer to Publi-
or OB25 to a serial communication port on your PC.
cation 850463, TFX-500IBOO CONSYS Programming Guide.
To program the AL to TFX addressable loop Translator Module:
1. XA Command points are programmed as OXA-500RM Ad-
dressable Relay Modules. In CONSYS, select the Panel, Loop,
and Address for each point that is mapped from an XA CABLE
Command Point. Select OXA-500RM as the "device type." 6pinTEL- PIN 976291
2. XA Signal points are programmed as IXA-500CM Contact J=~ CO
Monitoring Modules. In CONSYS, select the Panel, Loop, and \ Pin 1
Address for each point that is mapped from an XA Signal Point. Pin 6
Select IXA-500CM as the "device type." Female DB9
9
PROGRAMMING CABLE
PIN 976291
D
TFX-XA INTERFACE MODULE PC RUNNING ''WINDOWS TERMI
(WITH OPTIONAL EXPANSION NAL" OR "HYPER TERMINAL"
MODULE)
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 117
Entering the TFX-XA Interface Configuration Mode
RJ11 OB9 OB25
TELCO (Computer COM Port) (Computer COM Port) 1. Connect communications cable from PC to the TFX-XA
Interface Module PL 1.
Pin 2 Pin 3 Pin 2 2. Set Switch SW1-S1 to CLOSED (ON) to enable Configuration
Mode.
Pin 3 Pin 2 Pin 3
3. Press the TFX-XA Interface Module Reset button SW2.
Pin 1 or 6 Pin 5 Pin 7
Sending a Configuration File to the TFX-XA Interface
Module
Set Up Communications Program 1. Make sure the TFX-XA Interface Module is in Configuration
Mode.
To send files to or receive files from the TFX-XA Interface Module,
your communications program (Windows Terminal, Procomm, 2. Enter the communications program (Windows Terminal, Win-
CrossTalk) must be set to the following parameters: dows HyperTerminal, or other communications program).
3. Select the Xmodem protocol.
Baud Rate 1200
Parity None 4. Enter the name of the file be sent. This must be the binary file
Word Size a-bit that was written by the XLTCFG program.
Stop Bits 1
No hand-shaking (flow control) As the file is loading, the Yellow Configure LED (OS5) flashes. This
may take some time as the proper Xmodem protocol must be
These parameters are sometimes selected together and abbrevia- negotiated between the PC and the TFX-XA Interface Module.
ted '1200 N81'.
As soon as the file is received, the TFX-XA Interface Module
terminates the Xmodem transaction and the communications
program will indicate a successful transfer. The TFX-XA Interface
will then write the new configuration into EEPROM. This process
can take several seconds. The yellow LED (OS5) will remain ON
steadily during this process. Do not do anything until the LED goes
off.
After the yellow LED goes OFF, you may return to normal
operation, re-send the file, or read the XLTCFG Configuration file
back into the PC to verify the transfer operation.
The procedure for receiving a file is the same as for sending, except
that you choose the receive option in the file transfer package.
1. Make sure the TFX-XA Interface Module is in Configuration
Mode.
2. Enter the communications program (Windows Terminal, Win-
dows HyperTerminal, or other communications program).
3. Select the Xmodem protocol.
4. Enter the name of the file be received.
Important: Because of the way the communications program
works, there may be a couple of timeouts when the
file transfer begins. Eventually, the transfer will take
place.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 118
You may now return to normal operation, send a file to the TFX-XA
Interface Module, or re-read the XLTCFG configuration file. This document is written for skilled technicians with experience
installing and testing fire detection systems. These instructions do not
Returning to Normal Operation purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment described.
Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection
After transferring files to or from the TFX-XA Interface Module, the with installation, operation, or maintenance. All specifications are
subject to change without notice.
TFX-XA Interface Module must be returned to normal operation
for it to function with the TFX. Should further information be desired or should particular problems
arise which are not covered sufficiently for the user's purposes, the
1. Set switch SW1-S1 to OPEN (OFF) for Normal Operation matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Company,
Mode. Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
P125A
P045R
P205T
C100A
C100R
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 119
Module Position: _ _ _~=======
(See System Layout)
Space Requirement: One module space piggy-back to
MP-500 Main Processor Board at PL7
TLA-530 TFXnet Adaptor Board Supervisory Current: OmA
PCB PIN 900970 Assembly No. 976169 Alarm Current: OmA
Dimensions (Iwd): 3.5 X 4.6 X 0.75 inches
Publication Number 19700378
Issue 2, January 1997
o o
CONNECTOR
FOR CABLE TLA-530
PIN 19600150 1 J2 2 PCB PIN 900970
.. [/"!"":"'fl
U
POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2
19 20 TLA-530
o
o 1
J1
I
CD 1
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 121
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience installing and testing fire detection
systems. These instructions do not purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment
described. Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection with installation,
operation, or maintenance. All specifications are subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems arise which are not covered
sufficientlyforthe user's purposes, the matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems
Company, Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 122
Module Position: _ _ _~~=~~~~=
(See System Layout)
Space Requirement: TFX-500 Cabinet-B3
TLB-530 TFXnet Baseboard TFX-800 Cabinet (0 loops)-PB3
PCB PIN 900962 Assembly No. 976168 TFX-500M/800M Cabinet-Dne-half module space
--- - -- - - ----
POWER LlMITED/CLASS 2 2 , ,
3 , , ,
, , CONNECTION FOR
'DAISY CHAINING"
4 ' , ,
HBUS CONNECTOR
5q J2
1
o , ,
, , J3 0
HUB APPLICATION
1
CABLE PIN 19600150 OR , ,
DIASY CHAIN HUB , ,
SUPERVISED
TLB-530
PCB PIN 900962 , ,
POWER LlMITED/CLASS 2 , ,
, ,
, ,
, , ,
, ,
0,
,
o ,
,
,
, o o
TFX JP1, , ,
BRIDGE , ,
W
JP2,
, ,
H
JP3,
0 , ,
CONFIGURATION
SELECTOR JUMPER
0
LINKS
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 123
=
=
=
=1
TLI-S30
FPOWER
LIMITED
~"." Jt.~~1~~-;-~-~~~1i---
SUPPLY BAITERY
CHARGER
,l)UI
POWER SUPPLY '\. POWER LIMITED
?,----~'----:IIn
Ir POWER liMiTED ...----Trl
FPOWER
~~"T
Figure 2. Typical installations (a) TFX-800M control panel cabinet (b) TFX-500 control panel cabinet
(c) remote auxiliary cabinet.
Installation Notes: d. Install two TLI-530 modules (PCB PIN 900958 refer to
Publication No. 19700344) by carefully matching the
1 . Disconnect power before servicing the system. 20-socket connector to the 20-pin connector J2 or J3 on the
2. Set switches and jumpers on TLI-530 board that will be TLB-530. Gently press the connectors together until the
mounted to the TLB-530 Baseboard. stand-ofts snap into the holes in the TLB-530 board.
3. Mount TLB-530 in the panel using hardware provided. e. Connect Earth Ground Tab on the TLI-530 boards to J4 and
4. TFXnet Remote Signalling Application (See Figure 3): J5 on the TLB-530. Connect a wire from TB1-5 (EGRND)
a. Install TLB-530 in cabinet. to the common chassis earth ground point.
b. install jumper link in J1 for "TFX" configuration. f. Install connections for TFXnet sub-loop communications to
c. Install TU-530 (PCB PIN 900958 refer to Publication No. TLI-530 modules, Channel A and Channel B. Note: When
19700344) and Remote Signalling Option board (CEB-500 programming in CONSYS, Channel = Port L; Channel B =
PCB PIN 940524 refer to Publication No. 19700249, Port R.
CVB-500 PCB PIN 940525 refer to Publication No. g. Connect +24 V to TB1-1 and DC Common to TB1-3.
19700250, SRA-550 PCB PIN 942572 refer to Publication 6. Hub Network Configuration (See Figure 5):
No. 19700292) by carefully matching the 20-socket connec- a. Install TLB-530 in cabinet.
tor to the 20-pin connector J2 or J3 on the TLB-530. Gently b. Install jumper link in J3 (remove link from J1, J2) for Hub
press the connectors together until the stand-ofts snap into configuration.
the holes in the TLB-530 board. The TU-530 and remote c. Configure the TLI-530 modules for "Hub" operation (refer to
signalling option board may be installed in either location on Publication No. 19700344).
the TLB-530. d. Install two TU-530 modules (PCB PIN 900958 refer to
d. Connect Earth Ground Tab on the TLI-530 and Remote Publication No. 19700344) by carefully matching the
Signalling Option board to J4 and J5 on the TLB-530. 20-socket connector to the 20-pin connector J2 or J3 on the
Connect a wire from TB1-5 (EGRND) to the common TLB-530. Gently press the connectors together until the
chassis earth ground point. stand-ofts snap into the holes in the TLB-530 board.
e. Using cable (PIN 19600150) connect J1 of TLB-530 to J2 e. Connect Earth Ground Tab on the TLI-530 boards to J4 and
of TFXnet Adaptor Board, TLA-530. J5 on the TLB-530. Connect a wire from TB1-5 (EGRND)
f. Install TLA-530 on TFX MP-500 Main Processor Board. to the common chassis earth ground point.
g. Make other connections to TLI-530 and remote signalling f. Install connections for TFXnet sub-loop hub communica-
option board. tions to TLI-530 modules. For star topology, use either
5. Bridge Network Configuration (See Figure 4): Channel A; for redundant star topology, use both Channel A
a. Install TLB-530 in cabinet. and Channel B. Note: When programming in CONSYS,
b. Install jumper link in J2 (remove link from J1, J3) for Bridge Channel = Port L; Channel B =Port R.
configuration. g. Connect +24 V to TB1-1 and DC Common to TB1-3.
c. Configure the TLI-530 modules for "Bridge" operation (refer
to Publication No. 19700344).
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 124
Wiring Notes: 2. Disconnect power before servicing systems.
1. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA 3. All conductors to be free of grounds.
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable
notes. All circuits contained in this module are classified as
power limited/Class 2 and shall be installed to comply with
N.E.G. Article 760, Part A and Part C.
o o
TU-530 J2
PCB PIN 900958
TLA-530
PCB PIN 900970
PL7
CABINET GROUND
TO EARTH GROUND
Figure 3. One TU-530 and One Remote Signalling Option Board, with Connection to TLB-530.
OVDC
3 ,
4 I ~
5 -"
~
-
.- -.'!::
TU-530 TLI-530
PCB PIN 900958 PCB PIN 900958 --
--
D TLB-530
PCB PIN 900962
CABINET GROUND
TO EARTH GROUND
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 125
SEE INSTALLATION SEE INSTALLATION SEE INSTALLATION SEE INSTALLATION
CABINET GROUND NOTE 6F NOTE 6F NOTE 6F NOTE 6F
TO EARTH
TFXnet TFXnet TFXnet TFXnet
GROUND
EARTH GROUND Channel B Channel A Channel B Channel A
] , ] , ] , ]
, ,
~ ~ ~
,
,
TLI530 , TLI530 TLI530 , TLI530
] PCB PIN , ." PCB PIN ,. ." PCB PIN , ." PCB PIN
"
;
"
... 0 : 0
,
, -
<:>
,
, -
<:>
,
, C
] , ]
,
..
-0
~.
TLI-530
PCB PIN
900958
~
..
,
,
,
,
-a
~.
..
TLI-530
PCB PIN
900958
,~
..
o
Z
::0
o
0:
(9
o .. ' ': <:> ,: 0 , 0
~61:
...--+--HO ~ ,
4 '
- 5'
~ "'=:
TLI-530
PCB PIN
900958
. "
, :
TLI-530
PCB PIN
900958
""
CABLE PIN
19600150
(SUPPLIED)
RPS-424 POWER SUPPLYI
BATTERY CHARGER
WITH POWER MONITOR
Figure 5. Two TLB-530 boards, each with two TLI-530 boards, in Hub Configuration.
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience installing and testing fire detection
systems, These instructions do not purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment
described, Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection with installation,
operation, or maintenance. All specifications are subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems arise which are not covered
sufficientlyforthe user's purposes, the matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems
Company, Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145, Ph. (216) 871-9900,
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 126
Table 1: Specifications
Power Requirement 124 VDC (nominal)
from RPS-424 Power Supply
TLO-530 Fiber Optic Modem Module Current Draw Alarm: 125 mA max.
Supervisory 125 mA max.
Assembly 976166
Data RS-485 (Tri-state); EOL 120 ohm UL
Publication Number 19700380 ilisted PIN 976048
Issue 2, January 1997
Data Rate : DC-200 Kbaud
The TLO-530 Fiber Optic Modem (Part Number 976166) converts
RS-485 digital data current pulses to light pulses. The light pulses Wavelength 1850 nm
are then carried over fiber optic cabling. This method of commu- I
Transmitter Power : 20 [lW (-17dBm)
nication provides a more reliable signal because of its greater
immunity to radio frequency interference and electromagnetic Receiver Sensitivity 1 [IW (-30dBm)
interference. This increases system reliability.
Optical Power Budget 62.5/125 Fiber: 13 dB
Features 50/125 Fiber: 9 dB
True tri-state output
Maximum Cable Distance i 13,000 ft (4 km)
Data re-clocking
Unit Size (base) : 7.2 x 4.9 x 1.0 inches
Data rates to 200 Kbaud !
The TLO-530 Fiber Optic Modem is designed and approved for use II Optical Connectors ' ST type
with the UL listed AUTOCALL TFX (TFX-500/800,
TFX-500M/800M, TFX-500MV/800MV, DirecTone500, FireGraph) Power and Signal Connections:
TFXnet network systems. Together they form an interactive, Make power and signal connections to the Fiber Optic Modem as
supervised, optical transmitting communications system. shown in Table 2 and Figure 3.
Fire alarm system applications of the TLO-530 Fiber Optic Modem Fiber Optic Cable Connection:
include industrial, commercial, and institutional installations; rec-
Select good quality UL listed 62.5/125 or 50/125 fiber optic cable.
ommended for outdoor cabling. Install the fiber optic cabling in
Attach an ST style fiber optic connector, identifiable by the bayonet
accordance with UL 864, NFPA 70, NFPA 72, NFPA 101, and all
appearance of the connector housing (do not use SMA type that
local codes and ordinances.
has internal screw threads). Follow the connector manufacturer's
Modem Location and Mounting: recommended procedures. Connect the incoming fiber optic cable
Locate the TLO-530 Fiber Optic Modem within the enclosure of the to the Optical Receiver connection, beside the yellow LED.
TFX-500, TFX-500M, TFX-800 display box, TFX-800M control Connect the outgoing cable to the Optical Transmitter connection,
panel, in an auxiliary cabinet (must be in same room as control beside the green LED.
panel), or mounted externally next to the control unit. See Figure
2. Hold the modem unit against the mounting surface and mark the Table 2: Power & Signal Connections
locations of the keyhole slots on the rear mounting brackets. Install Modem Term TFX Notes
the No.6 mounting screws (supplied) to the keyhole slot marks,
allowing leeway under the screw heads for the modem unit to be Power 1 +24VDC Power In
mounted. Align the unit and tighten the screws. When mounting two (24VDC)
TLO-530 modems in a TFX-500 or TFX-800 display box, mount the
units piggy-back using hardware supplied. Power 2 (GRD) OV DC Common
LED Indicators Data 1 (D) L + or R+ Data (polarity sensitive)
The red power LED will light steadily when voltage is applied to the
unit. A yellow LED will pulse when incoming light pulses are Data 2 (GRD) Shield Data Circuit Wiring Shield
received. The green LED flashes when light pulses are placed on Data 3 (15) L- or R- Complimentary Data (polar-
the outgoing fiber. ity sensitive)
LED INDICATORS
Optical Data Fiber Optic Cable
Receive. (DATA
0000 REC)
MWERL~ DATm~ I
BLOCK BLOCK
Figure 1. TLO-530 Fiber Optic Modem.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 127
(a) Mounting in auxiliary enclosure. (b) Mounting in AUTOCALL 19-inch rail enclosure.
AUXILIARY MOUNTING
AUXILIARY PLATE KIT PIN 976170
,~ ENCLOSURE (INCLUDES (4) SCREWS TO
MOUNT PLATE TO RAILS)
I 976010
HARDWARE TO MOUNT
MODEM TO AUXILIARY PLATE
FURNISHED WITH MODEM
/
II
~
~ V
AUXILIARY BOX MOUNTING-TWO
~
(d) Mounting outside control panel. Fiber optic modem units must be located in the same room as the control
panel. Fiber optic modem units may be mounted directly to the wall or to a backing plate.
WIRING IN SAME ROOM
AS CONTROL PANEL
()Sl ()Sl
()Sl
D
()Sl
:
Figure 2. TLO-530 Fiber Optic Modem Mounting (a) Auxiliary cabinet, (b) TFX-500M/TFX-800M cabinet, (c)
TFX-500 or TFX-800 display box, (c) mounting outside cabinet.
2
3
4
5
6
7 PL2
TO 24 VDC
~
POWER SUPPLY TB1
EOL UL LISTED 120
OHM PIN 976048
1 24VOC
:
I
FIBER OPTIC{
CABLE
} ~ ~ ~R(bJ 2 GRO ~
0..
~ { 1 FIBER OPTIC CABLE
I CONNECTIONS } ~ L - CONNECTIONS TO
I ~ ffi 1 (+) 0 ~ ~ { NEXT PANEL
I I 15 GRO 2 N ~( ~rg 0 I
I I a.. 24VDC 1 \9 V I
~
I 1~
I } ~x ~ 0 ~R6 ~
SUPERVISED
POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2
I
Figure 3: Typical Fiber Optic Modem Configuration. Note that Fiber Optic Modem communication may be used on either or
both channels of the TU-530 network module.
Wiring Notes: 2. Apply power to the system. The red Power LED should be
1. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA lighted.
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable 3. Check for transmit/receive operation. Look for a lighted green
notes. All circuits contained in this module are classified as Transmit LED at one end ofthe fiber cable and a lighted yellow
power limited/Class 2 and shall be installed to comply with Receive LED at the other end (on a different unit).
N.E.C. Article 760, Part A and Part C.
Table 3: Transmit/Receive Troubleshooting
2. Disconnect power before servicing systems.
3. All conductors to be free of grounds. Transmit Green Receive Yellow Notes
4. Data circuit is supervised, power limited/Class 2 and restricted.
The TLO-530 Fiber Optic Modem must be in the same room as OFF OFF Check power, units,
the panel it is connected to. Wire need not be shielded. Use cable connections.
twisted wire pair 18-24 AWG (If shielded wire is used, make
sure shield is continuous over the length of the circuit. The ON ON Data transmitting nor-
shield should be connected to DC Common.) mally.
5. End-of-line resistor UL listed 120 ohms, PIN 976048 must be
ON OFF Check continuity and
connected across all modem data circuit connections.
signal loss in cable.
6. Power supply wiring-Connect to +24VDC from MP-500 main
processor board or RPS-424 Power Supply/Battery Charger. OFF ON Check units for opera-
Power Up and Testing: tion.
1 . Check to see that signal cables and fiber optic cables are
properly connected and are of the correct polarity.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 130
Module Position: _ _ _ _ __
(See System Layout)
Space Requirement: TFX-500/800 Cabinet-B3
TFX-500M/800M Cabinet-One-half module space
TLD-530 TFXnet Line Driver Specifications
PCB 920197 Assembly 976167 Operating Temperature: 32 OF to 122F (0 DC to 50C)
Publication Number 19700401 Operating Humidity: up to 85% (non-condensing)
Issue 2, January 1997 Dimensions (Iwd): 6.63 X 4.5 X 0.75 inches
The TLD-530 is a two-channel RS-4S5 to Line Driver interface Table 1: Electrical Specifications
which will support point to point communication on a dedicated pair Battery Requirements
of wires. Typically, these wires are a single, unshielded, #24AWG,
Standby Current I 25 I mA
twisted pair, contained in a multi-conductor cable (the multi-con-
ductor cable may already exist at the installation site). Alarm Current I 25 I mA
Two independent channels. 24 AWG, twisted wire pair, 4 miles maximum distance
I
Each channel can communicate over a maximum distance Power Parameters
of four miles over a single No. 24 AWG twisted wire-pair.
Removable screw terminal connectors provide for ease of
Isolated +5 VDC from TLI530
I
wiring. LED Indicators
The red TX-A or TX-B LED will light intermittently when Line A or
Data rates up to 38.4 K-baud are supported.
Line B is transmitting data. The red RX-A or RX-B LED will light
Application: intermittently when Line A or Line B is receiving data.
The TLD-530 TFXnet Line Driver is designed and approved for use Power and Signal Connections:
with the UL listed AUTOCALL TFX (TFX-500/800, Make power and signa! connections to the TLD-530 Line Driver as
TFX-500M/SOOM, TFX-500MV/800MV, DirecTone500, FireGraph) shown in Table 3 and Figure 2.
TFXnet network systems. The TLD-530 provides two independent
channels which interface TFXnet RS-485 communications to a Important: The +5 VDC power must be the isolated +5 Voc
proprietary prootocol line driver. A TLD-530 pair inserted in a supplied by the TLI-530 module.
TFXnet RS-485 link provides an intermediate line driver link which
is capable of operating over a four-mile distance using No. 24 AWG The line driver cable is connected from one TLD-530 module to
unshielded, twisted wire pair cable. The TLD-530 will support data another TLD-530 module at TB1. Maximum distance is 4 miles.
rates of 9600 Baud, 19.2 K-Baud, and 38.4 K-Baud.
RS-485 Cable Connections-The RS-485 twisted shielded pair
Fire alarm system applications of the TLD-530 TFXnet Line Driver cable is connected from the TLD-530 to the TLI-530. The shield
include industrial, commercial, and institutional installations; rec- should be connected to earth ground in the TFX cabinet at one end
ommended for indoor and outdoor cabling. The TLD-530 contains of the cable only.
on-board circuit protection, eliminating the need for a secondary
protection device when the line driver cabling is routed outdoors. Switch Settings
Install the cabling in accordance with UL 864, NFPA 70, NFPA 72, Switches SWA and SWB configure the RS485 and line driver
NFPA 101, and all local codes and ordinances. communication parameters for Channel A and Channel B,
respectively. For each of these, switches 1, 2, and 3 configure the
TLD-530 Location and Mounting: operating line dirver wire length; switches 4, 5, and 6 configure the
Locate the TLD-530 TFXnet Line Driver within the enclosure of the RS-485 data rate; and switch 7 is factory configured for on-board
TFX-500, TFX-500M, TFX-800 display box, TFX-SOOM control end-of-line termination for RS485 lines; switch 8 is not used. (See
panel, or in an auxiliary cabinet (must be in same room as control Table 2.)
panel).
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 131
Table 2: Switch Settings SWA and SWB Table 3: Power & Signal Connections
SUPERVISED
JrIr------II ====~~S~TA~T~IO~N~P~RO~T~E~C~TO~R~~~
UL LISTED PRIMARY TELCO
STATION PROTECTOR
TOTLI-530
TO
TB1-5 TB1-4 TLD-530
TLD-S30 TFXnet
Line Driver
SUPERVISED
POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2
RESTRICTED TO SAME ROOM
'-----HiK9i-] DCC
~------~~GND .. 4
~~v 3 liJ===ON
ffi,,-32
PCB 920197
Assembly 976167 liON
2=
3=
4=
5=
AS CONTROL PANEL ~ 5 CJI[] 6 CllIl
r- 6 =m 7 CllIl
1- 7 =m TB2: EIA-485 8 CllIl
8 =m
TX-BO o TX-A
RX-BO o RX-A
SUPERVISED SUPERVISED
POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2 POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2
RESTRICTED TO SAME ROOM AS CONTROL PANEL TO TLI-530 TO TLI-530 RESTRICTED TO SAME ROOM AS CONTROL PANEL
Figure 2: Typical TLD-530 Wiring Configuration_ Note that line driver line communication may be used on either or both chan-
nels of the TU-530 network module_
Wiring Notes: 7. Check for transmit/receive operation. Look for a lighted red
1_ All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA Transmit LED at one end of the line driver cable and a lighted
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable red Receive LED at the other end (on a different unit).
notes_ When installed to comply with NEC_ Article 760, Part
A and Part B, these circuits are classified as non-power This document is written for skilled technicians with experience
limited_ When installed to comply with NEC_ Article 760, Part installing and testing fire detection systems. These instructions do not
A and Part C, these circuits are classified as power limited_ purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment described.
2_ Circuits leaving the building must be connected to a UL listed Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection
primary protector at the point the wiring exits the building_ with installation, operation, or maintenance. All specifications are
3_ Disconnect power before servicing systems_ subject to change without notice.
4_ All conductors to be free of grounds_ Should further information be desired or should particular problems
5, Data circuit is supervised, power limited/Class 2_ Wire need not arise which are not covered sufficiently for the user's purposes, the
be shielded, Wire must not contain any taps or branches. Only matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company,
point-to-point connections are supported. Use twisted wire pair Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
18-24 AWG (If shielded wire is used, make sure shield is
continuous over the length of the circuit. The shield should be
connected to Earth Ground.)
6. Power supply wiring-Connect to +SVoc from TU-530, TB1-4
(+SV) and TB1-S (DCC).
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 132
Specifications:
Environment: Indoor Application Only
Operating Temperature: 32F to 120F
Operating Humidity: 85% (non-condensing)
CAA-500Ll Line Isolator Module Compatibility: Use only the AUTOCALL TFX Fire Control
PCB PIN 940529 Assembly No. 976026 System. Maximum number of CM-SOOLI modules per 2-way data
circuit is 12.
Installation Guide Electrical:
Publication Number 19700223 Minimum Current 2-Way Data Circuit: 2 mA
Issue 3, January 1997 Maximum Current 2-Way Data Circuit: 18 mA per pair (tripped,
maximum two devices)
The CM-SOOLI Line Isolator Module (P/N 940529) is designed to Terminal Block Wiring: No. 12 to 19 AWG shielded, twisted pair
be used only with the AUTO CALL TFX fire control panels. The Addressable Circuit Voltage: 28 VDC (POLARITY SENSITIVE)
purpose of the Line Isolator is to ensure that no short circuit fault Maximum Series Resistance: (Isolator ON) = 1.6 ohm
on the 2-way data (multiplex) circuit can disable more detection Base/Cover Material: "Bayblend" polycarbonate ABS alloy
devices than would be lost on a conventional non-addressable fire Dimensions (Iwh): 4.9 x 4.9 x 1 inch
circuit. The module monitors the condition of the 2-way data Shipping Weight: 3.6 ounces
circuits. When a short circuit is detected, it isolates the affected Mounting: Requires UL listed electrical box of sufficient depth to
section and allows the rest of the 2-way data circuit to function
accommodate wiring (dimensions depend upon application-flush
normally. The yellow LED turns ON when the module is isolating.
or surface mount):
The Line Isolator Modules should be installed only after all other Surface - 2-gang switch box
devices have been installed and tested. Surface - 2-gang tile box
Fiush - 4-inch square box with 2-gang adapter
Installation: (provides more wiring depth)
The CM-SOOLI module consists of a printed circuit board (PCB) Flush - cast box with 2-gang switch plate mounting
which is mounted to a cover plate. The wiring connectors are
exposed through the back ofthe base. After the wiring is complete,
the cover plate is mounted to a UL listed electrical box.
1. Check that there is continuity on all the circuits and that no short
circuits exist.
2. Wire each CM-SOOLI module onto the 2-way data circuit
according to the site plan. Make sure polarity is correct.
3. Mount the cover plate to the electrical box.
4. Screw the cover in place.
5. Check that the yellow LED on the module is not lighted (if it is,
a short circuit exists in the circuit wiring).
/ , SCREWS
/ (INCLUDED)
/
@
~ CAA-500LI COVER WITH
CIRCUIT BOARD
ASSEMBLY
o
LED
@ @
II II Electrical
Box
Wall
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 133
Niring: 6. Four pairs of connection terminals (L+ and L-) are provided on
I. Before connecting any module or device on the 2-way data the terminal block. The terminals are divided into LINE IN
circuit, make sure that the wiring is correct, has been tested for connections and LINE OUT connections. One LINE IN pair and
continuity, and that no short circuits exist. one LINE OUT pair are used to connect the module onto the
~. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA 2-way data circuit. The other LINE IN and LINE OUT pair are
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable used to provide 'tee-tapped' or 'spur' circuits.
notes. All circuits contained in this module are classified as 7. Spur circuits are susceptible to the effects of an open circuit,
power limited/Class 2 and shall be installed to comply with since communications will be lost with all devices after the
N.E.C. Article 760, Part A and Part C. break. With a looped circuit, a SINGLE open circuit will not
3. All conductors to be free of grounds. disable any device because there are always two communica-
:1-. Disconnect power from the circuit before installing modules. tion paths.
). When making connections, break wire run, strip 3/B-inch 8. LED operation-yellow LED "ON" indicates circuit isolation.
insulation from the end of the wires, slide the bare end of the
wires under the terminal clamping plate, and tighten the
clamping screw.
CONTROL
FOR
UNIT
SPUR CIRCUIT
AUTOCALL TFX (NOTE 6)
2-WAY DATA CIRCUIT
i J + TO NEXT
77--:J. DEVICE
SUPERVISED
POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2
1 6 () () ) 6611
,,-
" .
r
,
\" + \"
' , " \" 'j:
.
LINE IN LINE OUT
( )- LED
(BEHIND)
(NOTES)
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 134
System Compatibility: AUTOCALL TFX Fire Control System
Device Location: The location of each device should have been
determined according to the site plan. (See System Layout)
Specifications:
IXA-SOOCM Contact Monitoring
Environment: Indoor Application Only
Module Operating Temperature: 32F to 120F
PCB PIN 940528 Assembly No. 976027 Operating Humidity: 85% (non-condensing)
Base/Cover Material: "Bayblend" polycarbonate ABS alloy
Publication Number 19700225
Addressable Circuit Voltage: 28 VDC (POLARITY SENSITIVE)
Issue 4, January 19097
Contact Rating: Use with contact that has minimum current of
<500 micro-ampere; maximum current of >50 mA
The Contact Monitoring Module is used to monitor fire contacts
such as a fire alarm pull station, heat detector, or waterflow switch. Contact Supervisory Current: 3 mA minimum, 18 mA maximum
The module provides one identifiable detection loop which is Addressable Loop Supervisory Current: 0.18 mA maximum
capable of monitoring normally-open contacts or normally-closed Addressable Loop Alarm Current: 0.18 mA maximum
contacts. Supervision EOL: 1K ohm (UL listed, PIN 976045, supplied)
Identity Resistor: 2.2K ohm (UL listed, PIN 976044, supplied)
The Contact Monitoring Module is capable of identifying and Line Impedance (subcircuit): 10 ohm
signailing to the control panel whether a contact is OPEN or Terminal Block Wiring: No. 12 to 19 AWG shielded, twisted pair
CLOSED.
Dimensions (Iwd): 4.9 x 4.9 x 1 inch
Install in accordance with NFPA 70, National Electrical Code, Shipping weight: 3.6 ounces
NFPA 72, Installation, Maintenance, and use of Protective Mounting Requirements: One UL listed electrical box of
Signaling Systems. sufficient depth to accommodate wiring (dimensions depend upon
application-flush or surface mount):
Installation:
Surface - 2-gang switch box
The printed circuit board is mounted to a cover plate. The Surface - 2-gang tile box
connection terminals and address setting switches are accessible Flush - 4-inch square box with 2-gang adapter
(provides more wiring depth)
on the back. After connections have been made and the address Flush - cast box with 2-gang switch plate mounting
switches set, the cover plate is mounted onto the UL listed electrical
box. The LED extends through the front of the cover plate and
provides indication of unit operation.
/ /f'
UL LISTED BOX
(NOT SUPPLIED)
Address Setting:
Each module installed on the 2-way data (multiplex) circuits ; (
requires an address. Set the address before wiring the module into / J-;;.
the circuit.
The address for each module is set on a 7-position DIP switch
r< y\~ \~-k
I
"r
I"
SCREWS
(INCLUDED)
marked 1 to 7. For example, to set a module to address 26, set
switches 2, 4, and 5to ON (1) and switches 1 ,3,6, and 7to OFF (0).
I
I
/ / ..
I' /
I . ~ .\ /:
@ @ l('~:~~
COVER WITH
CIRCUIT BOARD
ASSEMBLY
~IXA-500CM
o LED
Electrical
Wall Box
Electrical Box - - - - I
Wall
Module Cover -----J!!!I!Jl!!!l!Jl!!!l!Jl!!!l!Jlm
SURFACE MOUNT ~ _ _ Module
FLUSH MOUNT Cover
Figure 1. Mounting IXA-500CM Contact Monitor Module.
AUTOCALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 135
Niring: 5. When making connections, break wire run, strip 3/B-inch
I. Before connecting any module or device on the 2-way data insulation from the end of the wires, slide the bare ends of the
circuit, make sure that the wiring is correct and has been wire under the terminal clamping plate, and tighten the
tested. clamping screw.
2. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA 6. Install the 2.2 k-ohm identity resistor (Ul listed,P/N 976044,
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable supplied) across CCT1 +VE and -VE terminals.
notes. All circuits contained in this module are classified as 7. Connect the Ul listed monitored contact device to the CCT2
power limited/Class 2 and shall be installed to comply with +VE and -VE terminals.
NEC. Article 760, Part A and Part C. B. Install the EOl resistor (1 k-ohm, Ul listed, PIN 976045,
3. All conductors to be free of grounds. supplied) into the circuit of the monitored contact device (see
~. Disconnect power from the circuit before installing modules. Figure 2).
9. Break wire run to provide supervision.
1KOHM
(a) UL LISTED (b) UL LISTED EOL
MONITORED DEVICE PIN 976045 UL LISTED
W/ NORMALLY OPEN MONITORED DEVICE
CONTACT WI NORMALLY CLOSE
CONTACTS
CIRCUIT STYLE B POWER LlMITED/
CONTROL FOR
SPUR SUPERVISED CLASS 2
UNIT POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2
CIRCUIT
r-;:::=I==I====:+=
CONTROL FOR CIRCUIT STYLE C
TO NEXT
DEVICE UNIT SPUR SUPERVISED
CIRCUIT L--::I=~-=:::!-_
r~~a~~~l~dd:f*~_~2'm2K
+
IDENTITY RESISTOR TO NEXT
OHM UL LISTED DEVICE
PIN 976044
POWER LlMITED/ + 2.2K OHM UL LlSTE
CLASS 2 IDENTITY RESISTO
PIN 976044
POWER LlMITE[
CLASS 2
LINE liP'S CCT 2 CCT 1
.- LED
C (BEHIND)
(NOTE 2) SUPERVISED CCT2 CCT 1
POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2 LED
ADDRESS CONTACT MONITOR MODULE NOTE 1 0'- (BEHIND)
(NOTE 2)
SWITCHES IXA-500CM
(NOTE 4) PIN 940528
""'" ON ADDRESS CONTACT MONITOR MODULE
SWITCHES
(NOTE 4)
IXA-500CM
""'" ON PIN 940528
Figure 2. Typical wiring configurations (a) Normally Open Contact Style B Initiating Circuit,
(b) Normally Closed Contact Style C Initiating Circuit.
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience installing and testing fire detection systems. These instructions do
not purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment described. Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met
in connection with installation, operation, or maintenance. All specifications are subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems arise which are not covered sufficiently for the user's purposes,
the matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company, Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 136
System Compatibility: AUTOCALL TFX Fire Control System,
CONSYS Issue 3.0 and above.
Specifications:
Environment: Indoor Application Only
IXA-500CMA, IXA-502CMA Contact Operating Temperature: 32F to 120F
Monitoring Module Operating Humidity: 85% (non-condensing)
IXA-500CMA PCB PIN 940575 Ass'y No. 976092 Base/Cover Material: "Bayblend" polycarbonate ABS alloy
IXA-502CMA PCB PIN 940581 Ass'y No. 976185 Electrical (IXA-500CMA and IXA-502CMA):
Publication Number 19700333 Addressable Circuit Voltage: 28 VOC (POLARITY SENSITIVE)
Issue 3, January 1997 Contact Rating: Use with contact with current rating of >50 !!A
(>0.5 mAl to <50 mA
The IXA-500CMA and IXA-502 Contact Monitoring Module is used
to monitor fire alarm system contacts such as manual pullstations,
heat detectors, water flow switches and other initiating devices. Dimensions (hwd): 4.5 x 4.5 x 1 inch
The module provides a single initiating circuit that may be wired in Shipping weight: 4 ounces
NFPA Styles B, C, 0 or E to monitor normally-open or normally Mounting Requirements IXA-500CMA: One UL listed electrical
closed contacts. box of sufficient depth to accommodate wiring (di mensions depend
upon application-flush or surface mount):
The IXA-500/502CMA Contact Monitoring Module is capable of
Surface - 2-gang switch box
identifying and signalling to the control panel the status of the Surface - 2-gang tile box
monitored contact and the status of the wiring to the contact. Flush - 4-inch square box with 2-aana adapter
(provides more wiring depth) ~ ~ .
!nstallation: Flush - cast box with 2-gang switch plate mounting
The IXA-500CMA printed circuit board is mounted to a cover plate.
The connection terminals and address setting switches are
accessible on the back. After connections have been made and the Table 1. Electrical Specifications
address switches set, the cover plate is mounted onto the UL listed
electrical box. The LED extends through the front of the cover plate Baltery Requirements:
and provides indication of unit operation. Addressable Loop Single Contact Application
The IXA-502CMA printed circuit board mounts by connector to an Figures 3 and 5 Figures 4 and 6
interface board such as an IXM-500 Motherboard or ATM-500
Standby Current 0.18mA 0.18 mA
Addressable Telephone Module. First set the address switches,
then mount the IXA-502CMA to its socket, being careful to orient Alarm Current 0.18mA 0.18mA
the board correctly. The LED provides indication of unit operation. Circuit Resistors
0
tJ ~
IXA-502CMA 10 Current
Condition Current
Open Circuit Fault
3.0 - 4.0 mA mA
0.0 -2.9 mA
3.0 -4.0 mA
0.0 -2.9 mA
10 in condition Fault 3.0 -4.6mA 3.0 -4.6 mA
Contact Monitoring Normal 4.7-7.5 mA 7.5- 11.1 mA
Module
c? 0
IXA-500CMA
Contact Monitoring
Module
PIN 976092
PIN 976185 NIO Contact Closed
NIC Contact Open
> 7.5mA
--
--
--
4.7 -7.5 mA
> 11.1 mA
I
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 137
'a) IXA-502CMA PLUG-IN
CONTACT MONITORING
MODULE PCB PIN 940539
(b)
/1'-...)]
/",' I
UL LISTED BOX
(NOT SLlPPLlED)
y-
PANEL CABINET ONLY-DO NOT SCREWS
ADDRESS
1 1//-:-:- /
SWITCHES
1/--1 ,-,/: COVER WITH
I (NOTE 5)
LED
(BEHIND):----..,.C
l.( --J.--. ~ '"
CIRCUIT BOARD
ASSEMBLY
1~ (NOTE 3)
~ IXA-502CMA
LED
am ON
Wall
___ Module
FLUSH MOUNT Cover SURFACE MOUNT
Figure 2 (a) IXA-502CMA connecting to carrier board. (b) IXA-500CMA Contact Monitoring Module Mounting to electrical box.
Table 2. Address Setting Switch Values 6. Install the identity resistor across 11+ (T8-1) and 11- (T8-2).
(See Table 1 for value.)
Sw. Pos. Value Sw. Pos. Value
(ON) (ON)
7. Connect the Ul listed monitored contact device(s} as shown in
Figure 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.
1 1 5 16 8. Install the EOl resistor(s} into the circuit of the monitored
2 2 6 32 contact device(s} as shown in Figure 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7. (See Table
3 4 7 64 1 for value.)
4 8 Notes Figures 3, 4, 5, 6-Single Contact Application:
1. All circuits connected to this module, IXA-500CMA
Wiring: (P/N 940575) are classified as power limited.
1 . Before connecting any module or device on the TFX address- 2. The red LED (seen from front) is ON when the contact being
able loop circuit, make sure that the wiring is correct and has monitored has operated and the control panel has received the
been tested. Refer to Publication 19700370 TFX-500/BOO event. LED indications:
Wiring Guidelines. a. ON continuously = Contact Activated
2. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA b. ON pulsing = Polling
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable c. OFF = Not Polling
notes. All circuits contained in this module are classified as 3. The detection circuit is monitored for open circuit and device
power limited/Class 2 and shall be installed to comply with fault conditions.
N.E.C. Article 760, Part A and Part C. 4. Set address according to site plan. See Table 2
3. All conductors to be free of grounds. 5. For monitoring Normally Closed (N.C.) devices, employ series
4. Shutdown the TFX control panel(s) and disconnect power from resistor UL listed 1 k-ohm PIN 976045.
the circuit before installing modules.
5. When making connections, break wire run, strip 3/8-inch
insulation from the end of the wires, slide the bare ends of the
wire under the terminal clamping plate, and tighten the
clamping screw.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 138
1KOHM UL LISTED UL LISTED EOL 1 K OHM ______
UL LISTED EOL UL LISTED
MONITORED DEVICE PIN 976045 NOTE 5 " MONITORED DEVICE
-
PIN 976045
WI "NORMALLY OPEN" r-"'M...-, WI "NORMALLY CLOSED'
CONTACTS UL LISTED EOL CONTACTS
1 K OHM FACTORY
INSTALLED
CIRCUIT STYLE B
PIN 976045 NOTE 5
CONTROL "SUPERVISED" CIRCUIT STYLE C
UNIT POWER LIMITED FOR "SUPERVISED"
CONTROL
NOTE 1 SPUR POWER LIMITED
UNIT
.-;:::==++===:+:::
I TO NEXT
DEVICE
CIRCUIT L--j;::::j;=::::"_ NOTE 1
l
PIN 976044 IDENTITY RESISTOR
PIN 976044
~=
-I
LED "SUPERVISED"
NOTE 1
UA-" (BEHIND) '" - LED
(NOTE 2)
NOTE 1 U---(BEHIND)
(NOTE 2)
ADDRESS
SWITCHES
(NOTE 4)
ON
CONTACT MONITOR MODULE
IXA-500CMA
PIN 940575
ADDRESS
SWITCHES
CONTACT MONITOR MODULE
IXA-500CMA
I
(NOTE 4)
Assembly 976092 "'" ON PIN 940575
Assembly 976092
!
Figure 3 Typical Style B. All circuits and connections Figure 4 Typical Style C. All circuits and connections
are power Iimited/Class2. are power Iimited/Class2.
UL LISTED
MONITORED DEVICE 1K EOL UL LISTED EOL UL LISTED
WI "NORMALLY OPEN" FACTORY INSTALLED MONITORED DEVICE
CONTACTS PIN 976045 NOTE 5 WI "NORMALLY CLOSED"
CONTACTS
CIRCUIT STYLE B
"SUPERVISED" CIRCUIT STYLE E
"SUPERVISED"
CONTROL
1 K EOL UL LISTED EOL CONTROL
UNIT PIN 976045
UNIT
r~~~!i~;::;;=== TO NEXT
DEVICE TO NEXT
DEVICE
2.2KOHM
RESISTOR 2.2KOHM
PIN 976044 RESISTOR
PIN 976044
a: CC
'" '" (\J C\J
LED
UA-"(BEHIND)
'" '" LED
(NOTE 2) U - - - (BEHIND)
(NOTE 2)
Figure 5 Typical Style D. All circuits and connections Figure 6 Typical Style E. All circuits and connections
are power Iimited/Class2. are power Iimited/Class2.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 139
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 140
System Compatibility: AUTO CALL TFX Fire Control System
Device Location: The location of each device should have been
determined according to the site plan. (See System Layout)
Address Setting:
Each module installed on the 2-way data (multiplex) circuits
requires an address. Set the address before wiring the module into
the circuit. IXA-S01CM
MINI CONTACT
The address for each module is set on a 7-position DIP switch MONITORING
marked 1 to 7. For example, to set a module to address 26, set MODULE
switches 2, 4, and S to ON (1) and switches 1 ,3,6, and 7 to OFF (0). PIN 940S73
Electrical
Box
Wall
MINI-
/" CONTACT
FLUSH MOUNT - - - Cover
(Not included) ULLISTED / ~ MONITORING
MODULE
ELECTRICAL
Wall BOX ( /0
Electrical Box - - - - ;
(NOT
SUPPLlED~1 Y MANUAL
ALARM
/STATION
Cover
(Not included)
SURFACE MOUNT I I
l~
'" V
TYPICALAPPLICATION
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 141
4. Disconnect power from the circuit before installing modules.
5. Connect the Red wire of the IXA-501CM to the positive(+)
Hiring: 2-way data circuit wire to the control panel. Connect the Black
I. Before connecting any module or device on the 2-way data wire of the IXA-501 CM to the negative (-) leg of 2-way data
circuit, make sure that the wiring is correct and has been circuit. When making connections, break wire run, strip
tested. 3/8-inch insulation from the end of the wires, connect bare ends
2. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA of the wire using a wire nut.
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable 6. Connect the UL listed monitored contact device to the Purple
notes. All circuits contained in this module are classified as and Yellow wires of the IXA-501 eM.
power limited/Class 2 and shall be installed to comply with 7. Install the EOL resistor (619-ohm, 0.25 watt, UL listed, PIN
N.E.C. Article 760, Part A and Part C. 976082) into the circuit of the monitored contact device.
3. All conductors to be free of grounds. 8. Break wire run to provide supervision.
Notes:
1. The detection circuit is monitored for open circuit and device
fault conditions.
CONTROL 2. Set address according to site plan. Switch ON Values:
UNIT
Sw. Pos. Value Sw. Pos. Value
TO NEXT
DEVICE 1 5 16
2 2 6 32
3 4 7 64
619 ohm, 0.25 watt
Ul LISTED EOl 4 8
REDWIRE
PIN 976082 Ul LISTED
MONITORED DEVICE
W/ "NORMAllY OPEN'
CONTACT
CIRCUIT STYLE B
SUPERVISED SUPERVISED
POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2 POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2
YEllOW WIRE
PURPLE WIRE
CONTACT MONITORING
ADDRESS MODULE
SWITCHES
IXA-501CM
(NOTE 2)
~ ON PIN 940573
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience installing and testing fire detection systems. These instructions do
not purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment described. Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met
in connection with installation, operation, or maintenance. All specifications are subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems arise which are not covered sufficiently for the user's purposes,
the matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 142
System Compatibility: AUTO CALL TFX Fire Control System
Compatibility Identifier: SOOA
Maximum Detectors per IXA-500DM Module or per MDM521
Zone: 20 or 30 (see list of compatible devices, Publication
MDM521 Multi Detector Monitor 19700411, Detector Compatibility Chart) Maximum of 240 detec-
Module tors per 8 zones for the MDMS21 module
PCB PIN 940607 Assembly 976375 Operating Temperature: 32F to 120F
IXA-500DM Detector Monitor Module Operating Humidity: 85% (noncondensing)
PCB PIN 940523 Assembly 976022 Cover Material: Polycarbonate ABS alloy
Terminal Block Wiring: No. 12 to 19 AWG shielded
Publication Number 19700220 Dimensions (hwd): IXA-500DM 4.9 x 4.9 x 1 inch
Issue 5, January 1997 MDMS21 3.6 x 11.4 x 1 inch
The Detector Monitor Modules can be used to connect to zones of Mounting Requirements for IXA-500DM: UL listed electrical box
conventional 24 V detector systems and interface them to the of sufficient depth to accommodate wiring (dimensions depend
AUTOCALL TFX Fire Control Systems. The Detector Monitor upon application-flush or surface mount). Surface mount:
Modules will monitor and signal alarms from a conventional two-gang switch box or a two-gang tile box. Flush mount: 4-inch
detector loop of 24 V detectors; but, the detectors in these square box with two-gang adapter (provides more wiring depth), or
conventional zones will not be individually addressable. The a cast box with two-gang switch plate mounting.
modules are compatible with 2-wire or 4-wire UL listed low-voltage
conventional point-type detectors, or normally open contact Mounting Requirements for MDM521: UL listed backbox
initiating devices. (recommend AUTO CALL box with Auxiliary Mounting Plate,
PIN 976399). MDM521 occupies 3/4 of one 19-inch space.
The !XA-500DM Detector Monitor Module provides one Style S,
Class B, zone for two-wire detectors or initiating devices Table 1. Electrical Specifications
Battery Requirements:
The MDM521 Multi Detector Monitor Module provides eight Style
B, Class B, zones. Resettable 24 VDC is provided for using Addressable Loop
four-wire detectors. Standby Current i 0.18 mA per IXA-500DM Module
1.44 mA per MDM521 Module
Operation !
Alarm Current i 0.70 mA (Module/Zone Alarm Current) plus
1. The red LED turns ON to indicate an alarm condition in the ! alarm current for devices on initiating zone subcircuit
detector circuit.
2. Operation of the TFX RESET switch drops the voltage at the Current Draw from Power Supply (For each Alarm Initiating Zone Circuit)
resettable outputs of the IXA-500DM or MDM521 to less than Standby Current I 20 mA plus 2 mA (typical standby) for each
100 mY, for a minimum of 5 seconds and a maximum of 15 i 24-volt initiating zone subcircuit
seconds, to reset detectors for each zone. Alarm Current 84 mA per initiating zone subcircuit
3. The module monitors the condition ofthe wiring and signals to
Circuit Parameters
the control panel if an open circuit or alarm is detected.
4. A power supply unit fault is signaled if the external power Alarm Iniliating Ckt. Max. Impedance 100 ohms
supply to the module fails. Alarm Inrtiating Ckt. Vortage
(D+ to D- or +VE to -VEl 16.9 to 22.2 Voc (with EOl connected)
(a) IXA-SOODM Detector Monitor Module
,----------, Alarm Initiating Ckt. Maximum Current 74mA
@ @ 1
10000000000001
1 Alarm Initiating Ckt. Ripple Voltage 500 mV peak-to-peak maximum
1
I IXA-500DM
I 1
1
L+ l L+ L L+ L- D+ 0
LlNEltp'S
NC NC 24V ov
1
Other
0 DETECTOR MONITORING
1 Maximum total devices per loop IXA-500DM 99 (Addressable Loop Load = 1 Loop
1
~=
Load Unit per IXA-500Module)
1
MODULE
~~ 1
MDM521 12 (Addressable Loop Load = 8 Loop
Sf!.
1 IXA500DM 5
j:)
,." 1 Load Units per MDM521 Module)
- ON c ~
I I 1
1
Ci
'"
1
1
Maximum detectors per zone on
MDM521 Module
30 (Refer to Pulbication 19700411, Detector
Compatibility Chart.)
@ 1 1
L _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ .J Supervision EOL UL listed 4.7 k-ohm, PIN 976047
FRONT REAR Input Voltage 24 Voc (nominal)
(b) MDMS21 Multi Detector Monitor Module Addressable Circuit Voltage 28 Voc (Polarity Sensitive)
L/OUT L/IN ZONE 1 ZONE 2Z0NE 3 ZONE 4 ZONE 5 ZONE 6 ZONE 7 ZONE 8 +24V RESE
Resettable 24 V current 1 A maximum
r~;Fr r~~:Fll ~v ~v &V iil mV ~v ~v ~v ~~&t\il Addressable Loop Currents
~
PK PK PK PK PK PK PK
Normal/Clear/Restore 3.0-5.7 mA
~~~~~~~
Une Fault 5.7-9.5mA
1234
Fire Alarm 9.5-13mA
Figure 1. (a) IXA-500DM Detector Monitor Module;
(b) MDM521 Multi Detector Monitor Module. Device Fault 13-20mA
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 143
(a)
@
wall~nYl;;'i"i~~~'1i;!;'\\, I
Electrical
Module Box _______
Cover I /" /f'~ ... / UL LISTED BOX
(NOT SUPPLIED)
o
SURFACE MOUNT
,c 1'1~~
I~y~ ,
SCREWS
(INCLUDED)
6-... '
~ w~e
I 1--/1' /
@
~J)6< : ""'to W,,"
CIRCUIT BOARD
ASSEMBLY
(b) AUXILIARY
MOUNTING
LED
BACKPLATE END VIEW
PIN 976399 UPPER MODULE
MOUNTED ON SWIVEL
STAND OFFS TO OFFSET 113/8
LOWER MODULE
HARDWARE FURNISHED
0 o o o
1
0 MDM521 MULTI DETECTOR MONITOR MODULES 31/2
, 1 I
AUXILIARY I 0 o o
o 7 ~Il
~
MOUNTING
BACKPLATE
I I SPACE FOR MINI
MODULEORCM
I \
PIN 976399
~~_
#6-32 MOUNTING
HARDWARE
o
o
o
o
o
o
f{~f("
~
(FURNISHED)
o o o /1 n:
1/ IS-_.Ji
\
Figure 2. Typicallnstallation. (a) IXA-500DM DetectorMonitor Module; (b) Typical MDM521 Multi Detector Monitor Module.
Compatible Conventional Detectors 2. The MDMS21 Multi Detector Monitor Module is mounted within
a TFX control panel or in an auxiliary cabinet. Use only a UL
Refer to Publication Number 19700411, Detector Compatibility
listed enclosure.
Chart, for the UL listed detectors that may be used with the
a. Set the address switch.
AUTOCALL TFX fire control systems when attached to an
b. Make sure that the jumper link for each circuit is
IXA-SOODM Conventional Detector Monitor Module or MDMS21
installed across position SeA (ALARM). See Table S.
Multi Detector Monitor Module. Note: only the IXA-SOODM or
c. Make sure that the jumper link for each installed circuit
MDMS21 zone address will be the "addressable point" on the
is NOT installed in position PK. See Table S and "Address
system.
Setting" section.
NOTE: If a combination of detectors is used, calculations must be d. Mount the MDMS21 module(s) to the auxiliary mounting
made such that the total standby current of the detectors does not plate or subplate in the backbox.
exceed the maximum normal standby detector load current rating e. Connect wiring.
of 2 rnA for each of the eight circuits. Address Setting:
Installation: 1. Each IXA-SOODM module installed on the TFX addressable
loop requires an address. Set the address before wiring the
Install in accordance with NFPA 70, National Electrical Code, module to the circuit.
NFPA 72, Installation, Maintenance, and use of Protective a. The address for each module is set on a 7-position DIP
Signaling Systems. switch marked 1 to 7. For example, to set a module to
1. The IXA-SOODM printed circuit board is mounted to the cover address 26, set switches 2, 4, and 5 to ON (1) and switches
plate. The LED extends through the front of the cover plate and 1,3,6, and 7 to OFF (0).
provides indication of unit operation. b. Set address according to site plan. Switch ON values:
a. Set the address switches. Table 2. Address Switch 7-Pasitian DIP Switch
b. Make sure that the jumper link is installed in LK1 across
position SIC ALARM. Sw. Pas. Value Sw. Pas. Value
c. Connect the wiring. (ON) (ON)
d. Mount the cover plate to the electrical box. 1 1 5 16
e. Before connecting any module or device on the TFX 2 2 6 32
addressable loop circuit, make sure that the wiring is correct
3 4 7 64
and has been tested and is in compliance with NFPA
standards. 4 8
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 144
2. Each MDM521 Multi Detector Monitor Module installed on the Table 5. MDM521 Terminal Designations, Associated LED
TFX addressable loop requires from 1 to 8 sequential Indicators, and Jumper Links
addresses. Set the address before wiring the module to the
circuit. See Table 3. Assoc.
a. The base address for Zone 1 is set on a 4-position DIP Assoc. Assoc. Park
Legend Terminal Function LED Aim Link Link
switch marked 1 to 4. The base addresses are in multiples
of eight. For example, to set a module to base address 40, TFX TB1-1 Loop Out (+)
set switches 1 and 3 to ON (1) and switches 2 and 4 to OFF Addr.
(0). The addresses for the remaining zones are consecutive Data TB1-2 Loop Out H
Loop
from the base address. That is, if Zone 1 has address 40, TB1-3 Loop In H
Zone 2 is 40 + 1 ~ 41; Zone 3 is 40 + 2 ~ 42, etc.
TB1-4 Loop In (+)
b. Set address according to site plan. Switch ON values:
Module TB2-1 Power (OV)
Power
TB2-2 Power (OV)
Table 3. Zone Addresses Using 4-Pos. DIP Switch
TB2-3 Power (+24 V)
Sw. Base Zone Addresses
Pos. Value TB2-4 Power (+24 V)
1,2,3,4 (1=ON) +1 +2 +3 +4 +5 +6 +7
Zone 1 TB3 Det. Ckt. (+1-) 095 LK1 N.A.
0000 o (not -- -- -- -- -- -- --
used) Zone 2 TB4 Det. Ckt. (+1-) 094 LK2 LK3
1000 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 I
Zone 3 TB5 Det. Ckt. (+1-) 093 LK4 LK5
0100 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 I Zone 4 TB6 Det. Ckt. (+1-) 092 LK6 LK7
1100 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 Zone 5 TB7 Det. Ckt. (+1-) 091 LK8 LK9
0010 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
Zone 6 TB8 Det. Ckt. (+1-) 090 LK10 LK11
1010 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
Zone 7 TB9 Det. Ckt. (+1-) 089 LK12 LK13
0110 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55
Zone 8 TB10 Det. Ckt. (+1-) 088 LK14 LK15
1110 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63
Reset- TB11-1 Power (+24 V)
0001 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
table
1001 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 24V TB11-2 Power (24 V)
Power
0101 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 TB11-3 Power (OV)
1101 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 TB11-4 Power (OV)
0011 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
1011 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 Wiring Notes (See Figures 3 and 4):
1. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code (NEG),
0111 112 113 114 115 116 117 118 119
NFPA 72, state, and local building code requirements, and
1111 120 121 122 123 124 125 126 -- applicable notes. All circuits contained in this module are
classified as power-limited/Class 2, and shall be installed to
comply with NEC Article 760, Part A and Part C.
c. If a zone is not used, place the associated "Park Link" in the 2. All conductors to be free of grounds.
"Park (PK)" position to disable that address (See Tables 3 3. Disconnect power from the circuit before installing modules.
and 5). That address may then be used for a different device. 4. Connect the detector circuit at D+ and 0- (+VE and -V E)
Hint: When choosing unused addresses for the "Park terminals making sure the polarity is correct.
Link," start from the highest address and work 5. Install the EOL resistor (UL listed, 4.7K ohm, PIN 976047,
backwards. supplied) into the last detector.
6. Connect the 24 V output from the power supply unit (or control
panel) to the negative (OV) and positive (24V) terminals.
Table 4. IXA500DM Terminal Designations 7. Resettable +24 V DC @ 1 Aoutputviaa four-way terminal block
provides powering of four-wire detectors.
Terminal Legend Function Terminal Legend Function 8. Terminals marked N.C. are not used.
9. The detection circuit is monitored for open circuit.
TB1-1 OV Power Supp. TB1-7 L- Loop Out 10. Break wire run at terminal connection to provide supervision.
TB1-2 24V Power Supp. TB1-8 L+ Loop Out When making connections, break wire run, strip 3/8-inch
insulation from the ends of the wire, slide the bare ends of the
TB1-3 NC Not Used TB1-9 L- Loop Spur wire under the terminal clamping plate, and tighten the
TB1-4 NC Not Used TB1-10 L+ Loop Spur clamping screw.
11. Use only a UL listed 24-volt regulated power-limited supply,
TB1-5 D- Detector H TB1-11 L- Loop In suitable for fire protective signaling service.
TB1-6 D+ Detector (+) TB1-12 L+ Loop In 12. Terminals for TFX addressable loop spur circuit. No connection
if not used.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 145
4.7K EOl
Ul LISTED EOl
PIN 976047
(NOTE 5)
CIRCUIT STYLE B
- / (NOTES 4,9, 10) Ul LISTED
(NOTE 12) REGULATED
CONTROL FOR SPUR POWER-LIMITED
UNIT
CIRCUIT r----------------I+ 24VDC
POWER SUPPLY
(NOTE 11)
TO NEXT
DEVICE
POWER-LIMITED/CLASS 2
CLASS 2
"SUPERVISED" (NOTE 6)
"SUPERVISED"
POWER LIMITED/
CLASS 2
(NOTE 10)
'----v-------'
LINE I/P'S
lED
(BEHIND) HEADER
(SEE "OPERATION") (SEE "INSTALLATION")
ADDRESS
SWITCHES IXA-500DM I q
(SEE TABLE 2.
"ADDRESS
DETECTOR MONITOR
SETTING") MODULE
PIN 940523
Figure 3. IXA-500DM Wiring. All circuits and connections are power Iimited/Class2.
RESETTABlE
4.7K EOl 4.7K EOl 24VDC
Ul LISTED EOl Ul LISTED EOl SUPERVISED
PIN 976047 PIN 976047 POWER-LIMITED/
RPS-424 CLASS 2
(NOTE 5) (NOTE 5)
Ul LISTED
REGULATED
POWER LIMITED
24VDC
I'J
POWER SUPPLY
(NOTE 11)
CONTROL TFX ADDRESSABLE lOOP 4.7K EOl
UNIT 2-WAY DATA CIRCUIT + Ul LISTED EOl
POWER-LIMITED/
PIN 976047
CLASS 2
"SUPERVISED" (NOTE 5)
(NOTE 6)
CIRCUIT STYLE B
+ t-Y'------{ (CLASS B) CIRCUIT STYLE B
POWER-LiMITED,cLASS 2 (CLASS B)
"SUPERVISED"
POWER-LIMITED/
TO NEXT - ------, CLASS 2
DEVICE + "SUPERVISED"
POWER-LiMITEDY
CLASS 2
"SUPERVISED"
(NOTE 10)
g~t=t::t:;-;~::;~~;-:--::LL:-:tj:~-rj:=-J::L-::tL-:tj:::-"1~=---.:jjL-r.k~;:;~~il
+VE-VE -VE +VE OVL +24V MDM521 MULTI DETECTOR MONITOR MODULE
LjOUT L/IN
SEE TABLE 5
SEE "OPERATION" --1--------------.() () () () () () () ()
SEE TABLE 5 095 094 D93 D92 D91 D90 089 D88
SEE "INSTALLATION"
Figure 4. MDM521 Typical Wiring. All circuits and connections are power-limited/Class2.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 146
System Compatibility: AUTOCALL TFX Fire Control System,
CONSYS Issue 3.0 and above
Compatibility Identifier: SODA
Device Location: The location of each device should have been
IXA-500DMA Detector Monitor Module determined according to the site plan. (See System Layout)
PCB PIN 940576 Assembly No. 976093 Specifications:
Maximum Detectors per Module: 15 to 30 (see list of compatible
Publication Number 19700334 devices, Publication Number 19700411, Detector Compatibility
Issue 2, January 1997 Chart))
Environment: Indoor Application Only
The IXA-500 Detector Monitor Module is used to connect to zones Operating Temperature: 32F to 120F
of conventional 24 V detectors and interface them to the Operating Humidity: 8S% (non-condensing)
AUTOCALL TFX Fire Control System. The IXA-500DMA Detector Base/Cover Material: "Sayblend" polycarbonate ASS alloy
Monitor Modu!e wil! monitor and signal alarms from a conventional Terminal Block Wiring: No. 12 to 19 AWG
loop of 24 V detectors. Although the IXA-500DMA is an address-
Dimensions (Iwd): 4.S x 4.S x 1 inch
able device, the conventional detectors attached to the
Mounting Requirements: UL listed electrical box of sufficient
IXA-500DMA are not individually addressable. The module is
compatible with UL listed low-voltage conventional point type depth to accommodate wiring (dimensions depend upon applica-
detectors such as the ISC-350 series or other conventional 2-wire tion-flush or surface mount):
detectors (see Table 1). The conventional detectors may be Surface - 2-gang switch box
installed in an NFPA 72 Style D (Class A) or NFPA 72 Style B (Class Surface - 2-gang tile box
8) configuration. In addition, the IXA-500DMAcan interface directly Flush - 4-inch square box with 2-gang adapter
to 4-wire type conventional detectors. (provides more wiring depth)
Flush - cast box with 2-gang switch plate mounting
Install in accordance \Nith NFPP, 70, National Electrical Code, Shipping Weight: 3.6 ounces
NFPA 72, Installation, Maintenance, and use of Protective
Signaling Systems. Battery Requirements:
Addressable Loop
Standby Current 0.25 mA
@ @
Alarm Current 0.25 mA
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 147
:::ompatible 2-Wire Conventional Detectors 5. When making connections, break wire run, strip 3/8-inch
=tefer to Publication Number 19700411, Detector Compatibility insulation from the ends of the wire, slide the bare ends of the
'Jhart, for the UL listed detectors may be used with the AUTOCALL wire under the terminal clamping plate, and tighten the
rFX fire control systems when attached to an IXA-500DMA clamping screw.
:;onventional Detector Module. Note: only the IXA-500DMA will be 6. Connect the output from the power supply unit (or control
he "addressable point" on the system. panel) to the negative (OV) and positive (24V) terminals.
7. Connect the detector circuit making sure of correct polarity.
Installation: See Figures 2, 3, and 4.
rhe printed circuit board is mounted to the cover plate. The 8. For Style B circuits, install the EOL resistor (UL listed, 4.7K
;onnection terminals and address setting switches are accessible ohm, PIN 976047, supplied) into the last detector. For Style 0
)n the back. After connections have been made, the address configuration, EOL is not required.
switches set, and the jumper set, the cover plate is mounted onto 9. Four-wire detector circuit requires UL listed end-of-line relay
:he electrical box. The LED extends through the front of the cover PIN 19240410. See Figure 4.
::>Iate and provides indication of unit operation. Notes (see Figures 2, 3, 4):
1. All circuits connected to this module, IXA-500DMA (PIN
~ddress Setting: 940576) are classified as power limited.
Each module installed on the 2-way data circuits requires an 2. The LED (seen from front), when lighted, indicates that an
address. Set the address before wiring the module into the circuit. alarm or trouble condition exists. Red color LED ON indicates
ALARM. For Style 0 configuration only, yellow color LED ON
The address for each module is set on a 7-position DIP switch
indicates TROUBLE.
marked 1 to 7. For example, to set a module to address 26, set 3. Terminals marked N.C. are not used.
switches 2, 4, and 5 to ON (1) and switches 1,3,6, and 7to OFF (0). 4. The detection circuit is monitored for open circuit.
Wiring: 5. Set address according to site plan. Switch ON values:
1. Before connecting any module or device on the 2-way data
(multiplex) circuit, make sure that the \'Viring is correct and has Sw. Pos. Value Sw. Pos. Value
been tested. 1 1 5 16
2. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA 2 2 6 32
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable
notes. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, 3 4 7 64
NFPA 70, state, and local building code requirements and 4 8
applicable notes. All circuits contained in this module are
6. Break wire run to provide supervision.
classified as power limited and shall be installed to comply with
7. Use only UL listed regulated 24 V power limited supply suitable
N.E.C. Article 760, Part A and Part C.
for fire protective signalling service.
3. All conductors to be free of grounds.
8. ".erify jumper link is installed in LK1 in position SIC ALARM,
4. Disconnect power from the circuit before installing modules.
pinS 1 and 2.
CONTROL UNIT
+ -
TFX-500/800
ADDRESS SWITCHES 2-WAY DATA CIRCUIT
NOTE 5 SUPERVISED
POWER LlMITED/CLASS 2
L+ NOTES 1, 6
L- STYLE B
ON SUPERVISED
L+
POWER LlMITED/CLASS 2
L- NOTES 1, 4, 6
TONEX SUPERVISED
DEVICE POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2
NOTES 1, 6
+
Figure 2 Typical 2-Wire Conventional Detector Circuit, Style B
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 148
CONTROL UNIT
+ -
TFX-500/800
TFX-500M/800M
2-WAY DATA CIRCUIT
ADDRESS SWITCHES
NOTES 1
I~~~Q~~~1
ON
L+
L-
L+
SUPERVISED
POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2
NOTES 1, 6
STYLE D
SUPERVISED
POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2
L- / NOTES 1, 4, 6
DET RET +VE
IXA-500DMA DET RET - VE
DETECTOR MONITORING DET +VE ULLISTED
CONVENTIONAL
MODULE DET -VE DETECTOR
PIN 940576 NC
(j)
Header DET SUP
NOTE 8 (j) N.C A
CONTROL UNIT
+ -
TFX-500/800
TFX-500M/800M
ADDRESS SWITCHES 2-WAY DATA CIRCUIT
NOTE 5
SUPERVISED
L+ POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2
L- NOTES 1, 6
ON
L+ STYLE B
L- SUPERVISED
POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2 UL LISTED
DET RET +VE NOTES 1, 4, 6 CONVENTIONAL
DETECTOR
IXA-500DMA DET RET - VE
DETECTOR MONITORING DET +VE ~ 4.7KOHM
MODULE
PIN 940576 Header
DET -VE I- -:r UL LISTED EOL
PIN 976047
NOTE 8 NC
S/CAlarm ~ 1 DET SUP EOLRELAY
SIC Fault 2 , \ PIN 19240410
24V
3
LK1 LED
(Behind)
NOTE 2
OV
SUPERVISED
POWER LIMITED
+
UL LISTED 24 VDC
NOTE 1 POWER SUPPLY
REGULATED
POWER LIMITED
SUPERVISED
TONEX POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2
DEVICE NOTES 1, 6
+
Figtlypital4-Wire Conventional Detector Circuit, Style B
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 149
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience installing and testing fire detection
systems. These instructions do not purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment
described. Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection with installation,
operation, or maintenance. All specifications are subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems arise which are not covered
sufficientlyforthe user's purposes, the matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems
Company, Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 150
System Compatibility: Use only with AUTO CALL TFX Fire
Control Systems
Specifications:
Environment: Indoor Application Only
OXA-502RM, OXA-503RM Operating Temperature: 32F to 120F
Addressable Relay Module Operating Humidity: 85% (non-condensing)
Base/Cover Material: "Bayblend" polycarbonate ABS alloy
PCB PIN 940586 (Stand-alone) Assembly No. 976258
Dimensions (Iwd): 4.9 x 4.9 x 1.3 inch
PCB PIN 940587(Plug-in) Assembly No. 976259 Mounting Requirements (OXA-502RM): One UL listed electrical
Publication Number 19700415 box of sufficient depth to accommodate wiring (di mensions depend
upon application-flush or surface mount):
Issue 2, January 1997
Surface - 2-gang switch box
The Addressable Relay Module provides one volt-free changeover Surface - 2-gang tile box
relay contact on a latching relay. The relay is controlled by a Flush - 4-inch square box with 2-gang adapter
command sent from the fire control panel via the 2-way data (provides more wiring depth)
(multiplex) circuit. The relay state (activated or deactivated) is Flush - cast box with 2-gang switch plate mounting
reported back to the controller. The red LED flashes when the
module is polled every two seconds and is turned ON temporarily Table 1. Electrical Specifications
for five seconds when the relay is latched in the ON state.
Battery Requirements:
OXA-S02RM stand-alone model installs in electrical box. Addressable Loop
OXA-503RM plug-in model installs on a motherboard such as
OXM-501 RM/SDA Motherboard or CSM-500 Channel Select Standby Current 0.18mA
board. Alarm Current 0.18mA
Relay Contact Rating
(a) OXA-S02RM
Stand-alone modules install to electrical box. DC 2 A@24VDC
SEE NOTE 6
AC 0.6 A@ 120 VAC
BACK VIEW
Relay Circuit Requirements
I
POWER LIMITED POWER LIMITED Condition Current
Installation:
(b) OXA-S03RM Plug-in modules typically install in The OXA-502RM printed circuit board is mounted to the cover
RM/SDA Motherboard. plate. The connection terminals and address setting switches are
accessible on the back. After connections have been made and the
address switches set, the cover plate is mounted onto the electrical
~ box. The LED extends through the front of the cover plate and
SUPERVISED CONNECTOR FOR provides indication of unit operation.
POWER LIMITED INSTALLATION TO
CLASS 2 OXM-501 RM/SDA
MOTHERBOARD
The OXA-S03RM printed circuit board mounts to an OXM-S01
OR RM/SDA Motherboard or CSM-SOO Channel Select Motherboard.
()~ LED CSM500 CHANNEL
First set the address switches. Install the OXA-S03RM into the
(BEHIND) SELECT MOTHER
socket on the motherboard. Be sure to orient the board correctly
BOAr
(the socket is keyed for correct alignment). The LED provides
RELAY MODULE indication of unit operation.
ADDRES~
SWITCHES
OXA-503RM
PIN 976259 Address Setting:
PCB 940587
Each module installed on the 2-way data circuits requires an
NOTE: INSTALL OXA-503RM IN CONTROL PANEL CABINET address. Set the address before wiring the module into the circuit.
ONLY. DO NOT INSTALL IN ELECTRICAL BOX
Figure 1. OXA-502RM and OXA-503RM Addressable The address for each module is set on a 7-position 01 P switch
Relay Modules. marked 1 to 7. For example, to set a module to address 26, set
switches 2, 4, and sto ON (1) and switches 1,3,6, and 7to OFF (0).
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 151
'a) OXA-502RM PIN 976258
(b)
C 0
OXM-501 RM/SDA MOTHER-
BOARD (P/N 976253, PCB 900981) ~ OXA-502RM
SS+SLD s :ll.2+
OR
o 0 0 TB5 CSM-500 CHANNEL SELECT MO- o
jJ:E8 THERBOARD (P/N 976179, PCB
900972)
2B"'@ J3B
o
00
J2A ~o J3A
00
00
00
00
00
o
JP .ooJ~oo
0,,00 ~oo
JP1 JP3
UL LISTED COVER
MODULE COVER
UL LISTED BOX INSULATOR (P/N 19240952)
"'-- -- ---r--
I '
4 x 4 X 1 1/8 INCHES
~OT SUPPLIED)
NON-POWER
LIMITED
lL 7
j
Figure 1. (a) OXA-503RM installation in OXM-501 RM/SDA Motherboard or CSM-500 Channel Select Mother-
board; (b) OXA-502RM installation to electrical box.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 152
UL LISTED DEVICE
ELECTRONIC
FOR
a. OXA-502RM Address- CONTROL SPUR SWITCHING CIRCUIT
able Relay Module, dry UNIT CIRCUIT
POWER LIMITED
contact CLASS 2
TO NEXT
DEVICE
DC
TB1
1
+ 'I + r,
+ 'I z z z
. "~
0
SUPERVISED 0 o0
"
,
POWER LIMITED z0 Z
CLASS 2 ~2
U>m 0
-l -l
() C
"'m
C
g"'
m
LED g
'~
(BEHIND)
t,
(NOTE 2)
ADDRESS
SWITCHES
RELAY MODULE
(NOTE 4) OXA-502RM
PIN 976258
TB1
1
+ I + I + Ij z
SUPERVISED
POWER LIMITED
'----v-----'
LED ~~~
"
~
-l
zo
-l
CLASS 2 (BEHIND) / ( C C
g"' "'m
(NOTE2)_ ) m
g
ADDRESS
SWITCHES RELAY MODULE
(NOTE 4) OXA-502RM
PIN 976258
c. OXA-503RM Addressable
SUPERVISED CONNECTOR FOR INSTALLA-
Relay Module, connector for POWER LIMITED TION TO OXM-501 RM/SDA
installation in OXM-501 RMI CLASS 2 MOTHERBOARD
OR
SDA Motherboard or CSM-500 CSM-500 CHANNEL SELECT
Channel Select Motherboard. MOTHERBOARD
( )......... LED
(BEHIND)
(NOTE 2)
RELAY MODULE
ADDRESS
OXA-503RM
SWITCHES
PIN 976259
(NOTE 4)
Figure 2. Wiring (a) OXA-502RM dry contact, (b) OXA-502RM powered relay circuit, (c) OXA-503 connection to motherboard.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 153
Table 2. Terminal Designations 4. Set address according to site plan. Switch ON Values:
OXA-S02RM OXA-S03RM Sw. Pos. Value Sw. Pos. Value
Terminal Function Terminal Function 1 1 5 16
TB1-1 (N/O) Relay Norm. Open P1-1
2 2 6 32
TB1-2 (N.C.) Not Used P1-2
3 4 7 64
TB1-3 (N/C) Relay Norm Closed P1-3
4 8
TB1-4 (N.C.) Not Used P1-4
5. Break wire run to provide su Pervlsion
TB1-5COM Relay Common P1-5 6. For non-power limited circuit application, add blank label to
TB2-1 (L-) Loop (-) P1-6 cover the "POWER LIMITED" reference. Make sure that all
TB2-2 (L+) Loop (+) P1-7 power-limited/Class 2 wiring is separated at least 0.25 inches
from any wiring that is not power limited. Use cable ties or other
TB2-3 (L-) Loop (-) P1-8
permanent means to secure wiring.
TB2-4 (L+) Loop (+) 7. Use only UL listed 24 V power limited supply suitable for fire
TB2-5 (L-) Loop (-) protective signalling service.
TB2-6 (L+) Loop (+)
Wiring:
1. Before connecting any module or device on the 2-way data
circuit, make sure that the wiring is correct and has been
tested.
2. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable
notes.
3. All conductors to be free of grounds.
4. Disconnect power from the circuit before installing modules.
5. When making connections, break wire run, strip 3/8-inch
insulation from the ends of the wire, slide the bare ends of the
wire under the terminal clamping plate, and tighten the
clamping screw.
6. OXA-502RM relay circuit wiring:
a. For dry contact switching, connect the external circuit to the
COM and N/O or N/C terminals for normally-open or
normally-closed contacts as required.
b. For powered circuit operation, connect one power supply
terminal to the COM and one circuit connection to the NjO
or N/C terminal for normally-open or normally-closed
contacts as required. Connect relays to UL listed power
limited source suitable for fire protective signalling service.
7. OXA-503RM connects directly to OXM-501 RM/SDA Mother-
board (PCB PiN 900981) or CSM-500 Channel Select
Motherboard (PCB PIN 900972).
8. OXA-502RM Addressable Loop (2-way data circuit) Wiring-
Connect L+ to Addressable Loop (+); L- to Addressable Loop
(-). Make sure shields are continuous and do not make contact
with other wiring, conduit, or box.
Notes:
1. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable
notes. When installed to comply with N.E.C. Article 760, Part
A and Part B, these circuits are classified as non-power
limited. When installed to comply with N.E.C. Article 760, Part
A and Part C, these circuits are classified as power limited.
2. The red LED (seen from front) indicates the following when This document is written for skilled technicians with experience
addressed by the control panel: installing and testing fire detection systems. These instructions do not
a. When scanning normally (relay deactivated), the LED will purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment described.
illuminate once every two seconds when the module Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection
address is scanned. with installation, operation, or maintenance. All specifications are
b. When the relay is initially activated, the LED will illuminate subject to change without notice.
for a short period, then illuminate once every two seconds Should further information be desired or should particular problems
when the address of the module is scanned. The LED will be arise which are not covered sufficiently for the user's purposes, the
brighter than when the relay is deactivated. matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company,
3. Terminals marked "N.C." are not used. Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 154
System Compatibility: AUTOCALL TFX Fire Control Systems
Device location: (See System Layout)
Specifications:
OXA-500SD Signal Driver Module Environment: Indoor Application Only
Operating Temperature: 32F to 120F
PCB PIN 940526 Assembly No. 976023 .
Operating Humidity: 85% (non-condensing)
Publication Number 19700221 Cover Material: "Bayblend" polycarbonate ABS alloy
Issue 4, January 1997 Addressable Circuit Voltage: 28 VDC (POLARITY SENSITIVE)
Addressable Circuit Supervisory Current: 0.18 mA
The Signal Driver Module is used to activate signalling appliances Addressable Circuit Alarm Current: 0.70 mA (Alarm)
in response to a command sent from the fire control panel. The Input Voltage: 24 VDC (nominal)
signalling appliances are powered from a separate UL listed power Current Draw from Power Supply: 8 mA standby, 45 mA alarm
supply. The module is capable of passing current up to 500 mA Output Rating: 500 mA maximum
maximum. The current capability of the module may be increased line Impedance (subcircuit): 5 ohms
by using a Signal Expander Module (P/N 940527). The module is Signaling Appliance Wiring: Open circuit 100K ohms, Short
capable of monitoring and reporting the following conditions when circuit 2K ohm
the signalling circuit is supervised via a 22k ohm EOL resistor (P/N Terminal Block Wiring: No. 12 to 19 AWG shielded, twisted pair
976042): Normal condition, power supply fault, open/short circuit, EOl: UL listed 22K ohm, PIN 976042, supplied
relay coil fault, signalling appliance relay correct operation.
Dimensions (Iwd): 4.9 x 4.9 x 1 inch
!nstall in accordance with NFPA 70, National Electrica! Code, Shipping weight: 3.6 ounces
NFPA 72, Installation, Maintenance, and use of Protective Mounting Requirements: One UL listed electrical box of
Signaling Systems. sufficient depth to accommodate wiring (dimensions depend upon
application-flush or surface mount):
Installation:
The printed circuit board is mounted to the cover plate. The Surface - 2-gang switch box
Surface - 2-gang tile box
connection terminals and address setting switches are accessible Flush - 4-inch square box with 2-gang adapter
on the back. After connections have been made and the address (provides more wiring depth)
switches set, the cover plate is mounted onto the electrical box. The Flush - cast box with 2-gang switch plate mounting
LED extends through the front of the cover plate and provides
indication of unit operation.
Address Setting:
Each module installed on the 2-way data (multiplex) circuits
requires an address. Set the address before wiring the module into
the circuit.
The address for each module is set on a 7-position DIP switch
marked 1 to 7. For example, to set a module to address 26, set
SCREWS
switches 2, 4, and 5 to ON (1) and switches 1,3,6, and 7 to OFF (0). (INCLUDED)
COVER WITH
@ @ CIRCUIT BOARD
ASSEMBLY
~ OXA 50050
o LED
Wall
IElectrical Box - - - - - I
Module Cover ------lll!ll!!lll!ll!!lll!ll!!lll!ll!!l!!!!l
@ @ Electrical
Box
Wall
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 155
Wiring:
1. Before connecting any module or device on the 2-way data 5. When making connections, break wire run, strip 3/8-inch
circuit, make sure that the wiring is correct and has been insulation from the ends of the wire, slide the bare ends of the
tested. wire under the terminal clamping plate, and tighten the
2. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA clamping screw.
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable 6. Connect the 24 V output from the power supply unit to the
notes. negative (OV) and positive (24V) terminals.
3. All conductors to be free of grounds. 7. Connect the UL listed signalling appliance to terminals SDR
4. Disconnect power from the circuit before installing modules. +VE and SDR -VE. Make sure the polarity is correct.
8. Install the EOL resistor (UL listed 22 k ohm, PIN 976042) into
the last device.
22KOHM
PjN 976042
Notes:
rMI'1 1. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA
I I
U.L LISTED
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable
notes. All circuits contained in this module are classified as
HORN OR power limited and shall be installed to comply with N.E.C.
CIRCU
STYLEY
STROBE
+
(NOTE 1
& NO TE 3) Article 760, Part A and Part C.
CONTROL AUTOCALL 2. The power supply to the signalling appliance circuit is limited
UNIT
TFX-500jBOO U.L. LISTED to 730 mA by a thermistor which acts as a resetable fuse.
TFX-500MjBOOM 24VDC
FOR
2-WAY DATA CIRCUIT SPUR SUPPLY 3. The red LED (seen from front) is ON when the signalling
(NOTE?) appliance relay is operated.
CIRCUIT +
R~
+
o
T NEXT 4. Signalling appliances must be equipped with EMI suppression
D EVICE and diode polarization devices.
"SUP ERVISED'"
5. Set address according to site plan. Switch ON Values:
1)0 )0060<: (
11 Sw. Pos. Value Sw. Pos. Value
, .
L+ L- L+ L- L+
LINE liP'S
L-SDRSDR24V OV
' +VE-VE
1
2 2
5
6
16
32
()- LED 3 4 7 64
(BEHIND)
'~
..., (NOTE 3) 4 8
ADDRESS
SWITCHES ,--""" v= SIGNAL DRIVER MODULE
6.
7.
Break wire run for supervision.
Use only RPS-424 (PIN 910683) UL listed regulated 24-volt
(NOTE 4) OXA-500SD
:: ON
PIN 940526 power supply.
Figure 2. Wiring OXA-500SD. All circuits and This document is written for skilled technicians with experience
connections are power Iimited/Class2. installing and testing fire detection systems. These instructions do not
purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment described.
Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection
with installation, operation, or maintenance. All specifications are
subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems
arise which are not covered sufficiently for the user's purposes, the
matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company,
Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
RELAY MODULE
(PCB PIN 940582.
ASSEMBLY 976186) I.,/Y,', '
'< -.J/ 0.<'"
OXA-500SDA
ASSEMBLY 976091,
OXA-504SDA
o ASSEMBLY 976216
COVER WITH CIR-
CUlT BOARD
NOTE: LED
INSTALL OXA-501SDA IN
CONTROL PANEL CABINET
ONLY-DO NOT INSTALL IN SURFACE MOUNT
ELECTRICAL BOX. Wall
!Electrica! Box - - - - I
TYPICAL RM/SDA Module Cover ------liiiiiiEiiiiiiiiEiiiiiiiiEiiiiiiiEil
MOTHERBOARD (PIN
976253)
FLUSH MOUNT Electrical
Box
000000 1000000110000001
TB1 (2) TB2 0 TB3 Wall
Module
Cover
Figure 1 (a) OXA-501SDA installation in Local SDA Motherboard; (b) OXA-500/504SDA installation to electrical box.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 157
22KOHM
Ul LISTED EOl
Wiring:
PIN 976042 1 . Before connecting any module or device on the 2-way data
I I circuit, make sure that the wiring is correct and has been
U.l. LISTED tested.
(a)
AUTO CAll
C COMPATIBLE
INDICATING
APPLIANCE
-
(NOTE 4)
U.L. LISTED
2. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable
CONTROL
UNIT
TFX500/800
TFX500M/800M
CIRCUIT
/ ,----- +
r- -
24 VDC
SUPPLY
(NOTE 7)
notes.
3. All conductors to be free of grounds.
(NOTE 2)
2WAY DATA CIRCUIT STYlEY 4. Disconnect power from the circuit before installing modules.
5. When making connections, break wire run, strip 3/B-inch
A7---:
TO NEXT
DEVICE insulation from the ends of the wire, slide the bare ends of the
"SUPERVISED"
POWER LIMITE o wire under the terminal clamping plate, and tighten the
NOTE 1 (NOTE 6) clamping screw.
6. Connect the output from the power supply unit to the negative
1660000(000 1
(OV) and positive (24V) terminals.
+ , + I + I + I > >
-' -' -' -' IT IT rJJ rJJ 7. OXA-500/504SDA Wiring:
rJJ rJJ "
N
0
LED
6. Break wire run for supervision.
(BEHIND) ______ ( ) 7. Use only RPS-424 (P/N 910683) Ul listed regulated 24-volt
(NOTE 3) power supply.
SIGNAL 8. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA
ADDRESS DRIVER MODULE 70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable
SWITCHES PCB 940574 notes. All circuits contained in this module are classified as
(NOTE 5) OXA-500SDA Assembly
976091" OXA-504SDA power limited and shall be installed to comply with N.E.C.
Assembly 976216 Article 760, Part A and Part C.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 158
System Compatibility: AUTOCALL TFX Fire Control Systems
Compatible with CONSYS Issue 3.0 and above for notification
applications; compatible with CONSYS Issue 10 and above for
agent releasing applications.
S05SDA, 506SDA Notification Appliance
Specifications:
Modules
Environment: Indoor Application Only
505SDA, Plug-in Assembly 976377
Operating Temperature: 32F to 120F
506SDA, Stand-alone Assembly 976378
Operating Humidity: 85% (non-condensing)
Publication Number 19700473 Cover Material 506SDA: Polycarbonate ABS alloy
Dimensions 506SDA (hwd): 4.5 x 4.5 x 1.25 inches
Issue 1, Revision .13, July 1997
Mounting Requirements 506SDA: One UL listed electrical box
of sufficient depth to accommodate wiring (dimensions depend
The 505/506SDA Notification Appliance Module is used to activate
upon application-flush or surface mount):
notification appliances in response to a command sent from the fire
control panel. The notification appliance circuit is supervised and
Surface - two-gang switch box
may be configured as an NFPA 72 Style Z circuit or NFPA 72 Style
Surface - two-gang tile box
Y circuit. The notification appliances may be powered from either
Flush - 4-inch square box with two-gang adapter
a UL listed audio source or a separate power supply (UL listed for (provides more wiring depth)
Flush - cast box with two-gang switch plate mounting
fire signaling applications). For agent releasing applications see
Publication No. 19700475 and Publication No. 850526. Terminal Block Wiring (506SDA): No. 12 AWG maximum
When used with the UL listed RPS-424 power supply, or any other Table 1. Electrical Specifications
power-limited input source that is UL listed for fire signaling IBattery Requirements:
applications, all wiring terminals are power-limited. Addressable loop
The unit can be used with other nonpower-limited UL listed input Standby Current 0.35 mA
sources. If power-limited output is required for those applications, Alarm Current 0.35 mA
the optional plug-in boards provide power-limiting output for either
Input at TBH to TB1-4 (Power Supply) 0,08 mADC
24 V DC/25 V RMS (P/N 976379) or 70 VRMS (P/N 976380).
Addressable Loop Currents
ID Current 12,8-15,8mA
(a) 506SDA Condilion Current lED Indication
Stand-alone modules install to electrical box. Power Supply Fault Pulsed, Dim 0-3,0 mA
TERMINAL BLOCKS
Device Fault (Relay Coil) Pulsed, Dim 3,0 - 5,5 mA
REAR VIEW
Normal Pulsed Green 5,5 - 9,5 mA
POWER LIMITING
BOARD OPTIONS: Fault (Output Une) Pulsed Dim 9,5 -13,0 mA
(24 Vocl 25 VRMS
PIN 976379) Operated Pulsed Red 13,0 -17,5 mA
(70 VRMS
PIN 976380) Addressable Loop Unit Load
TB3 TB2 CLiPPABLE Each 505SDA or 506SDA module requires more than a single unit 1,43 loop Load
RESISTORS load on the addressable loop; therefore fewer than 99 addressable Units per module
SEE NOTES devices may be attached to a TFX loop containing 505/506SDA
modules, See Installation "Addressable Loop andAddress Setting"
PCB 90989
on page 3,
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 159
(a) ~~r UL LISTED TWO-GANG BOX
ROUTE WIRING TO THE RIGHT FOR NONPOWER-LiMITED WIRING, ROUTE WIR-
ING TO THE LEFT FOR POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2. MAINTAIN AT LEAST 0.25
/'" Y (NOT SUPPLIED)
INCHES OF SEPARATION BETWEEN POWER-LIMITED AND NONPOWER-L1MITED
/'" JG. WIRING BY MEANS OF WIRE TIES OR OTHER PERMANENT MEANS.
y,~1'
SCREWS
(INCLUDED) BLANK LABEL TO COVER THE 4 x 4 x 21/8 INCHES
POWER LIMITED NOTATION. (NOT SUPPLIED)
I I./''-..
I./'r,~,
~ --J/ 0.<:"
I
/
506SDA
ASSEMBLY
/
976378,
COVER WITH
CIRCUIT BOARD
LED
UL LISTED BOX
4 X 4 x 2 1/8 INCHES
(NOT SUPPLIED)
~ ---"f'
II '" '1-1
I '"4 506SDA
ASSEMBLY
~ 1-~ I
976378,
COVER WITH
CIRCUIT BOARD
'" '-L-
I '"~I
NOTE:
INSTALL 505SDA IN CONTROL PANEL
J1B
CABINET ONLY-DO NOT INSTALL IN
ELECTRICAL BOX.
'" " " '" "" D " '" '" " D " " <> " <> "
Figure 2 (a) 506SDA installation to electrical box; (b) 505SDA installation on Local SDA Motherboard.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 160
Releasing Function Applications 2. If needed, Install optional audio power-limiting option boards:
When used for releasing control, the SOS/S06SDA Notification Ap- a. Shunt is factory installed for normal power-limited operation
pliance Module is UL listed for fire alarm and releasing service and using the RPS-424 Power Supply/Battery Charger.
meets the requirements of NFPA Standards: NFPA 12, CO 2 Extin- b. When a nonpower-limited power supply is used, 24 V Dcl2S
guishing Systems (High Pressure Only); NFPA 12A, Halon 1301 VRMS power-limiting is achieved by removing the shunt and
Extinguishing System; NFPA 12B, Halon 1211 Extinguishing Sys- installing option board P/N 976379. Carefully seat the option
tem; NFPA 13, Sprinkler Systems; NFPA 1S, Water Spray board over header J2 and press.
Systems; NFPA 16, Foam-Water Deluge and Foam-Water Spray c. For 70 VRMS power-limiting, remove the shunt and install
Systems; NFPA 17, Dry Chemical Extinguishing Systems; NFPA option board PIN 976380. Carefully seat the option board
over header J2 and press.
17A, Wet Chemical Extinguishing Systems. For details regarding
3. For audio applications clip resistor R39 and R40 open:
these applications refer to Publications No. 1970047S and 8S0S26.
a. Clipping R39 open disables DC input supervision. Input
WARNING: When installing releasing equipment, supervision must then be furnished by the audio source.
b. Clipping R40 removes the DC input filter capacitor, which
do not connect releasing equipment circuits until
otherwise would short out an audio input.
the system has been verified to be working in 4. Connect the wiring to the terminals.
accordance with NFPA requirements. 5. Mount the circuit board to the cover plate making sure that the
Operation LED is visible from the front.
6. Install the module cover to the UL listed electrical box cover
The SOS/S06SDA can monitor and report the following conditions: PIN 192409S2.
7. Fit the assembly to the UL listed electrical box (not supplied).
Normal Condition (polled green LED)
Use 4 x 4 x 21/8 inch box for nonpower-limited applications.
Operated condition (polled red LED) 505SDA Installation:The S05SDA plug-in module board typically
Trouble condition (dimly polled LED) mounts to an OXM-S01 RM/SDA Motherboard (P/N 976253):
v Input power fault 1. On the circuit board, set the address switches to the TFX ioop
address.
Relay coil operation fault 2. If needed, install optional audio power limiting option boards:
a. For 24 VDC/2S VRMS power limiting, install option board PIN
Sounding circuit fault (open or short circuit)
976379. Carefully seat the option board over header J2 and
press.
Note: The unit will not operate into a shorted sounding
b. For70VRMS power limiting, install option board PIN 976380.
circuit fault.
Carefully seat the option board over header J2 and press.
Addressable Loop and Address Setting: 3. For audio applications clip resistor R39 and R40 open:
a. Clipping R39 open disables DC input supervision. Input
Each SOSSDA or S06SDA module requires more than a single unit
supervision must then be furnished by the audio source.
load on the TFX addressable loop. Each SOSSDNS06SDA module
b. Clipping R40 removes the DC input filter capacitor, which
is equivalent to 1.43 Loop Load Units. Since the maximum number
otherwise would short out an audio input.
of Loop Load Units available on a TFX loop is 99, then the
4. Install theS05SDA into the socket on the motherboard. Be sure
maximum number of SOSSDNS06SDA modules possible is:
to orient the board correctly (socket keyed for correct
99 -;- 1.43 =
69 SDA modules. alignment). The LED provides indication of unit operation.
To determine the maximum number of unit loads left when mixing
SDA and other loop devices, use the formula: Table 3. Terminal Designations
Remaining Unit Loads = 99 - (1.43 X Number of SDAs)
506SDA 505SDA
For example, If thirty SOSSDA modules are used, then the number
of remaining unit loads is: Terminal Function Terminal Function
99 - (1.43 X 30) = S6 unit loads TB1-1 (SH) Shield PH (-) Input (-)
Each module installed on the addressable loop (multiplex) circuits TB1-2 (1-) Input In (-) P1-2 (+) Input (+)
requires a separate, unique address. Setthe address before wiring TB1-3 (1+) Input In (+) P1-3 (S-) Sounder Signal H
the module into the circuit. TB1-4 (1-) Input Out (-) P1-4 (S+) Sounder Signal (+)
The address for each module is set on a 7-position DIP switch TB1-5 (1+) Input Out (+) P1-5 (R-) Sounder Return H
marked 1 to 7. For example, to set a module to address 26, set TB2-1 (SH) Shield P1-6 (R+) Sounder Return (+)
switches 2, 4, and S to ON (1) and switches 1 ,3,6, and 7to OFF (0). TB2-2 (S-) Sounder Signal H P1-7 (not used)
Table 2. Address Switch Values TB2-3 (S+) Sounder Signal (+) P1-8 (L+) Loop (+)
Sw. Pas. Value Sw. Pas. Value TB2-4 (R-) Sounder Return (-) P1-9 (L-) Loop (-)
1 1 5 16 TB2-5 (R+) Sounder Return (+)
2 n
6 .,2
n TB3-1 (L-) Loop Out (-)
3 4 7 64 TB3-2 (L+) Loop Out (+)
4 8 TB3-3 (L-) Loop In (-)
TB3-4 (L+) Loop In (+)
Installation TB3-5 (SH) Shield
The 506SDA stand-alone module:
1. On the circuit board, set the address switches to the TFX loop
address.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 181
l
Wiring Notes: B. For releasing applications, install an OXA-502RM Relay
1. Before connecting any module or device on the data circuit, Module (P/N 976258) as shown in Figure 5. Refer to
make sure that the wiring is correct and has been tested. Publication 19700415 for information concerning the
2. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code (NEG), OXA-502RM module.
NFPA 70, state, and local building code requirements and
Programming for Releasing Applications
applicable notes. When installed to comply with NEC. Article
760, Part A and Part 8, these circuits are classified as
nonpower-limited. When installed to comply with NEC. Article Refer to Publication 850526, TFX Releasing Option User's Guide
760, Part A and Part C, these circuits are classified as and TFX-500 and Publication 850463, TFX-800 CONSYS Pro-
power-limited. gramming Manual for information concerning programming for
3. For nonpower-limited circuit application, add blank labels to agent releasing functions.
cover the "POWER LIMITED" references. Make sure that all
power-limited/Class 2 wiring is separated at least 0.25 inches
from any wiring that is not power-limited. Use cable ties or other
permanent means to secure wiring. Refer to Table 4 for
compatible audio devices.
4. Maintain O.25-inch separation of nonjacketed wiring between
power-limited and non power-limited wiring. Use type FPl,
FPlR, or FPlP cable for nonpower-limited wiring. Refer to
NEC Section 760-54 for further details.
5. All conductors to be free of grounds.
6. Disconnect power from the circuit before installing modules.
7. Use only RPS-424 or other regulated, power-limited 24V Ul
listed power supply suitable for fire protective signalling
service.
B. Use only devices Ul listed as suitable for fire protective
signalling service.
9. For compatible speakers refer to Table 4.
10. When making connections, break wire run, strip 3/B-inch
insulation from the ends of the wire, slide the bare ends of the
wire under the terminal clamping plate, and tighten the
clamping screw.
11. Connect the output from the power supply unit,or audio circuit,
to the negative (-) and positive (+) terminals as required.
12. 506SDA Wiring:
a. Connect the Ul listed notification appliance to terminals S+
and S-. For Style Z connect the return wiring to R+ and R-.
Make sure the polarity is correct.
b. For notification circuit Style Y (DC application), install the
EOl resistor (Ul listed 27 k ohm, 1 Watt PIN 976250) into
the last device.
c. For audio notification circuit Style Y (audio applications),
install the EOl resistor (Ul listed 27 k ohm, 1 Watt PIN
976250) into the last device. In the last device on the audio
riser, install EOl resistor 5.1 k-ohm, 2 Watt PIN 4281-050
(DirecTone applications).
d. For releasing control circuit Style Y (24 Voc), install the Ul
listed suppression device PIN 97626B across the releasing
control device terminals.
13. 505SDA typically connects directly to OXM-501 RM/SDA
Motherboard (P/N 976253). The socket is keyed for correct
alignment.
14. Notification appliances must be equipped with diode polariza-
tion or DC blocking.
15. Set address according to site plan. See Table 2 for Switch ON
Values.
16. For power-limited wiring with a nonpower-limited input source,
install the optional audio power-limiting option boards:
a. For 24 Voc / 25 VRMS power-limiting, remove the shunt and
instaii option board PiN 976379. Carefuiiy seat the option
board over header J2 and press.
b. For 70 V RMS power-limiting, remove the shunt and install
option board PIN 9763BO. Carefully seat the option board
over header J2 and press.
17. For audio applications clip resistor R39 and R40 open:
a. Clipping R39 open disables DC input supervision. Input
supervision must then be furnished by the audio source.
b. Clipping R40 removes the DC input filter capacitor, which
otherwise would short out an audio input.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 162
(a) 506SDA, Style y, 24 VDC
27KOHM
UL LISTED EOL
PIN 976250
NOTE12B
SUPERVISED
CONTROL POWER LlMITED/
SUPERVISED
POWER LlMITED/ ' - - , - - - , - - - - ' _.... CLASS 2
UNIT
CLASS 2
CIRCUIT STYLE Y
TO NEXT
DEVICE All circuits and connections
cj cj
are power-limited/Class2.
z z
0 0 001
I + I + + I
+ I
(f)
....J ....J ....J [[ [[
(f) CIJ I + + I
TB3
TB2
CIJ ./"--,T","B.:.1_ _ _ ClJ_-+_ ~N~~~~LED
LED
(BEHIND)
R40
CLiPPABLE RESISTORS
OPTION
WIRING NOTE 17
R39~
U.L. LISTED
COMPATIBLE
NOTIFICATION
APPLIANCES
WIRING NOTES 8,
14
SUPERVISED REGULATED POWER SUPPLY
CIRCUIT STYLE Z UL LISTED FOR FIRE SIGNAL
____+-t--+-I-~ ING APPLICATIONS
WIRING NOTE 11
AUTO CALL TFX ADDRESSABLE
LOOP SUPERVISED
POWER LlMITED/ CLASS 2
00
I
(f)
j J j J I + I
CIJ
CIJ TB1
TB3
J2 .--------+- 6~~6~ ~~J~~~
LED c:.:==J WIRING NOTE 16
(BEHIND)-----.... ( )
All circuits and connections NOTIFICATION
APPLIANCE MODULE
are power-limited/Class2.
1~==
506SDA Assembly 976378
ADDRESS
SWITCHES
WIRING NOTE 15
~ =
= ON
D CLiPPABLE
RESISTORS
OPTION
WIRING NOTE
17
Figure 3. Wiring (a) 506SDA NFPA Style Y, 24 VDC Power; (b) 506SDA NFPA Style Z, 24 VDC Power.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 153
(a) 506SDA, Style Y, Audio Power
U.L. LISTED
NOTIFICATION/AUDIO
APPLIANCE
~moc,
WIIRNG NOTE 8,9,12
Table 4
AUTOCALL TFX ADDRESSABLE
LOOP SUPERVISED
POWER-LIMITED/ CLASS 2
SUPERVISED CIRCUIT
STYLE Y POWER-LIMITED
AUDIO IN / ~~~EEL~fl~ TWISTED
CONTROL
WHEN OPTIONAL PLUG-
UNIT IN BOARD IS INSTALLED AUDIO OUT AUDIO CIRCUIT SUPER-
VISED BY DIRECTONE.
TO NEXT NONPOWER-LiMITED
DEVICE WIRING NOTES 4, 12C
LJ
:i.
11
V5 ~ j j J +
0:
I
0:
TB3
J2
LED c::=:J
(BEHIND) -------.. ( )
NOTIFICATION
APPLIANCE MODULE
1~~
506SDA PIN 976378
CLiPPABLE RESISTORS
DR40 OPTION
ADDRESS~ ~
WIRING NOTE 17
SWITCHES
WIRING NOTE 15
=
""""" ON R39
n
U
,,------+- 6~~6~-~1~~~1~
WIRING NOTE 16
LED
NOTIFICATION (BEHIND)
APPLIANCE MODULE
506SDA PIN 976378
1B
'"D","
SWITCHES
WIIRNG NOTE 15
~ 1=1
= """""
ON
D CLiPPABLE RESISTORS
OPTION
WIRING NOTE 17
Figure 4. Wiring (a) 506SDA NFPA Style Y, Audio Power; (b) 505SDA connection to motherboard.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 164
U.L. LISTED
RELEASING CONTROL DEVICE
SPRINKLER OR AGENT RELEASING CIRCUIT SUPERVISED POWER-LIMITED.
INSTALL UL LISTED RELEASING SUPPRESSION DEVICE PIN 976268 (USED FOR
SPRINKLER SOLENOIDS ONLY). RELEASING
WIRING NOTE 120
UL LISTED SUPPRESSI RPS-424 REGULATED UL LISTED
DEVICE
FOR FIRE SIGNALING APPLICATIONS
PIN 976268 24 VDC POWER SUPPLY
WIRING NOTE 120 WIRING NOTES 7, 11
TO NEXT
TO NEXT CIRCUIT DEVICE
DEVICE STYLE Y
+ I + I I
a:: a: Cf) CIJ (j) ..:.. I + I
(f) SHUNT
TB1 INSTALLED
TB2 TB2
JP2
NOTIFICATION
APPLIANCE MODULE LED ~
506SDA PIN 976378 (8EHIND) -------. ( )
or 505SDA PIN 976377
1~
=
=
LED
(BEHIND) =
ADDRESS ~
ADDRESS
RELAY MODULE SWITCHES =
SWITCHES
(NOTE 15) OXA-502RM WIRING NOTE 15 = ON
PIN 976258
Figure 5. Typical use of SOA module in releasing application. For further details, refer to Publication 19700475, Fire Sup-
pression Agent Releasing Stations Installation Guide, and Publication 850526, AUTOCALL TFX Releasing Option User's
Guide.
ET-1 070-WM-24-VF-R Speaker with Strobe, 117 Candella, 8W multi-tap ET -1070-WM-24-VF-R WHEELOCK B8mA
ET-1 070-WM-24-VF-W Speaker with Strobe, 117 Candella, BW multi-tap ET-1070-WM-24-VF-W WHEELOCK BBmA
.. - - ----ET_10S=-=0-=_W-:-::-:cM_"Ccc_--:-V-=F-=_R=---
ET -10BO-WM-24-VF-R Speaker with Strobe, 117 Candella, 8W multi-tap 24 WHEELOCK BBmA
ET -1 080-WM-24-VF-W SpeakercwiihStrobe,--:1cc17=-C=-a~n-cde-;;ll~a,-=8:;-OW~m~u-olt~i-C-ta~p-------- ET -1080-WM-24-VF-W WHEELOCK B8mA ,
-----_. -.~----- .-------------------.--------~-
ET-101 0-WS-24-HF-R Strobe/Speaker, 25 and 70.7 VRMS. Strobe 25 mA, 1.5 cd 960450 WHEELOCK 25mA
------
ET-1070-WS-24-VF-R Strobe/Speaker, 25 and 70.7 VRMS. Strobe, 1.5 cd 960451 WHEELOCK 25mA
-:=-c::-::::-:c=-::-:-c=-==-------= .-=-:c=-::~c-:---:-::__;-----------_=== - --------- ---
ET-1080-WS-24-VF-R Strobe/Speaker, 25 and 70.7 VRMS. Strobe, 1.5 cd 960453 WHEELOCK 25mA
-E;:::T=----:1c:c cc
08=-=0-=-Wc=S--=24--=C:O;:F:----"'R----:Strobe/Speaker, 25 and 70.7 VRMS. Strobe, 8000 cp ET -1 0-8-0--W-S;---24----:C-F--R-~' WHEELOC;-K-----25mA
-~~--------------- ---.-.------- - - - c c c ____ .____ .c _ _ _ _ _ _
ET -1 090-WS-24-CF-\I\J
Strobe/Speaker, 25 and 70.7 VRMS. Strobe, 1.5 cd 960511 WHEELOCK 25mA
E-7025--~R------Speak6r-25VRMS~-96-d-BA ---------------E-7025-R
'E'::iO-70---R ----.-------- Speaker 70 VRMS, 96 dBA .- ------ -- - -..---------- E=-_"CCC'c-_-=-R----
7070
E-7025-LS-24-VF-R Speaker with 15 cd Strobe, -25-v-oC-lt-sp-e-a"ke-r--------- E-7025-LS-24-VF-R -----cWccHccE=E::-::LOCK 80mA ,:
E-7070-LS-24-VF-R Speak-er-with15 cd Strobe, 70 volt spea'C'ke-r----------- E-7070-LS-24-VF-R WHEELOCK BOmA ,
E-7070-LS-24-VF-W Speaker with 15 cd Strobe, 70 volt speaker WHEELOCK BOmA .
------- .. - - - ---E9025--:-L-=-S"C-:----=-C:-:Fcc--;-;----
E9025-LS-24-CF-W Speaker with Strobe, 15 VRMS, 15 cd 24 W WHEELOCK 80mA
E9070-LS-24-CF-W Spea-ke-rWlthStrDbe,-io VR"'MC":S"',C " 1 5 = - c - d : - - - - - - - - - - - - - E9070-LS-24-CF-W WHEELOCK BOmA '
..
----~-.-"'-'-~-~-;;;;.~;c;"'--"'-.~-~'____~.;..-._.. -- -~----.
Note: The speaker appliances listed above are the only speakers that may be used. However, any UL listed, 24 V DC nonspeaker
appliances (ie., horns, bells, strobes) may be used when using the RPS-424 Power Supply/Battery Charger that is regulated and UL
listed for fire signalling applications.
o COVER WITH
CIRCUIT BOARD
OXA-500SB ASSEMBLY
~
~
LED
~
~
~
~
@ @
Electrical
Box
Wall
Wall
Electrical Box - - - - - I
Module Cover ------l-=-=-=-== FLUSH MOUNT
~ _ _ Module
Cover
SURFACE MOUNT
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 157
6. This module requires no address setting since it is not
connected to the 2-way (multiplex) data circuit.
Wiring: 7. Connect terminals I/P+ and I/P- to the Signal Driver Module
1. Before connecting any module or device, make sure that the (OXA-500SM PIN 940526) output. Make sure the polarity is
wiring is correct and has been tested. correct.
2. All wiring to conform to current National Electrical Code, NFPA 8. Connect the Ul listed 22 k-ohm EOl resistor (P/N 976042) to
70, state, and local building code requirements and applicable EOl terminals (-) and (+).
notes. 9. Connect the 24 V output from the Ul listed regulated power
3. All conductors to be free of grounds. limited supply unit to the negative (OV) and positive (24V)
4. Disconnect power from the circuit before installing modules. terminals.
5. When making connections, break wire run, strip 3/8-inch 10. Connect the Ul listed signalling appliance making sure of
insulation from the ends of the wire, slide the bare ends of the correct polarity. Connect Ul listed 270-ohm, 5-W EOl device
wire under the terminal clamping plate, and tighten the (P/N 976043) to SDR+ and SDR-.
clamping screw. 11. Make sure EMI suppression device is installed.
(NOTE 5)
U.L. LISTED REGULATED, POWER LIMITED
24VDC SUPPLY
Figure 2. OXA-500SB Signal Expander Wiring. All circuits and connections are power Iimited/Class2.
Addressable Loop
The OXM-501 RM/SDA Motherboard provides connections for
Standby Current OmA
combinations of OXA-501 RM or OXA-503RM Relay Modules,
OXA-501 SDA Signal Driver Modules and/or 505SDA Notification Alarm Current OmA
Appliance Modules. Up to four OXM-501 RM/SDA Motherboards Addressable Loop Currents
can be mounted on a standard back plate.
For plug-in-modules per plug-in module
The OXA-501 can accommodate the following combinations of
plug-in boards: 1 to 3 OXA-501 RM Relay Modules; 1 to 3 INSTALLATION NOTES
OXA-501 SDA Signal Driver Modules; 1-3 505SDA Notification Ap-
pliance Modules. 1. Set loop address for each OXA-501 RM module (Refer to
Publication No. 19700224) or each OXA-503RM module (re-
Features fer to Publication 19700415); each OXA-501 SDA module
Two three-position terminal blocks provide for wiring TFX ad- (Refer to Publication No. 19700332); each 505SDA module
dressable loop. (Refer to Publication No. 19700473).
Three sets of two pluggable terminal blocks for relay and/or sig- 2. Install the RM and/or SDA modules in the correct sockets on
na! driver module installation. Module terminal blocks are keyed the OXM-501 RM/SDA Motherboard. Make sure each board
for correct board orientation during installation. is oriented correctly.
Three sets of output terminal blocks for sounder circuit output Important: When installing SDA modules, install the first
field wiring. SDA in position J1A-J1 S. That is, always
Three terminal blocks for relay and/or signal driver module field install SDA modules from left-to-right.
wiring. 3. When one or more modules are powered from the same
source, jumpers JP1-JP4 can be installed to connect the in-
put power from Module 1 (TS1) to Module 2 and Module 3.
Install jumpers JP1 and JP2 to connect input power from
Module 1 (TS1) to Module 2 (TS2); Install jumpers JP3 and
JP4to connect input power from Module 1 to Module 3 (TS3).
TERMINAL BLOCKS TB6, TB7,
TB8 FOR SIGNALING CIRCUIT
OUTPUTS STYLE Y OR STYLE Z SOCKETS FOR OXA-501/503RM AND
OXA-501 SDA or 505SDA MODULE
~~~T~B6~~I~~~~T~B~7~~~~1____~~~-'~ SOCKET KEYED FOR CORRECT
110 0 0 a 0 I (2) 1110 a 0 0 0 I 0 1,--0_0_ __
BOARD ORIENTATION
IJ
L- SHLDGJ J2B
J1B BLOCKS TB4, TB5
I, , SS+SLDSi.?+
illJ 00
00
SOCKETS J1, J2, J3 FOR OXA-501/503RM,
OXA-501SDA, 50SDA MODULE.
, , , TB5
J1A
00
J2A SOCKET KEYED FOR CORRECT BOARD
ORIENTATION
SEE IN~TALLATION NOTE 2
~~ ~ [ill J3B ~
00 ,
,
,
JUMPERS JP1 , JP2; JP3, JP4
FOR POWER INPUT TO J2
AND J3
: : J2A r~; J3A
MOUNTING PLATE
PIN 9647-001-002
TERMINAL BLOCKS TB1, TB2, TB3 USED FOR
COVER "POWER LIMITED" REF- OXM-501/503RM; DC INPUT FOR OXA-501 SDA AND
ERENCE WITH BLANK LABEL FOR 505SDA; AUDIO RISER FOR 50SDA NOTIFICATION
NON-POWER LIMITED APPLICATIONS APPLIANCE MODULE
SEE TABLE 1
TB1 (RM #3) Jumpers TB2 (RM #2) Jumpers TB3 (RM #1) Jumpers
1 N/O 1 N/O 1 N/O
2 (Not used) 2 (Not used) 2 (Not used)
Jumpers JP5-JP9 in Jumpers JP1 O-JP14 Jumpers JP15-JP19
3 N/C 3 N/C 3 N/C
"RM" position in "RM" position in "RM" position
4 (Not used) 4 (Not used) 4 (Not used)
5 COM 5 COM 5 COM
6 (Not Used) 6 (Not Used) 6 (Not Used)
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 171
SUPERVISED L- TFXAD- L+ SUPERVISED
IN OUT
POWER LIMITED DRESSABLE POWER LIMITED
L+ L-
CLASS 2 LOOP CLASS 2
NOTE 5 <I;::; ::::J
<~
~ P TB7
F
TB6 TB8 TERMINAL BLOCKS TB6, TB7,
I
s-
0
0
SLD 82-82+
a I Ia 0 a
TB4 r l r o
L+
0
L
a
SHLD
TB5l
RM 11"3 L- SHLD RM #2 RM #1
D Cd~,
D 'i,
~ J3
B ~ act~
,~
9;
d
J2
'jn
1
/
V
JUMPERS IN "RM"
POSITION
SEE TABLE 1
a~liIiJ iJ
TB1 RM#3
BaliliJiJ
TB2 RM #2 TB3 RM #1
Ba~ v ~~~'G~~~;:;_~o~~~U';rS6!~~3RM
MODULES IN J3, J2, J1, RESPEC-
TIVELY
t~~~QO ~~~~QO
123456
000000 UL LISTED
0 ::;; 00::;; ::;;
0 POWER UL LISTED EXTERNAL
0
z 8 z 0 f------ DEVICE/SWITCHABLE
1
z 0 z 0
111
0 z z 0 SUPPLY
(NOTE 6-B) CIRCUIT
f\
I I
I UL LISTED EXTERNAL
DEVICE/SWITCHABLE
CIRCUIT
\
VOLT FREE v/I
POWERED RELAY CIRCUIT
NOT SUPERVISED NOT SUPERVISED
POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2 POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2
SEE NOTE 6 (A) SEE NOTE 6 (B)
Figure 2. Typical wiring diagram for two OXM-501 RM or OXA-503RM relay modules.
STYLE Z SIGNALLING CIRCUIT
SUPERVISED
SUPERVISED POWER LIMITED /CLASS 2
POWER LIMITED NOTE 7(B)
CLASS 2
TFX ADDRESSABLE
LOOP IN L- NOTE 7 (B)
22 K-OHM NOTE 5
UL LISTED L+
\OTE7(A)
TFX ADDRESSABLE
ELR L+ LOOP OUT
L- NOTE 5
Figure 3. Typical Wiring for Signaling Circuit, OXA-501SDA Modules Installed on OXM-501 RM/SDA Motherboard.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 172
UL LISTED
27 KOHM
STYLE Y SIGNALLING CIRCUIT ELR
SUPERVISED NOTE 8 (A), 10
POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2
NOTE 8(A)
TFX ADDRESSABLE
LOOP IN L-
NOTE 5
SU PERVISED L+
POWER LIMITED
CLASS 2
TFX ADDRESSABLE
LOOP OUT
NOTE 5
TB8
INSTALL JUMPERS
IN JP1, JP2 FOR
POWER INPUT TO
J2
SEE INSTALLATION
NOTE 3 IaJ J2
JUMPERS IN "SDA"
POSITION nnnnn
I.! 0000 i;j 1;1;'\;/ \;/ IJ ~wfJ fJ
TB1 SDA#1 TB2 SDA#2 TB3 SDA#3
1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6 123456
TB1, TB2, TB3 AUDIO RISER 000000 000000 000000
INPUTS TO PLUG-IN 505SDA 1- 1+ SLDI- 1+ x 1- 1+ SLD 1- 1+ x 1- 1+ SLDI- 1+ x
NOTIFICATION APPLIANCE
MODULES IN J3, J2, J1 RE-
SPECTIVELY
NOTE 8(C) AUDIO RISER END-OF-L1NE RESISTOR IF
ELR THIS IS LAST BOARD ON AUDIO RISER-
AUDIO RISER UL LISTED NOTE 8(D)
5,1 KOHM
Figure 4. Typical Wiring for 505SDA Modules, Audio Application, Installed on OXM-50 1 RM/SDA Motherboard.
,~ ~
POWER LIMITED/CLASS 2
'\\
27 KOHM
NOTE 9(A) ELR
NOTE
? 9 (A)
TFX ADDRESSABLE
LOOP IN L+ SUPERVISED
L-
NOTE 5 POWER LIMITED
L- CLASS 2
SUPERVISED L+
POWER LIMITED
CLASS 2
(~
n 0 01
!
~
~
P
1s-0s+0 0 0 01
(~
P
p
0 0000
TFX ADDRESSABLE
LOOP OUT
NOTES
UL LISTED
POWER I
SUPPLY
(NOTE6-B)
Figure 5. Typical Wiring for 505SDA Module, DC Application, Installed on OXM-501 RM/SDA Motherboard.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 173
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience
installing and testing fire detection systems. These instructions do not
purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment described.
Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection
with installation, operation, or maintenance. All specifications are
subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems
arise which are not covered sufficiently for the user's purposes, the
matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company,
Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 174
MODULE POSITION
(See System Layout)
Space Requirement: 1/4 rear module space and 1 door
module space (rear mount)
IXM-500 CMA Motherboard Dimensions (whd): 4 X 5 1/4 X 3.125 inches (with
plug-in modules installed)
PCB PIN 900973,
Assembly No. 976184
Battery Requirements
Publication Number 19700383,
Standby Alarm
Issue 2, January 1997
The IXM-500 CMA Motherboard provides connections for com- IXM-500 CMA Motherboard OmA OmA
bination of 1 to 3 IXA-502CMA Contact Monitoring Modules. Up to Each Plug-in CMA Module 0.27 mA 027 mA
four IXM-500 Motherboards can be mounted on a standard back
plate. Installation Notes
1. Set loop address for each IXA-502CMA module (Refer to
Publication No. 19700333).
Features
Pluggable three-position terminal blocks provide for wiring TFX 2. Install the CMA modules in the correct sockets on the
addressable loop. IXM-500 CMA Motherboard. Make sure each board is ori-
ented correctly. When installing CMA modules, install the
Three sets of two terminal blocks for monitoring contacts. Mod-
first CMA in position J1 A-J1 B.
ule terminal blocks are keyed for correct board orientation
3. Instal! field wiring to terminal blocks.
during instaliation.
Terminal blocks for addressable loop and contact monitoring 4. Remove "Power Limited" label for TB1 if used with non-pow-
er limited source(s).
module field wiring.
J3B j J:f
(I)
, J1B
, J1A
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 175
Table 1. IXM-500 Terminal Block and Jumper Designations
I 000
1 2 3
liN OU~ OCIC
1 2 3
I
TB4 TB5
[J .'
[J , ~" []
~ ~ ~
,;" ~
'f~ ,? ~
Jl J2 J3
~I Iz
0 0 0
z
'ffi":::;---+ B
2.2K OHM UL LlSTE D ~
SUPERVISED
ON BOARD POWER LlMITEDI
NOTE5 CLASS 2
mm
UL LISTED
MONITORED DEVICE Typical Style B
WI "NORMALLY OPEN" PIN 976045
CONTACTS UL LISTED EOL
lKOHM
--
Ej
1
~/ ~
2.2K OHM UL LISTED 0
z z
0
0 0 o 0 lKOHM EOl
IDENTITY RESISTOR z z z z lKOHM EOL
ON BOARD
ON BOARD 2.2K OHM UL LISTED
ON BOARD 2.2K OHM UL LISTED / NOTE 7 NOTE 7
NOTE 5 IDENTITY RESISTOR
IDENTITY RESISTOR ON BOARD
ON BOARD NOTE 5
- 1K EOL UL
NOTE 5
P/N9760~
UL LISTED
MONITORED DEVICE UL LISTED NOTE 7
UL LISTED
UL LISTED EOL
lKOHM
NOTE 7
Figure 2. Typical Wiring for IXA-502CMA Modules (a) Style B, (b) Style C, (e) Style D, (d) Style E.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 177
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience
installing and testing fire detection systems. These instructions do not
purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment described.
Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection
with installation, operation, or maintenance. All specifications are
subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems
arise which are not covered sufficiently for the user's purposes, the
matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company,
Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 179
Sensitivity: 6. At the TFX control panel, select the "Reset point threshold
compensation" menu option from the System Test Menu or
enter Fast Access Code 0037.
Sensitivity range may be selected during system programming 7. Select the loop on which the detector is installed.
using TFX-500/800 CONSYS, Version 3.0 and above and Firm- 8. Enter the point address number of the device. The display will
ware Version 3.2 and above. Refer to Publication 850463, show [point no. xx update successful] where xx is the actual
TFX-500/BOO CONSYS Programming Guide. point number. If the selected device has not been configured,
the display will show [Point not found]. If the device is not an
Address Cards analog addressable detector, the display will show [invalid, try
Sets offactory-set Addressable Xpert Cards are available. Use the again].
following part numbers to order.
ISN550P Photoelectric Detector
Addresses Part Number
The ISN-550P Photoelectric Smoke Detector responds to visible
Ai-ABO 92016B smoke particles from flaming and smoldering fires using light
81-8BO 920169
scattering properties of those particles. It does not detect gas, heat,
er flames.
C1-CBO 920170
01-0BO An infrared LED inside the chamber emits a burst of collimated light
every 0.5 second which in clean air conditions can not be scattered
E1-EBO 920171
Fl-F80
into the sensing photo-diode. See Figure 3. When smoke does
enter the chamber, light is scattered by the smoke particles and
G1-GBO 920172 detected by the photo-diode and the detector goes into alarm.
H1-H80
J1-JaO
K1-KaO
920173 r COLLECTOR
Aa1-A126 920174
8B1-8126
C81-C126
081-0126
920175 .,..
I
I
E81-E126 920176 I
F81-F126 u I
I
G81-G126 920177 --L.
H81-H126
J81-J126
K81-K126
Blank Card Set (50) 920178 Figure 3 Detector Type Ionization
~
\,,0
There are two fixed temperature detectors in the IHN analog Example: Where smooth ceilings are present, 30 foot spacing may
addressable heat detector series. The (IHN-135) is rated as be considered. Areas that employ beams or other obstructions
Normal and alarms at 135 oF. The (IHN-200) is rated as extending more than 18 inches below the ceiling such obstructions
Intermediate and alarms at 200 of. should designate a new separation point and be considered a new
section. Areas that employ beams or other obstructions extending
IBN-553 Relay Base and IBN-554 Sounder Base more than 8 inches but less than 18 inches, spacing should be
Programming of RESET time reduced at the perpendicular of such obstruction to compensate.
For differing styles of construction consult NFPA Handbook,
When "power off" is used to reset either the1BN-553 Analog Section 72.
Addressable Relay Base (PIN 920194) or I BN-554 Analog
Addressable Sounder Base (PIN 920195), at least four (4) seconds Remember: In order for a detector to operate, combustion
of "power off" is required for RESET. Use CONSYS to program a products must enter the outer chamber. Air flow, stratification,
delay of at least four (4) seconds before power is restored to these velocity, stagnation, and migration all affect the efficiency and
detector bases. See Figures 9 and 11. accuracy of the installation. Air flow meters may be utilized.
Detector Operation and Application DO NOT INSTALL smoke detectors in areas where
temperatures are likely to exceed 100 degrees F or fall
Under normal standby conditions, the detector LED flashes when below 32 degrees F.
the detector is polled. When the smoke level exceeds the alarm DO NOT INSTALL detectors closer than 4 inches to side
threshold, an alarm is triggered at the control panel. The detector wall.
LED then lights steadily. DO NOT INSTALL detectors where forced ventilation can
dilute the smoke from a fire.
The 550 Series Smoke and Heat Detectors meet the requirements DO NOT INSTALL detectors near air conditioning vents.
DO NOT INSTALL ion or photo detectors in known areas of
of UL 268, 268A, and 521 for use in fire alarm signalling systems combustion such as kitchens, furnace rooms, etc.
as well as for dust, corrosion, vibration, shock, and impact
resistance. Testing the Wiring
Fire alarm system applications of the 550 Series detectors include
industrial, commercial, and institutional ceiling or wall installations. Before connecting any module or device on the input zone circuit,
Install the 550 Series detectors in accordance with UL 268, 268A, make sure that the wiring is correct and has been tested.
521, NFPA 72, and all local codes and ordinances.
By following the items listed in NFPA 72, base the number and
location of detectors on an engineering survey of the area to be
protected.
Consider:
Contents to be protected
Type of construction and use
Is there human occupancy
Burning characteristics of contents
Space involved
Height of ceilings
Surface condition of ceilings
Total area
Air movement--stratification
Vent locations--velocities--dilution
Deflections and obstructions
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 181
Base Installation
rhe IBN-553/554 bases mount directly to 4-inch square and 4-inch TYPICAL ELECTRICAL / BACKPLATE
)ctagonal electrical boxes. The IBN-552 base mounts directly to BOX (SEE TEXT)
3-1/2-inch square, 4-inch square, and 4-inch octagonal electrical BASE RING
)oxes. See Figure 6. and Figure 7.
~
WARNING: Ceiling bases should be mounted at least 4
/
inches from the wall. Wall bases should be mounted
--~
between 4 and 12 inches from the ceiling.
~.
9.
IBN-553/554 Installation
Orient the base so that its LED can be easily viewed after the
detector is installed. Use the Alignment Mark (raised line) on
o --~
the base as a guide to orient the base (when the head is
installed, the LED will be aligned with the alignment mark). See -.a
"Installing the Detector to the Base" in this guide.
~
u/
8-32 SCREWS
-TYPICAL
(NOT INCLUDED)
\ ELECTRICAL BOX \ DETECTOR BASE
\ (see text)
DETECTOR BASE
~,
, / IBN-553, IBN-554
Figure 7 Base instaliation, IBN-552
2. Secure the base to the electrical box with the two 8-32
pan-head, zinc-plated steel screws (not supplied) as in Figure
7.
o Note: For some electrical boxes, you may have to separate the
back plate from the detector base, secure the back plate to the
electrical box with the two 8-32 pan-head, zinc-plated steel screws
(not supplied), and then secure the base to the back plate with two
8-32 steel screws (supplied) as shown in Figure 7.
8-32 SCREWS
(NOT INCLUDED)
CONTROL UNIT
ADDRESSABLE
LOOP.
To Next Device
Addressable Loop
Supervised
Power Limited
J
Note 4
+ 0-+--+-1------'
Figure 10 Wiring Schematic for IBN-553 Relay Base (Provides individual non-silenceable,
resettable, relay base activation-wiring is shown in supervisory state.) Reset-
table 24 Voc must be off for at least 4 seconds to reset the IBN-553 Relay Base.
CONTROL TO NEXT
UNIT DEVICE
+ -
U AUTOCALL
TFX-500/800
2-WAYDATA
~~"
CIRCUIT
;#
L+
L-
OXA-501SDA
L+
L- W BASE
"
OXA-504SDA SR+ r-l-I--~ IBN-553
CIRCUIT
DRIVES~O:~6uLE** SR- STYLEY BASE
IBN-553
S+
S- 27KOHM
24+ U.L. LISTED EOL
OV PIN 976250
* NOT INCLUDED
- +
24VDC
POWER
LED SUPPLY
(BEHIND) UL listed for Fire **MAXIMUM NUMBER OF 30 BASES MAY BE INSTALLED PER OXA-501 SDA OR
"SUPERVISED" Protective OXA-504SDA SIGNAL DRIVER MODULE. FOR MORE SIGNAL DRIVER MODULE
POWER LIMITED Signaling INFORMATION, REFER TO PUBLICATION 19700332.
Figure 11 Wiring Schematic for IBN-553 Relay Base with OXA-501 SDA or OXA-504SDA
Signal Driver Module (Provides zone non-sillenceable, resettable relay base
activation. (All base relays activate at the same time-wiring shown in
supervisory state.)
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 184
CAUTION! DO NOT USE LOOPED WIRE UNDER SOUNDER BASE TERMINALS.
BREAK WIRE RUN TO PROVIDE SUPERVISION OF CONNECTIONS. SHIELD
TOPANELDCC--~----------------------------~----------------~~~--------~~--------------------
AUTO CALL 2-WAY DATA SIG-
NALLING CIRCUIT
+
TO NEXT DEVICE
CONTROL UNIT
CIRCUIT
tu
UJ CONTACT
LU
a:
+ MONITORING
OT SUPERVISED
I!;I MODULE
U.L. LISTED 24
VOLT EOL RELAY'
EJ IXA-501 CM
RPS-424 24V DC
POWER SUPPLY
UL listed for Fire
'NOT INCLUDED
RECOMMEND AIR PRODUCTS
PAM-2 PIN 19240410
/ 619 ohm, 0.2S watt
PIN 976081
This contact is needed to restore the sounder when the panel is reset (it is open during normal operation). Use any available
normally-closed TFX relay contacts (for example, alarm or trouble relay on the Main Processor board) or OXA-502/503RM
addressable relay module. When programming the TFX control panel, assign the relay as "output normally ON," "General
Purpose output," assign the relay to Group OS174 "RESET in Progress O/P All Zones."
General Note: Sounders are non-silencable, but restorable on panel reset.
Figure 12 Wiring Schematic for IBN-554 Sounder Base (Provides individual non-silenceable, reset-
table audible alarm-wiring shown with base in supervisory state.) Resettable 24 Voc must
be off for at least 4 seconds to reset the IBN-554 Sounder Base.
CAUTION! DO NOT USE LOOPED WIRE UNDER SOUNDER BASE TERMINALS.
BREAK WIRE RUN TO PROVIDE SUPERVISION OF CONNECTIONS. SHIELD
TOPANELDCC---------------------.--------------------------~._----------------------------~---
TO NEXT
CONTROL
UNIT DEVICE
+ -
U AUTO CALL
TFX-SOO/800
2-WAY DATA
CIRCUIT
~ ~~"
L+
ON L-
~
L+
OXA-S01SDA L- BASE
"
T-+--'--~ IBN-SS4
OX~~~~~DA SR+ CIRCUIT
DRIVER MODULE- SR- STYLEY BASE
IBN-SS4
S+
S- 27KOHM
24+ U.L. LISTED EOL
OV PIN 976250
- +
24VDC
POWER 'NOT INCLUDED
LED SUPPLY
(BEH!ND) UL listed for
"SUPERVISED" Fire Protective
POWER LIMITED Signaling
Figure 13 Wiring Schematic for IBN-554 Sounder Base with OXA-501SDA or OXA-504SDA Signal
Driver Module. Provides zonal non-silenceable, resettable sounder base activation (All bases sound
alarm at the same time-wiring shown is for base in supervisory state.)
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 185
CAUTION! DO NOT USE LOOPED WIRE UNDER RELAY BASE TERMINALS.
BREAK WIRE RUN TO PROVIDE SUPERVISION OF CONNECTIONS. SHIELD
TO PANELDCC
CONTROL
UNIT
TO NEXT
I
DEVICE
c
;:#
r-~----n:::t-.-----1 ~ " BASE
IBN553
CONTACT
OXA502RM MONITORING
PIN 976258 "SUPERVISED'
POWER LIMITED
I!!!I MODULE
EI IXA501 CM
L..+-_____
* NOT INCLUDED
..J
- KI :::: RELAY
CAN BE ANY 2 FORM C (BREAK BE
FORE MAKE) 24 V UL LISTED FOR
v
K2 = U.L. LISTED
/ /
619 ohm, 0.25 watt
PIN 976081
FIRE PROTECTIVE SIGNALING SER EOL RELAY (Air Products & Con- UL LISTED EOL
+ VICE. POWER SUPPLY MUST BE trols Model PAM-2 PIN 19240410 PIN 976082
RPS424 RPS424 OR OTHER REGULATED 24 V EOLRELAY
REGULATED SUPPLY LISTED FOR FIRE PROTEC * NOT INCLUDED
24Vnc
POW'E'R
SUPPLY
I Figure 14 TIVE SIGNALING SERVICE
CONTROL
UNIT
TO NEXT
OXA-502RM + - DEVICE
RELAY MODULE
PIN 976258 AUTOCALL
TFX-500/800
2-WAYDATA TOP
CIRCUIT VIEW
!",,,k,,,, l~:
liP'S c
;#
~"
LED c+
(B~ND) c BASE
COM IBN-554
K1A
(NOT USED)N.C. CONTACT
N/C MONITORING
(NOT USED) N.C. I!!I MODULE
N/O
EI IXA-501 CM
TB1 / PIN 976081
K2 = U.L. LISTED
EOL RELAY (Air Products & Con- 619 ohm, 0.25 watt
K1 = RELAY trols Model PAM-2 PIN 19240410 UL LISTED EOL
CAN BE ANY 2 FORM C (BREAK EOLRELAY
BEFORE MAKE) 24 V UL LISTED PIN 976082
FOR FIRE PROTECTIVE
* NOT INCLUDED
+ SIGNALING SERVICE. POWER
RPS424 UL listed SUPPLY MUST BE RPS-424 OR
REGULATED for Fire OTHER REGULATED 24 V SUP
24VDC Protective PLY LISTED FOR FIRE PROTEC-
POWER Signaling TIVE SIGNALING SERVICE.
SUPPLY * NOT INCLUDED
Figure 15 Wiring Schematic for IBN-554 Sounder Base with OXA-502RM Relay
Module to activate individual sounders within a zone or all on one zone
when desired. (Typical wiring shown is for base in supervisory state.)
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 186
550 Series Address Data Card Installing the Detector to the Base
Address Remove Buttons Address Remove Buttons AddressRemove Buttons
,~ ,~ ,~
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 188
3. Gripping the photoelectric chamber firmly, rotate it counter- c. Enter the point address number ofthe device. The display
clockwise and lift it away from the detector. will show [point no. xx update successful] where xx is
4. Use a vacuum cleaner to remove any dirt from both the bug the actual point number. If the selected device has not
screen and the baffles inside the photoelectric chamber. been configured, the display will show [Point not found].
5. A clean artist's paint brush can also be used to remove dust If the device is not an analog addressable detector, the
particles from within the baffles. Do not use the paint brush to display will show [invalid, try again].
remove dust from the bug screen--the screen may be 10. Test the device in the system. Refer to Autocall TFX-500/BOO
damaged. Operation Manual and Installation Guide, Publication No.
6. After cleaning replace the black photoelectric chamber and 850462, for further information.
rotate it clockwise until it snaps into position. Replace the white 11. Notify the appropriate authorities that the cleaning operation is
smoke lid and secure it using the two Phillips screws. complete and the system is active again.
7. Re-install the detector in its base.
8. Test the device in the system. Refer to Autocall TFX-500/BOO Detector Head
Operation Manual and Installation Guide, Publication No. ~ _ A n t i -Tamper_ ~
850462, for further information. 'W . screwS ,~
9. Notify the appropriate authorities that the cleaning operation is
I (use special driver PIN 920112) I
complete and the system is active again.
,4
head by using suction from a vacuum cleaner. Use the following E BE: ::: iE;; :i: ;
procedure. - -
CAUTION: In order to clean the bug screen in this detector the unit b,
\\J\ !V/
must be partially dismantled to a stage which exposes
the radioactive Americium 241 foil to the person
carrying out the maintenance work. Cleaning opera-
tions which involve exposing the radioactive foil shall
~ V
only be carried out by maintenance personnel who Figure 19 Disassembly of Ionization
have received appropriate training and are authorized Detector Head for Cleaning
under relevant legislation to do so. Read these
instructions carefully before proceeding to clean Warnings and Limitations
the detector.
Smoke detectors will not work without power. System powered
1 . Remove the detector head from the base. See Figure 19. smoke detectors will not work if the power supply or connections
2. Using the special anti-tamper screwdriver, PIN 920112, to the fire control panel are cut off for any reason. Interconnecting
remove the two anti-tamper screws located on the under side wiring must be able to carry the total indicating appliance current,
of the detector and lift off the smoke lid. in alarm, without excessive line voltage drop.
3. Hold the main body of the detector firmly in one hand and grip
the ionization chamber in the other. Rotate the ionization
chamber counter-clockwise until it snaps free and then lift it off Smoke must reach the detector. Smoke from fires in enclosed
the detector. The radioactive foil is gold-colored and is located places, roofs, or behind closed doors may not reach the detector
behind the hole in the center of the metal disk that is exposed to alarm it.
when the ionization chamber is removed.
4. At this point the radioactive foil is exposed. Be careful not to Smoke detectors may not sense all fires: Rapidly spreading fires
touch the foil or cause dust or other contamination to get onto or explosions caused by escaping gas and improper storage of
it. Dust particles or fibers present on the foil will impair the flammable materials or arson may not be detected.
operation of the detector.
5. The ionization chamber can be cleaned on the inside and
outside using a vacuum cleaner. A clean artist's paint brush can Smoke detectors wear out. Smoke detectors contain electronic
be used to remove dust from between the fins inside the smoke parts that could fail at any time.
chamber. Avoid damaging the bug screen when using an
artist's brush.
6. After cleaning, replace the ionization chamber. Make sure it
Radioactive Material: ISN-5501 Smoke detectors contain
snaps back into position when it is rotated clockwise. The
less than 0.9 microcuries Americium 241. Do not attemDt
detector will not operate properly if it is not seated correctly.
disassembly of the sensing chamber. This assembly must
7. Replace the smoke lid and secure it in position using the two
anti-tamper screws. remain sealed for your protection. For service or disposal,
8. Re-install the detector to its base. return detector head, intact, to: Grinnell Fire Protection
9. Reset the Point Threshold Compensation. Systems Company, Inc, 835 Sharon Drive, Westlake, Ohio
a. Atthe TFXcontrol panel, select the "Reset pointthreshold 44145.
compensation" menu option from the "System Test" menu
or enter Fast Access Code 0037.
b. Select the loop on which the detector is installed.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 190
Specifications
Environment:
Operating Temperature: 32F to 100F (OC to 38C)
Air Flow Velocity: 300 to 4000 feet per minute.
ISN-550 Series Analog Addressable Operating Humidity: 10% to 85% (non-condensing)
Smoke Duct System
ISN-550DI (PIN 920102) Electrical:
ISN-550DP (PIN 920103)
Ionization Photoelectric
Publication Number 850507 ISN-550DI ISN-550DP
Issue 2, January 1997 Battery Requirements
Current Draw
The Series ISN-550 Analog Addressable Smoke Duct Systems Standby Current 0.20 mA 0.30 mA
(Figure 1) are designed for use with Autocall TFX-500 and TFX-800
fire control panels. They are designed to provide early detection Alarm Current 4.00 mA 4.20 mA
of smoke and combustion by-products present in the air moving Alarm with remote LED 5.70 mA 5.90 mA
through an HVAC duct. The series ISN-550 systems are available
Addressable LoopCurreots
in ionization or photoelectric types. Refer to Publication Number
850505, 550 Series Analog Addressable Detectors and Bases. 10 Current 3.0-4.0 mA 5.2-6.8 mA
Clean Air Condition 4.6-8.0 mA 7.0-10.0 mA
The ISN-550DP Photoelectric Smoke Duct System responds to Current
visible smoke particles from flames and smoldering fires using light (Normal Condition)
scatterina techniaues. The ISN-350DI Ionization Smoke Duct
Syst;';m resp-o-nds tc;~i~ible~ndinvisibl~ particl;~ p~~d~~~din fi~e-~ Alarm Threshold
(selectable through
I
Above 1i .4 mA IAbove 10.7 mA
using ionization techniques. Neither of these detects gas, heat, or
flames.
I programming)
Other
Fire alarm system applications of the Series ISN-550 Systems Max Devices per loop 99 99
include industrial, commercial, and institutional HVAC duct installa- Remote LED 4.5 mA 4.5mA
tions. Install the Series ISN-550 Systems in accordance with UL Max Current
268A, NFPA 72, NFPA gOA, and all local codes, regulations, and
ordinances. Refer to the NEMA Guide for Proper Use of System Light/Radioactivity Americium 241 GaAs Infra-red
Smoke Detectors, Publication No. 850460. Source (0.9 [lCuries) Emitting Diode
L length needed to cover the full width of the duct on which the unit
is installed.
Figure 1: The ISN-550 Series Smoke Duct System
WARNING: Disengage all alarm signaling devices, extin-
guishing systems, and releasing devices before testing the
circuit.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 191
Mechanical Installation Duct Hall
I
7 I
I
I. MOUNTING Template Stopper
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 192
II. ELECTRICAL INSTALLATION
A. GENERAL INFORMATION ISN-550 DUCT HOUSING
Wiring must conform to applicable local codes, ordinances, and Detector Connections (Within
regulations covering this type of device. Terminals are capable of Housing)
accepting up to #14 AWG wire.
B. DETECTOR WIRING AND ADDRESSING L2 -R
CAUTION: Wires should not be looped under the terminals 1, or
2.
1. If the detector head was not removed previously, remove it.
2. De-energize the power source.
3. Install address XPERT Card.
4. Wire the detector according to the engineering drawings for 2
this installation. (See Figure 5.)
C. TESTING THE INSTALLATION
1. Install the detector head. Locate the Alignment Mark (raised
line) on the detector base, align the LED on the side of the Detector
detector head with the alignment mark on the base. Place the Connections
FIrE'! NOT
detector onto the base and turn counterciocl\wise until the
P~~;itY sen-I \lV \
head seats into the base.
2. With all wiring in place, verify proper voltage and connections
then energize the detector power source.
sitive
II /
/ ~~~ervised
Power Limited/
3. After the TFX-500/BOO has been programmed with the correct /c~~ Class 2
device address and other functional information, test the Remote LED Wiring Must
device in the system. This can be done by verifying that the Have Polarity as Shown
clean air condition current is within the range shown in the
electrical specification table. For further information refer to
TFX-500/BOO Operator's Manual and Installation Guide, Publi-
cation No. B50462.
Supervised
Power Limited
----- - ---------------
4. Replace the cover. Class 2
Mounting
Screws
(four
places) o
SIG - SIG + RET + RET -
II II
Figure 5: System Wiring Diagram.
Figure 4: Detector Base and Connections for
ISN-550 Series.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 193
Warnings and Limitations Detector Maintenance
lS~~-550 S6iies Smoke Duct Systems vvill not wOik if the pOvVei
supply or connections to the fire control panel are cut off for any
reason.
Radioactive Material: ISN-550DI Analog Addressable Duct
Smoke must reach the detector. Smoke from fires external to the Smoke Detectors contain less than 1.0 microcuries Ameri-
duct being protected may not reach the detector to trigger it. cium 241. Do not attempt disassembly of the sensing
Additional area protecting devices are therefore recommended. chamber. This assembly must remain sealed for your
protection. For service or disposal, return detector head,
Smoke detectors may not sense all fires: Rapidly spreading fires intact, to: Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company, Inc,
or explosions caused by escaping gas and improper storage of 835 Sharon Drive, Westlake, Ohio 44145.
flammable materials or arson may not be detected.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 194
Operating Temperature: 32 0 F to 120 0 F
Operating Humidity: 85% (non-condensing)
Dimensions (wdh): 14.4 X 10.8 X 5.2 inches
Issue 2, January 1997 'For current draw of Serial Interface Module PIN 976262, Refer to Publication 19700419
AUTO CALL Model LX-300 printer provides a permanent record in Table 2: Socket S1 Pin-out designations
English of system data. The LX-300 Printer is recommended for Pin Signal name Direction Description
use at the system control unit or at remote location(s) when the 1 Protective Ground -- Printer's chassis ground
printer is used as a secondary annunciator. English-language char- 2 Transmitted data (TXD/SD Out Printer has transmitted serial data
acters are printed at a rate of 220 characters per second with up to 3 Received data (RXD/RD In Printer has received serial data
80 characters per line. Applicable Systems include: AUTOCALL 4 Request to Send (RTS/ Out Always positive
3800 Series, AUTOCALLAL-1500 and AL-1500E; AUTOCALL RS)
system applications consult your system representative). 7 Signal Ground (SG) -- Return path for data control signals
'IECHNiCAL DA'IA:
.8-10 -- -- . Not used
9 -- -- Not used
Print method: Serial impact dot matrix
12-19 -- -- Not used
Print head: 9 pin
20 Data Terminal Ready Out Positive when the printer is ready to
Print Direction: Bi-directional (DTR/ER) accept data, and negative when the
Paper feed: Friction feed or pin feed tractor printer is not ready
0000000000000
000000000000
1
14
7
12. Caution: To prevent damage to the printer, do not use the
parallel interface connections.
13. Refer to the manual supplied with the printer for additional in-
formation.
14. Program the LX-300 Printer for operation with AUTOCALL
systems (refer to Tables 3, 4, 5, and 7)
15. May be used with 5200-477 DC / AC Inverter for Battery
Stand-by. Refer to publication MP-52 for more information.
Paper release
lever
-.......... Paper-feed
knob
Power switch
Control panel
Connector
Figure 1: LX-300 Printer PIN 976264.
eS00006
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 195
120 VAC 60 HZ
NON-POWER
LIMITED
PIN 940578 SUPERVISED
Cable Assembly
PIM-550 Maximum Length 50 ft NOTE 2
PIN 976018 See Detail "A" RS-232
Note 1 NOTES 3,4
SERIAL
PL1 TO MPIM P/N/976015
Jack for PORT
Ribbon Cable SERIAL PORT
to MPIM NOTE i
PRINTER
Jack for
Ribbon Cable '<. DC" '"17.1")
r,"':)-'"-.J.
to MPIM PL41 " Supervised
Power Limited
1 - - - - - - - - - - IN SAME ROOM
-----~----
DETAIL "A"
/ ,,
I
(, )
I
----------
/
/
Figure 2: AUTOCALL TFX-500/BOO, TFX-500M/BOOM, TFX-500MV/BOOMV System
using PIM-550 Printer Interface Module and MPIM. All circuits and connections are
power limited/Class 2 unless otherwise noted as non-power limited.
Notes, Figure 2: TFX-500/800, TFX-500M/800M, Table 3: LX-300 Settings for TFX-500/500M, TFX-800/800M,
TFX-500MV/800MV Application with PIM-550 Module TFX-500MV/800MV with PIM-550 Module Printer Configuration
1. Refer to Publication 197002S3, AUTOCALL PIM-550 Printer Function Setting
Interface Module P/N 976018, and Publication No.
Character spacing 10 cpi
19700235, AUTOCALL TFX Multi-Purpose Interface Module
(MPIM) P/N 976015, for more information. Refer to the Shape of zero (0
User's Manual supplied with the LX-300 printer for setup in- 1 inch skip-over-perforation OFF
formation.
Character table PC 437
2. For use with the TFX-SOO/800, TFX-SOOM/800M,
TFX-SOOMV/800MV, the LX-300 printer must be configured Auto line feed OFF
as shown in Table 3:. Page length 11 inches
3. Maximum cable length should not exceed SO feet. Use Cable
PIN 940578. Connect to RS232 serial port of LX-300 printer Auto tear off OFF
Interface Board (P/N 940S4S). Tractor Single
4. Maintain at least 0.2S inch clearance between power limited
Interface Auto selection (10 sec.)
and non-power limited circuit wiring. Use cable ties or some
other permanent means. Serial IIF bit rate 4800 bps
TFX Programming for LX-300 Operation Serial IIF parity bit None
TFX-SOO/SOOM, TFX-800/800M, and TFX-SOOMV/800MV require Serial IIF data length 8 bit
programming using CONSYS. The following printer parameters
Serial IIF ETXjACK ON
need to be programmed:
1. Select "Digital I/O" Menu Option.
2. Select the MPIM to which the PIM-SSO module is attached
(for example, MPIM Local Bus 01, PIB-L).
3. Define device as I/P (Norm. Lo) which enables RS232 Online
Detect.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 196
120 VAC 60 HZ
MPIM PIN 976015 6-INCH
CABLE ASSEMBLY PIN 940578
Note 1 CABLE
MAXIMUM LENGTH 50 FT SERIAL INTERFACE MOD- 19600221 NON-POWER
NOTES 3, 4 ULE PIN 976262
SEE DETAIL "A" LIMITED
SEE NOTE 1 SUPERVISED
PRINTER
PL3
RS-232
" Supervised
Serial Port Power Limited
~------------------------------INSAMEROOM
/'
/ ~ ----------
r-;i?-
DETAIL "A"
",
(\
~ ~~-;;;~~ \
/
"" ----- - - - - - - - - - - - ---
Figure 3: AUTOCALL TFX-500/BOO, TFX-500M/BOOM, TFX-500MV/BOOMV System with Serial Interface Module
976262 Typical Printer Application Wiring Diragram. All circuits and connections are power limited/Class 2 unless
otherwise noted as non-power limited.
Notes, Figure 3: TFX-500/800, TFX-500M/800M, Table 4: LX-300 Settings fDr TFX-SOOISOOM, TFX-BOOIBOOM,
TFX-500MV/800MV Application with Isolator Module TFX-SOOMVIBOOMV with Serial Interface Module 976262 Printer
1. Refer to Publication 19700419, Serial Interface Module Configuration
PIN 976262, and Publication 1970023S, AUTOCALL TFX Function Setting
Multi-Purpose Interface Module (MPIM) PIN 976015, for
Character spacing 10 cpi
more information. Refer to the User's Manual supplied with
the LX-300 printer for setup information. IShape of zero
2. For use with the TFX-SOO/800, TFX-SOOM/800M, 1 inch skip-over-perforation OFF
TFX-500MV/800MV the LX-300 printer must be configured
Character table PC 437
as shown in Table 4:.
3. Maximum cable length should not exceed SO feet. Use Cable Auto line feed OFF
PIN 940578. Connect RS232 serial port PL3 of MPIM to Page length 11 inches
RS232 serial port S1 of Serial Interface Module PIN 976262;
connect cable 19600221 to RS232 serial port of LX-300 I Auto tear off
printer. Tractor Single
4. Maintain at least 0.2S inch clearance between power limited
Interface Auto selection (10 sec.)
and non-power limited circuit wiring. Use cable ties or some
other permanent means. Serial IIF bit rate 4800 bps
TFX Programming for LX-300 Operation Serial ifF parity bit None
TFX-SOO/SOOM and TFX-800/800M require programming using Serial IIF data length 8 bit
CONSYS. The following printer parameters need to be pro-
Serial IIF ETX/ACK ON
grammed:
1. Select "Digital I/O" Menu Option.
2. Select the MPIM to which the printer is attached (for exam-
ple, MPIM Local Bus 00, OIB-L).
3. Define device as I/P (Norm. Lo) which enables RS232 Online
Detect.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 197
To Power
Supply
5200-478
25 - 36
V-EXPANDER MODULE
,........,
NOT USED
A B C 5130- 25 0 OV 37
5130-091-20
JUMPERS 5130-091-19 J~9~p~~S 26 0 OV 38
JP1-IN
JP1 - IN 27 0
JP2 - IN +24 39
JP3 IN
28 0 +24 40
JP4 - IN
JP5 - IN
JP6 - IN 29 0 DCC 41
D
30 0 DCC 42
31 0 DCC 43 0
SERIAL To Module
32 0 OUT + 44 0 Below
33 0 SERIAL
OUT- 45 0
34 0 DCC 46 0
SERIAL
DCCr 5 35 0
IN+ 47 0
L60 SERIAL
IN- 48 0
I SERIAL INTERFACE
MODULE PIN 975262
SEE NOTE 1 r--~-----I
Figure 4: AL-1500 Application using printer port of V-Master Logic Module PIN 5200-469 or V-Ex-
pander Module 5200-478 and Serial Interface Module PIN 976262. All circuits are non-power limited.
Notes Figure 4: AUTOCALL AL-1500 and AL-1500E Table 5: LX-300 Settings for AL-1500IAL-1500E V-Master Log-
Applications, RS-232 Communications ic RS232 Serial Printer Output System Configuration
1. Refer to Publication 19700419, Serial Interface Module Function Setting
PIN 976262, and Publication No. MP-38 V-Master Logic
Character spacing 10 cpi
Module PIN 5200-469, Publication No. MP-54,AUTOCALL
V-Expander Module Assembly PIN 5200-478, for installa- Shape of zero 0
tion and wiring details. for more information. Refer to the 1 inch skip-over-perforation OFF
User's Manual supplied with the video terminal for setup in-
formation. Character table PC 437
2. This V-Master Logic Module must be the main V-Master Log- Auto line feed OFF
ic Module for the system. For use with the AL-1500 V-Master Page length 11 inches
Logic Module, the LX-300 printer must be configured as
shown in Table 5:. Auto tear off OFF
3. Maximum cable length should not exceed 50 feet. Use Cable Tractor Single
PIN 19600222. Connect J4 serial port of the V-Master Logic
Interface Auto selection (10 sec.)
Module to RS232 port (S1) of Serial Interface Board
(PIN 976262); connect cable PIN 19600221 to RS232 serial Serial IIF bit rate Configuration dependent upon
port of LX-300 printer. AL-1500 firmware programming
Serial IIF parity bit ODD
Serial IIF data length 7 bit
Serial IIF ETXjACK ON
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 198
A B C 25 0 ov 37 0
5130-091- 5130-
O~ 0iDc'C'", 01~ 20 5130-091-19 j~T~p~~s 0 ov 38 0
5200-478 26
V-EXPANDER
""
026uTg, 02;UTG; 02eh
9
"
9
8"
..J
JUMPERS
JP1 - IN
JP1-IN
27 0 +24 39 0
MODULE 030UT ;;;! 030LJT;;;' 030-UT ~ JP2 - IN 28 0 +24 40 0
+ ~ + ~ + ~ JP3 - IN
JP4 IN
0 4 IN ~ 0 4 eN ~ 04 IN ~
-
29 0 DCC 41 0
JP5 - IN
NOTE 5 JP6 - 0
05 IN fl 0 5 IN fl 0 5 iN fl IN 30 0 DCC 42 0
Shield ~ --/ --/
~ 06'DCc';: 06~ OV [ ' 0
20
31 0 DCC 43 0
070UT "
g; 07;UT8070~Tg,""
r
Return (DCC) SERIAL
32 0 OUT + 44 0
9 ...J 9 O 0 SERIAL
Serial OUT- +24 VDC 33 OUT- 45 0
8 0lJT ;;' 08 OUT;;;! 08 OUT;;'
ffi ffi ffi 40
34 0 DCC 46 0
-" 09+ " ' 09+
IN <c IN
"~' 0 9+ "'
IN <c
II SERIAL
0: E E 0
DCC [ 50 35 IN+ 47 0
~ 0 10 IN fl 010 iN fl 010 IN fl
~ --/ ~ 60 SERIAL
Q. 36 0 IN- 48 0
o
9
-"
if
w
(j)
120 VAC 60 HZ D ---
DETAIL "A"
E SEE DETAIL "A"
,
TH~\,
o
'" / '" 2
DTR
3 4
81G.
,
WIRING THAT LEAVES TB CTS RT8 RXD COM.
BUILDING MUST BE RUN
UNDERGROUND
AWAY FROM ANY HIGH
VOLTAGE W!R!NG.
AND
\ t
RS232 ( TB1 1@@1001 \ i
L--....-f--I--~,....----- -~~II
SERIAL
PORT I
PRINTER I I /
/
--- ----
TOAB TO A6
.;
20 rnA NOT SUPERVISED
MAX WIRE GAUGE NO. 12 AWG
MAXIMUM LENGTH 240,000 FT FOR NO. 12 AWG
NOTE 4 -
Figure 5: AL -1500 Application using printer port of V-Master Logic Module 20 mA communica-
tions and Serial Interface Module PIN 976262 (all circuits are non-power limited).
Notes Figure 5: AUTOCALL AL1500 and AL1500E Cabling." Connect to 20 rnA circuit from 5200-478 V-Ex-
Applications, 20 rnA Communications pander Module to 20 rnA terminal block TB1 serial port of
1. Refer to Publication 19700419, Serial Interface Module Serial Interface Board (PIN 976262). See Table 6:.
PIN 976262, and Publication No.MP-38, V-Master Logic 5. Shields must be tied to DCC only as shown on field wiring
Module, and Publication MP-54, V-Expander Module PIN drawing (one end at control unit only) and must be free ofoth-
5200-478, for more information. Refer to the User's Manual er grounds.
supplied with the video terminal for setup information. Table 7: LX-300 Printer Settings for AL-1500IAL-1500E, 20 mA
2. This V-Master Logic Module must be the main V-Master Log- IFunction ISetting
ic Module for the system. For use with the AL-1500 V-Master
Character spacing 10 cpi
Logic ModuleN-Exapnder Module, the LX-300 printer must
be configured as shown in Table 7:. Shape of zero 0
3. In the AL-1500E application, typically, printer outputs are lo- 1 inch skip-over-perforation OFF
cated on the 5200-478 module, and designated as 20-mA
Character table PC 437
Serial Loops #2, #4, and #6. See Table 6:.
Auto line feed OFF
Table 6: AL-1500E Circuits 1-6 Configurable as Printer Ports.
Page length 11 inches
Terminals, Jumpers, and LEOs
Auto tear off OFF
AL-15DOE Terminal Connect to Serial In-
terface Module PIN 976262: Tractor Single
Serial AL-15DDE
Output TB1-4 TB1-1 Jumper AL-15DOE Interface Auto selection (10 sec.)
Circuit (SIG. COM.) (CTS) Installed LED
Serial IIF bit rate Configuration dependent upon AL-1500
1 A1 A3 JP1 TXD1 firmware programming
5 C1 C3 JP5 TXD5
6 C6 C8 JP6 TXD6
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 199
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience
installing and testing fire detection systems. These instructions do not
purport to cover all the details or variations in the equipment described.
Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection
with instaliation, operatioil, or maintenance. All specifications are
subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems
arise which are not covered sufficiently for the user's purposes, the
matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company,
Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 200
Specifications
Environment: Indoor Application Only
Operating Temperature: 32F to 120F
Operating Humidity: 85% (non-condensing)
Serial Interface Module Base/Cover Material: AB.S.94HB
PCB 900982 Assembly No. 976262 Dimensions (Iwd): 2.25 x 4.4 x 1 inch
Publication Number 19700419 Table 8: Electrical Specifications
Issue 2, January 1997 Battery Requirements:
The Serial Interface Module PIN 976262 provides an isolated Current Draw from TFX-500/S00M TFX-800/800M
interface between AUTOCALL TFX, AL-1500 and AL-1500E TFX-SOOMV/800MV 24 Voe
control panel RS232 or 20 mA circuits and peripheral devices such Standby Current SmA
as printers and video terminals. Alarm Current SmA
Features: Currenl Draw from AL-1S00/AL-1S00E 24 Voe
Provides electrical ground isolation between control Printer Port J4 Standby Current 4mA
equipment and UL listed printer, video terminal, or any other
Printer Port J4 Alarm Current 4mA
UL listed peripheral devices. Isolation allows for proper
ground fault monitoring of the RS-232 cable. V-Expansion Module 20 mA Output 20mA
Converts 20 mA signals to RS232 levels to drive UL listed Table 9: Indicator LED DS1
terminal devices.
Function
Eliminates the need for a separate printer interface module,
required by the TFX for isolation.
Operation: Printer (or other peripheral device) is in fault (not ready or con-
nections not properly made).
For AUTOCALL TFX applications the Serial Interface Module
connects directly to any TFX MPIM-OiBL serial port PL3 (or other I Data is being transferred.
MPIM with personality that accommodates serial communica-
tions), providing electrical isolation from the peripheral device. Installation:
(Refer to Publication 19700235, MPIM Installation Guide.) 1. Disconnect power before servicing the system.
2. Connect control panel circuit to the Serial Interface Module.
For AL-1500/AL-1500E applications the Serial Interface Module Use the 25-pin connector S1 for RS232 serial communication;
connects to either J4 (DB9) printer port on the V-Master Logic use terminal block TB1 for 20 mA communication
Module or to one of the six 20 mA outputs of the V-Expander 3. Connect the printer or other peripheral device to Serial
Module. The Serial Interface Module provides electrical isolation Interface Module P1 output jack using cable PIN 19600221.
from the printer when connected to the printer port, and converts
the 20 mA signal to RS232 levels when connected to the
V-Expander Module.
(a)
SERIAL INPUT OB25-S0CKET CON- CLiPPABLE RESISTOR LED SERIAL OUTPUT
NECTOR FOR CONNECTION TO RS232 FACTORY INSTALLED FOR SEE TABLE 2 CONNECTOR FOR
NORMAL OPERATION
0
OUTPUT FROM CONTROL EQUIPMENT CABLE 19600221
SEE TABLE 3 FOR OUTPUT (TO
TERMINAL DEVICE) WO oW
o
......
~.
20 mAINPUT
REMOVABLE LI_El----!
",m"""" '''~"ffi d
14 1 TERMINAL
.. BLOCK
... R1 TO CONTROL
EQUIPMENT
25 .:
o
13
F:ij
END VIEW INSIDE, TOP VIEW END VIEW
SIDE VIEW-OPEN, CLOSED
g- m-- __ 14
Figure 6: Serial Interface Module PIN 976262 (a) Module, (b) Cable.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 201
Table 10: Connector P1 Output Control 6. For TFXSOO/800 applications refer to Publication 8S0462,
TFX-SOO/800 Operator's Manual and Installation Guide; for
Pi Output Control (to Periph TFX-SOOM/SOOM applications refer to Publication 8S0S1S,
eral Device) Direction Function TFX-SOOM/SOOM Operator's Manual and Installation Guide.
P1-1, Signal Ground (SG) -- Signal return path 7. For AL1S00/AL1S00E applications, refer to Publication
,
0022-136, Autocall 3800 System Installation and Operating
P1-2, Request to Send (RTS) OUT Tied to CTS via O-ohm clippable
resistor R1 Instructions, AL1S00 and AL-1S00E; Publication MP-3S,
V-Master Logic Module Installation Guide; Publication MP-S4,
P1-3, Receive Data (RXD) IN Negative voltage source V-Expander Module Installation Guide.
P1-4, Clear to Send (CTS) IN Positive voltage source S. For proprietary systems use model LX-300 Printer PIN 976264
or any UL S64 listed printer rated for fire protective signaling
P1-5,DSR IN Positive when the terminal
equipment is ready; Negative service. For local type systems any UL 19S0 listed printer is
when not ready. acceptable.
P1-6, Transmit Data (TXD) OUT Data output to terminal device
(a) ANY UL 1950 LISTED
TERMINAL
Table 11: Terminals TB1 20 mA Input Control NOTE 6 NOTE 5
NOTE?
CABLE
TB1,20 rnA Input Control Direction Function 19600221
TFX-500/500M
TB1-1, Clear to Send (CTS) IN Positive voltage source TFX-800/800M
TFX-SOOMV/800MV
TB 1-2, Request to Send (DTR! OUT Terminal equipment status. Posi- Control Panel
RTS) tive when ready. MPIM
AL-1S00
TB1-3, Receive Data (RXD) IN Data input Control Panel
PRINTER
LX-300 PIN 976264
V-Master
TB1-4, Signal Ground (SG) -- Data return path. Logic Module
OR OTHER
NOTE 4, NOTE 8
Connector Pin Configuration
The 25-pin serial input connector information is given so that Figure 7: Typical Configuration RS-232 input from
if an adaptor is needed, correct pin function can be accom- TFX MPIM or AL-1500 V-Master Logic Module.
modated.
SERIAL INPUT 25-POSITION
130000000000000 1 ]
25 000000000000 14
(b)
NOTE 7 CABLE
19600221
TERMINAL
NOTES 0
ANY UL 1950 LISTED
AL-1S00
Control Panel
.
Table 12: DB25-Pin Connector S1, Pin Configuration V-Expander
Module
6 Data Set Ready (DSR) OUT Tied to RTS Figure 8: Typical Configuration 20 rnA input from
7 Signal Ground (SG) -- Data Return Path AL-1500/AL-1500E V-Expander Module.
8-19 -- -- Not Used
I \1
r_, I~ LINE EQUIP
,......a..._.L..-_-+-_ _--'-_......,P/N 19300374 (INCLUDEDt
fQl"
lQJ " 1.55 in.
@
5::!::::::;:;::;:;:;::=;:::::j'..;: : :".,;: : :,.=:d;:~I~\"I + 0.125 in.
!
CABINET SLJRFACE
(INSIDE CABINET)
.. ..
SX-TB030-2A
SECONDARY PROTECTOR
LINE EQUIP
GND
TO EQUIPMENT
TO PRIMARY CIRCUIT
PROTECTOR (INSIDE CABINET)
AT BUILDING
ENTRANCE
CABINET GROUND
TO EARTH GROUND
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 204
Specifications:
Environment: Indoor installation only
The unit should not be subjected to ambient air temperatures below
32 degrees F or above 122 degrees F. Humidity should not exceed
Auxiliary Housing 85% (noncondensing).
Assembly No. 976010 Dimensions (Iwd): 14.00 x 12.50 x 4.75 inches
Conduit knockouts for 0.50 inch fittings
Publication Number 19700219 #6-32 x 0.38 Ig PEM nut fittings
Issue 4, January 1997
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ ,.. .
0
~oo
I() 0.. 00
.., 00
~
00
00
~ ~~~~~~~~~~~ 6'lriJ-.
&1m-
I ,..
~~~~~~~~~~~ ,..
"til 0
I
,.. 0
I
RED
I i
II
I
I 0 0
NON-POWER LIMITED
BATTERY BUS CABLE
Wiring:
1. All conductors to be free of grounds.
2. Disconnect power before servicing systems.
3. See Module installation guides for unit wiring. See Publication
Number 19700262, "AUTO CALL TFX-500/800 Battery Cal-
culation Worksheets," or TFX-500M/800M, Publication No.
19700368, to select correct capacity standby batteries for
system requirements.
14.00
.50 STD CONDUIT\
KNOCKOUT TYPICAL
o o
~4.75-J
1- ,1______ -------11,1
12.50
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 206
4050 Series Fire Alarm Table 1. Specifications 4050 Series Fire Alarm Stations
Model/Part
No. Description Action Application Back Box
4050-211T Single-Action 4050-211T Conventional Alarm 1 Conventional Alarm 9090-006-001
4050-211TB Single-Action Station:
Terminals, N.O. Con-
Station. 4050BB
Type 4050 non-coded fire alarm stations use normally-open (N.O.) con- 4053-001-101 Terminals, N.O. Con- 1 Single Transponder to 9090-006-001
tacts; operate and reset easily; and may be mounted semi-flush or surface. tacts. Addressable AUTO CALL XA[rXA
AutoCommand. Au- Module 5200-422
Optional break-away shield (PIN 8462-657) is available. toMonitor
(b) Slide the tab of the new shield between the handle plate and the
4053-001-101 1 rnA 1 mA
station front.
(c) When the station is closed, the hole in the shield will engage the 4052-505-102 1 mA 1 mA
retaining pin, holding the shield in place. 4059-001-101 Negligible Negligible
Model 4052-505-1 01 Patrol Station-Inserting the patrol key into the patrol
keyswitch immediately causes a patrol condition to be reported to the con-
trol unit. Installation Notes
General Wiring Notes 1. Installation must be in compliance with local codes having jurisdiction.
2. Stations should be mounted not less than 4.5 feet or more than 6 feet
1. Disconnect power before servicing system.
from floor levels. Usually the 4.5 feet height is preferred. Location
2. All conductors must be free of grounds. should be in normal exit paths and distributed no more than 200 feet
3. All wiring isto be in accordance with N.E.C. (National Electrical Code), from any point in the building. Stations should be unobstructed and
local authorities, and applicable notes. readily accessible.
4. When installed to comply with N.E.C. Article 760, Part A and Part C, 3. Address setting for addressable alarm stations.
these circuits are classified as power limited. When installed to comply (a) For digital DIP switches, use a small screw driver or plastic tool
with N.E.C. Article 760, Part A and Part S, these circuits are classified to set address switches (do not use a pencil, graphite particles
as non-power limited. Maintain at least 0.25 inch clearance from all may damage the switch). Address is equal to the sum of the
power limited wiring with cable ties or other permanent means. switch values placed intheON position. Forexample, for address
5. These drawings are typical only.
~
=
1\ F~REI A FIRE
,
~ 00 0
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 207
WALL LINE FOR
iEMI-FLUSH MOUNTING SEMI-FLUSH
MOUNTING
---.--t--,~~
() T
i@
II [F ~ [f2 ~ ~ [F~[f2~1
@ @
(' 1
BAC
111[lt"MU,
!
II ffi\lffi\[f2~ \ ~ ~~~[f200l \
STANDARD SINGLE GANG
BACKBOX (BY OTHERS) PLASTER 4" SQUARE
4050-211T 4050-211T, 4050-211T77 (with
1
RING (BY BACKBOX
4050-211T777 WALL LINE FOR IXA-501 CM). 4053-001-101.
SEMI-FLUSH 4059-001-101 OTHERS) (BY OTHERS)
MOUNTING
TIT
SURFACE MOUNTING I 9091-043 BACKBOX PROVIDED MEASURES IJ'''LL I INE-----I
1-1/8 INCHES HIGH BY 2-7/8 INCHES DEEP \ I
r'f' til_rf)ff_
'M LI
WALLLlNE-I WALL LlNE------1
'II -.J"
SHALLOW BACK-
BOX PIN 4050B8 Ii
@
_" I
SURFACE
STYLE DEEP
I
I II 151
s-
~~~~:~~Epi
DEPTH-
5..J DEPTH- - 16 BACKBOX
[l t"lWl,l, @~OO [l 58 [lII1IU @~oo[l 8 BACKBOX PART NO.
PART NO. 9091-043
9090-006 (SUPPLIED)
~~~~001 \ ~~~~/f;'I\
1
29, turn on switches 5, 4, 3,1 (Value 16 + 8 + 4 + 1). Switch values 6. For NFPA Style 4 ("T-Tap") wiring and semi-flush mounting, use astan-
in ON position' dard single gang outlet box, 21/4-inch minimum depth, setflushtothe
Sw. Pos. Value Sw. Pos. Value plaster line.
7. For surface mounting, use Autocall PIN 9090-006 steel back box (3
1 1 5 16
inches deep).
2 2 6 32
3 4 7 64 WIRING NOTES-ModeI4050-211T (Figure 3)
4 8 8* 128 1. Connect terminals to initiating circuit.
2. Install end-of-line device as required for supervision.
(b) Model 4053-001 ,addressable alarm station application with Au-
tocall3800 control panel, 5200-422 Module. Address switch S1
is located under the insulator ofthe electronic component assem- WIRING NOTE5-ModeI4050-211TB (with optional
bly. Switch values in ON position: IXA-501 CM Contact Monitoring Module-Figure 4)
(c) For rotary add ress switches (model 4059) , use a small screwd riv- 1. Set address on IXA-501 CM Mini Contact Monitoring Module (PIN
er to rotate the indicator and position the indicator dot to the 976081) according system site plan. Refer to Publication 19700293.
correct position on each switch: for example, E4:
2. Break wire run to provide supervision. Install UL listed end-of-line de-
vice as required by the control system for supervision.
SWITCH 2
(a) Install the EOL resistor (619-ohm, 0.25 watt, UL listed, PIN
"4" SWITCH 1 976082) into the circuit of the monitored contact device. Refer to
"E" Publication 19700293.
(b) IXA-501 eM connections to TFX signalling line circuit (address-
able loop): Terminal 1 (+) to addressable loop (+); Terminal 2 H
(d) TFX-500/800 application set address on IXA-501 CM Module.
to addressable loop (-). Refer to Publication 19700293 for circuit
Switch is 7-position (position 8* not available) values in ON posi- parameters.
tion. Refer to Publication Number 19700293.
4. Install alarm station wiring.
5. For NFPA Style 6 wiring and semi-flush mounting use a standard
4-inch by 4-inch by 2 1/B-inch outlet box fitted with a 3/4-inch deep
single gang plaster ring set flush to the plaster line.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 208
o o
66~~~~tOO
n
( ) BACK VIEW + - - - - - _ . ___ + TO NEXT
DEVICE
UNIT
4050-211T
o o
TERMINAL
BLOCK
a a
TERMINAL 4050-211TB
BLOCK Ul LISTED EOl
AS NEEDED
FOR SUPERVISION
BLACK RED
4050-211T 4050-2111 LF
WIt
AS NEEDED
OR SUPERVISION
YELLOW PURPLE
Ul LISTED
6190HM.1/4W.1~
RESISTOR
~1 ~1
-l~ ADDRESS
SWITCHES
CONTROL
UNIT
/ , I ,
/
I PIN 976081
l
I
\ I
Figure 4. 4050-211TB with optional
IXA-50 1CM Mini Contact Monitoring Module for
Figure 3. 4050-211T Wiring. application to TFX-500/BOO addressable loop.
WiRiNG NOTE5-4059-001-101 AutoPlex Control Panel job information. This address must be set on switch i located under
Application-Figure 5 the insulator of the electronic component assembly. The address is
1. Maximum line resistance 20 ohms, per wire. Capacitance 0.25 mF equal to the sum of the switch values placed in the ON condition.
(wire to wire and wire to shield).
2. Circuit limitations: 24 VDC; normal supervision current is 250 mA; WIRING NOTES-4052-505-101 XA Interface with Patrol
maximum alarm current is 250 mA; frequency is 250 Hz, ripple voltage Station-Figure 7
100%. 1. Maximum line resistance 100 ohms, per wire. Capacitance 1.5 mF
3. Shields must be tied to DC Common only as shown on field wiring (wire to wire and wire to shield).
drawing (one end at control unit only). Must be free of grounds. 2. Circuit limitations: 24 VDC; normal supervision current is 250 mA;
4. Loops terminate at an AutoPlex Module (5200-442). Refer to Publica- maximum alarm current is 250 mA; frequency is 250 Hz, ripple voltage
tion No. MP-25. AutoPlex loop terminals are connected to terminals: 100%.
In (+) 1, (SIG)2, (-)3; Out (+) 10, (SIG) 11, (-) 12. Loops may becon- 3. Shields must be tied to DC Common only as shown on field wiring
nected in Style 4 or Style 6. Shield connects at one point only. drawing (one end at control unit only). Must be free of grounds.
5. Each station requires a unique and predetermined address for the 4. Install ULiisted 1 k-ohm end-of-line resistor PIN 4280-068 in ULiisted,
location at which it will be used, as contained in, and defined by, the normally-open contact initiating device (patrol box). When ELR is re-
job information. This address must be set by rotating the indicator of mote, R15 must be removed from PC board assembly located next to
switch 1 to match the first (most significant) digit of the assigned ad- terminals 4 and 5.
dress and then rotating the indicator of switch 2 to match the second 5. Patrol box connects to Terminals 4 and 5.
(least significant) digit. A maximum of 250 uniquely addressed devices
6. XA loop terminals are intemally connected: 1-10,2-9,3-8,4-7, and
of all types including fire stations may connect to a single AutoPlex
5-6. Loops may be connected in Style 4 or Style 6. XA loops terminate
loop.
at an XA/TXA Input Module (5200-422). Refer to Publication No.
MP-24.
WIRING NOTES-4053-001-101 XA Interface to Control 7. Each station reqUires a unique and predetermined address for the
Panel Application-Figure 6 location at which it will be used, as contained in, and defined by, the
1. Maximum line resistance 100 ohms, per wire. Capacitance 1.5 mF job information. This address must be set on switches 1 and 2 located
(wire to wire and wire to shield). on the electronic component assembly. Switch 1 sets address for cir-
2. Circuit limitations: 24 VDC; normal supervision current is 250 mA; cuit 1, leadsto patrol keyswitch. Switch 2 addresses circuit2, terminals
maximum alarm current is 250 mA; frequency is 250 Hz, ripple voltage 4 and 5, to patrol box. The address is equal to the sum of the switch
100%. values placed in the ON condition. Refer to Installation Note 6.
3. Shields must be tied to DC Common only as shown on field wiring 8. Switch S3 needs to be set to program the circuits that are used:
drawing (one end at control unit only). Must be free of grounds.
Switch Position ON= OFF =
4. XA loop terminals are internally connected: 1-10,2-9,3-8, 4-7, and
5-6. Loops may be connected in Style 4 or Style 6. XA loops terminate 1 Circuit 1 Used Circuit 1 Not Used
at an XA(TXA Input Module (5200-422). Refer to Publication No.
2 Circuit 2 Used Circuit 2 Not Used
MP-24. I I I
5. Each station requires a unique and predetermined address for the 3 (Not Connected) -- --
location at which it will be used, as contained in, and defined by, the 4 (Not Connected) -- --
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 209
.- -
A
1'1
ROTARY SWITCHES
SEE INSTALLATION
.- - -- -. I
-
NOTE 6C, WIRING
I
I II I
I
I I I
~
NOTE 5 I I
+
~
I + I
TERMINAL '+
I I
I I
BLOCK AUTOPLEX I I
CONTROL PAN
I
I
if ::!i
I
I
I if ::!i I
EL
.- -
I
- - -.
I
. - - - - - ..
I I
+ 1 f\
IN SIG 2
- 3
SHIELD SH
DCC
J SUPERVISED
NONPOWER LIMITED
BACK VIEW 5200-442 SEE NOTES 1, 2, 3, 4
AUTOPlEX
4059-001-101 MODULE
-
1
OUT SIG 11
+ 10
BACK VIEW
4053-001-101
TERMINAL
I 380.0. CONTROL I
I
I
.- -
I
~ --i I - - - "11
!
PANEL I
...
- - - ..
5200-422 CLK D
MDDUlE REF
SIG
BPOSITION DIP
SWITCHES UNDER INSU
SHIELD
DCC
SH ~ SUPERVISED
LATOR ON ELECTRONIC NDNPDWER LIMITED
ASSEMBLY SEE NOTES 1, 2, 3, 4
SEE INSTALLATION NOTE 1'\
SIG
6, WIRING NOTE 5
REF
ClK
/1
PATRDL KEYSWITCH SEE DETAIL "A", INSTAL-
4280-068 4280-068
SEE DETAIL "A" LATIDN NDTE 6, WIRING
1K END LINE
*1
1K END LINE
NDT SUPERVISED N~DTES 7, 8
WIRES NOT TO RUN TERMINALS 4 '------"
RESISTOR
NOTES 4,5
1+1 f
'------"
RESISTOR
NOTES 4, 5
DUTSIDE DEVICE AND 5 CIRCUIT 2
TO BDX SEE DE-
N.O.
1 ~ S2~!!Ml S3 l.-D TAil "A"
S~S3REF
o-D IDE~AI:'A'~
I
REF
TRANSPDNDER ClK N TRANSPONDER ClK N I S1 AND S2
0 SIG
4052-505-101 BOX ~
co
...
0
4052-505-101
SIG
BOX ~
co
... Ig~Fgg~ 12 345678
~~~ BOX ~ '"
BOX
S1~ S1~ ;;)0 I S3
~
I ON
CONTROL PANEL TWIST AND TAPE
SHIELD WIRES TOGETHER
TWIST AND TAPE
SHIELD WIRES TOGETHER
I OFF
I I n n r:v1~CHES
1 234
REF S1 A NO S2 ARE
ClK I ! I 8POSITIDN DIP SWITCHES
w SIG
I
I USED FOR ADD RESS SET
-'
::> TING. SWITCH S31S
C
SUPERVISED 14.POSITION DIP SWITCH
0
::;;
SHIELD I NON-PDWER LIMITED USED TO. PROG RAM WHICH
DCC NOTES 1, 2, 3,4 CIRCUITS ARE USED.
I SWITCH S1 SET S ADDRESS
SIG FDR N.D. CO NTACTS (CIR
CLK IJ I CUIT#1), SWITC H S2 SETS
REF I ADDRESS FDR TERMINALS
U ;~_ U ~AND 5 (CIRCUI T #2, BOX).
Figure 7. 4052-5 5-101, XA Interface with Patrol Station; Typical wir-
mg to XA loop at 5200-422 Module.
SEE NDTES 12
~D~3:.. ..J
AUTOCALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 210
101
23 JAN 97 22:17:02 101
101
101
101
101
101
101
/
[ill
A. FIRE ALARM LED--red H. SCROLL UP touch-button O. KEYSWITCH
B. TROUBLE LED--yellow I SCROLL DOWN touch-button P. PANEL SILENCE touch-button
C. SUPERVISORY LED--yellow J. YES/ENTER touch-button Q. ALARM SILENCE touch-button
D. ZONE ALARM LED--red K. POWER LED--green R SYSTEM RESET touch-button
E. ZONE TROUBLE LED--ye!!ow L. QUIT touch-button s. DR!LL touch-button
F. ALPHANUMERIC DISPLAY M. FAST ACCESS touch-button T LAMP TEST touch-button
G. NO/DELETE touch-button N. NUMERIC touch-pad
AUTOCAll TFX-500M Operating instructions
Attention! Look at lights and displays!
What You See What It Means
[A] Red Ught ON. FIRE ALARM! An initiating device (smoke detector or other device) has detected a FIRE ALARM condition. See D or F.
[!] Yellow Ught ON. TROUBLE. There is a trouble condition at one or more of the system devices, or with some other part of the system. See E or
F.
Yellow Ught ON. SUPERVISORY. A sprinkler system supervisory device has been activated. See F.
@]
Zone Red Ught ON FIRE ALARM in the ZONE indicated by the Zone Number next to the light. See F. If light Q is on, alarms have been silenced.
[[]
[]] Zone Yellow Ught ON. TROUBLE in the Zone indicated by the Zone Number next to the light. See F.
[] Display MESSAGE. Shows information about the zone and device in alarm.
Une 1-Alarm or System Message. Shows type of Alarm or Trouble.
Shows date and time under Normal conditions.
Shows "REMOTE LOCKOUT' if another system control panel or
Remote OpslDis panel is being accessed. Only one
operator may be logged on to operate the system at one time.
Une 2--Zone Message.
Une 3-Point Message.
Une 4-Zone number, point ID, outstanding events.
ACCEPT EVENTS: Enter your PASSCODE or 0911 at Touch-pad N, follow menu shown on Display F.
PANEL SILENCE: Insert Key in Keyswitch 0, turn to ENABLE, press PANEL SILENCE P; the panel buzzer turns OFF.
ALARM SILENCE: Insert Key in Keyswitch 0, turn to ENABLE, press ALARM SILENCE Q.
RESET: Insert Key in Keyswitch 0, turn to ENABLE, press ALARM SILENCE Q, press RESET R.
WARN!NG---Do not RESET the pane! until events are ACCEPTED and alarms are S!LENCED.
WARNING! Never leave a panel in TROUBLE or SUPERVISORY condition. The system may be unable to detect or annunciate a fire alarm and lives may be
lost.
Refer to the Autocall TFX-500M/BOOM Operator's Manual, PIN 850516, for information on alarm, trouble, and supervisory conditions; alarm SILENCE, system
RESET, lamp TEST, and fire DRILL operation.
Test the Autocall TFX-500M fire control system periodically as necessary to comply with NFPA, state, and local codes and ordinances of authorities having
jurisdiction.
In case of trouble with this equipment, please contact:
Remove or copy this sheet, frame, and place within Name: Company:
sight of all Autocall TFX-SOOM fire control panels, dis- Address: Telephone:
play panels, and Remote Ops/Dis panels. Publication Number 19700371 ,Issue 2, January 1997
Page 211
Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company
835 Sharon Dirve
Westlake, Ohio 44145
A -tileD INTERNATIONAL LTD. COMPANY
TFX-800M
Fire Control Panel
A. FIRE ALARM LED-Red
B. TROUBLE LED-Yellow
C. SUPERVISORY LED-Yellow
D. ZONE ALARM LED-Red
E. ZONE TROUBLE LED-Yellow
F. ALPHANUMERIC DISPLAY
G. NO/DELETE touch-button
H. SCROLL UP touch-button
I. SCROLL DOWN touch-button
J. YES/ENTER touch-button
K. POWER LED-Green
L. QUIT touch-button
M. FAST ACCESS touch-button
N. NUMERIC touch-pad
O. KEYSWITCH
P. PANEL SILENCE touch-button
Q. ALARM SILENCE touch-but-
ton,
Yellow LED
R. SYSTEM RESET touch-button
S. DRILL touch-button
T. LAMP TEST touch-button
(!] Yellow Ught ON. TROUBLE. There is a trouble condition at one or more of the system devices, or with some other part of the system. See E or
F.
Yellow Ught ON. SUPERVISORY. A sprinkler system supervisory device has been activated. See F.
@]
Zone Red Ught ON FIRE ALARM in the ZONE indicated by the Zone Number next to the light. See F. If light Q is on, alarms have been silenced.
[[]
f]] Zone Yellow Ught ON. TROUBLE in the Zone indicated by the Zone Number next to the light. See F.
[] Display MESSAGE. Shows information about the zone and device in alarm.
o Une 1-Alarm or System Message. Shows type of Alarm or Trouble.
Shows date and time under Normal conditions.
Shows "REMOTE LOCKOUT" if another system control panel or
Remote OpslDis panel is being accessed. Only one
operator may be logged on to operate the system at one time.
o Une 2--Zone Message.
o Une &-Point Message.
o Une 4--Zone number, point ID, outstanding events.
ACCEPT EVENTS: Enter your PASSCODE or 0911 at Touch-pad N, follow menu shown on Display F.
PANEL SILENCE: Insert Key in Keyswitch 0, turn to ENABLE, press PANEL SILENCE P; the panel buzzer turns OFF.
ALARM SILENCE: Insert Key in Keyswitch 0, turn to ENABLE, press ALARM SILENCE Q.
RESET: Insert Key in Keyswitch 0, turn to ENABLE, press ALARM SILENCE Q, press RESET R.
WARNING--Do not RESET the panel until events are ACCEPTED and alarms are SILENCED.
WARNING! Never leave a panel in TROUBLE or SUPERVISORY condition. The system may be unable to detect or annunciate a fire alarm and lives may be
lost.
Refer to the Autocall TFX-500M/BOOM Operator's Manual, PIN 850516, for information on alarm, trouble, and supervisory conditions; alarm SILENCE, system
RESET, lamp TEST, and fire DRILL operation.
Test the Autocall TFX-500M fire control system periodically as necessary to comply with NFPA, state, and local codes and ordinances of authorities having
jurisdiction.
Page 213
Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company
835 Sharon Dirve
Westlake, Ohio 44145
A 1:"eD INTERNATIONAL LTD. COMPANY
TFX-SOOMjBOOM Battery Calculation
Worksheets
AUTOCALL Publication Number 19700368
Issue 3, January 1997
Be sure to include the 100 mA current draw of the RPS-424 in alarm and standby current draw calcula-
tions.
To comply with Factory Mutual requirements, the maximum current load on 85-Ah batteries for a 60-hour
back-up application must not exceed 1.16 amperes.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
PageA-1
Battery Calculation Worksheets
The following current draw values have been adjusted for TFX-500/BOO power supply charging efficiency and other system variables.
They are all expressed as equivalent current draw from the 24 VDC supply. .
Suggestion: Duplicate this sheet and use one sheet for each 2-way data circuit. 2-Way Data Circuit Loop _ _ __
Modules Normal Condition Alarm Condition
(Detectors include base)
Number X Load (mA) = Total Number X Load (mA) = Total
*
4.20
Base IBN-550/551/552
Base IBN-553 I 0.20
0.20
4.00
4.00
I
Base IBN-554
I I I 0.23
I I 4.00
I
IHN-135 Analog/Addr. Heat Sensor *
Base IBN-550/551 0.30 3.90
Base IBN-552 0.30 3.90
Base IBN-553 0.30 3.90
Base IBN-554 0.33 3.90
Other
Total
..
*Maxlmum additional alarm current of 50 rnA per loop to activate a maximum of 5 device LEOs (after 5 alarms on the loop, the system does
not light any more LEOs on the loop).
Suggestion: duplicate this sheet and use one sheet for each panel enclosure. Control Panel: _ _ __
16 Indicator Module
I 9
I I 34
I I
16 Status Control Module (without MPIM) 7 26
Expansion Motherboard 22 20
Other
Total
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
PageA-3
rhe following current draw values have been adjusted for power supply charging efficiency and other system variables. They are
'111 expressed as equivalent current draw from the 24 VDC supply.
Control Panel External Loads
Load Load
Number x (rnA) = Total Number x (rnA) = Total
ARM-500 relays
Total
This document is written for skilled technicians with experience installing and testing fire
detection systems. These instructions do not purport to cover all the details or variations in the
equipment described. Nor do they provide for every possible contingency met in connection with
installation, operation, or maintenance. All specifications are subject to change without notice.
Should further information be desired or should particular problems arise which are not covered
sufficiently for the user's purposes, the matter should be referred to Grinnell Fire Protection
Systems Company, Inc., Westlake, Ohio 44145. Ph. (216) 871-9900.
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
PageA-4
TFX-SOOM and TFX-800M Spare Parts
and Compatible Devices
Publication Number 19700373
AUTOCALL Issue 3, January 1997
Detector Compatibility
The following list shows which detectors are compatible with the Autocall TFX-500M and TFX-800M Fire Control Panels, the standby
current for each detector model, the detector base, and identifier, and the maximum detectors per 2-way data circuit loop for each
detector. The following detectors may be connected directly to the TFX 2-way data circuits.
Mfr. Detector Modell Standby Currenl Base Modell Part Number Maximum Detectors
Part Number per Loop
Thorn ISN-5501/920095 0.20 rnA IBN-551 920100, IBN-552 920192, (IBN-550 920099) 99
0.20 rnA IBN-553 920194, 1 1
0.23 rnA IBN-554920195
The UL listed conventional detectors listed in Publication 19700411 ,Smoke Detector Compatibility Chart, may be used
when they are attached to an IXA-500DM or IXA-500DMA Conventional Detector Module. Note: only the IXA-500DM
will be the "addressable point" on the system. TFX-500/800 Zone ID is 500A.
TFX-500M/BOOM End-of-Line Devices
Part Number Description Application(s)
976042 22 k-ohm OXA-500SD, OXA-50SDA, OXA-501SDA, OXA-504SDA Signal Driver Module, OXA-500SB Signal Expander Module
976045 1 k-ohm IXA-500CM, IXA-500CMA Contacl Monitoring Module, IXM-500 Motherboard with IXA-500CMA
976250 27 k-ohm, 1 Watt OXA-502SDA, OXA-503SDA DC/Audio Signal Driver DC or audio applications, Style Y, last device EOl
4281-050 5.1 k-ohm, 2 Watt OXM-501SDA (with OXA-502SDA) DC/Audio Signal Driver audio riser Style Y last device EOl; CSM-500 (with
OXA-502SDA) Channel Select Module audio circuit Style Y last device EOl
19240410 relay OXA-503SDA DC/Audio Signal Driver, install in DC return circuit for supervision of DC power limited/Class 2 operation
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
PageA-5
TFX-SOOM/BOOM Cable Applications
Cable Description
19600206 1 end Molex, 1 end bare 5 wires 16 inches RPS-424 Power Supply TBI to Main Processor Board PL5
13100076 2ends, 14 pin flex 12 inches Up-Down Local Bus--NOT for use between FCM and Main Processor
13100077 2 ends, 16pin flex 6 inches Up-Down Expansion Bus--Front Panel MPIM to Zone Indicator board
13100078 2ends, 14-pin flex 24 inches Up-Down Local Bus--Main Processor to MPIM in position B3 Not for
use between FCM and Main Processor
13100080 2 ends, 16pin flex 4 inches Up-Up Expansion Bus--MPIM to ARM-500 or XIOM
13100087 2 ends, 14 pin flex 12 inch Up-Up Local Bus-For Use Between FCM and Main Processor
13100092 2 ends, 14pin flex 13 inch Up-Up Local Bus-For Use Between FCM and Main Processor
13100093 2 ends, 16 pin flex 12 inch Up-Up MPIM to Ribbon Cable Converter Board
13100094 2 ends, 14 pin flex 18 inch Up-Down Main Processor to RM/SDA Motherboard
13100095 2 ends, 16 pin flex 4 inch Up-Down Expansion Bus MPIM to first XIOM or ARM
13100100 2 ends, 14 pin flex 24 inch Up-Up Local Bus-For use between FCM and DC Converter or
PSM
19600193 1 end Mol ex, 1 end bare 4 wire Remote Bus--OCPM terminal block to MPIM
940547 2 ends special SpeCial 6 inches Special Serial Cable, MPIM to Printer Interface Board
940577 1 end special, 1 end DB9 (pin) Special 15 feet Programming Cable (Special)
940578 1 end special, OB25 (pin) Special 25 feet Printer Cable (Special)
940579 1 end special, OB25 (socket) Special 25 feet Printer Cable (Special)
19600188 1 end Fast-on (fem.), 1 end bare Battery Harness RPS-424 to batteries
19600067 2 ends #6 Ring Term inal 1 wire 3 inches Main Processor to Earth Ground
TFX-SOOM/BOOM Fuses
Assembly Number Part Number Description Application(s)
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
PageA-6
TFX-500M and TFX-800M Spare Parts 920144 RS232 to MMF Serial Cable Converter
920192 IBN-552 6-inch Addressable Detector Base, Low Prolile
920194 IBN-553 6-inch Addressable Detector Base, w/ Relay
18000259 EOL 10 k-Ohm resistor 920195 IBN-554 6-inch Addressable Detector Base, w/ Sounder
18400351 Fuse--3.15 amp (See 976019) 940517 ISA-4121 Addressable Ion Detector
18400352 Fuse--6.3 amp (See 976019) 940518 ISA-412P Addressable Photo Detector
940519 ISN-5121 Analog/Addressable Ion Sensor
18900235 TFX-500 Main processor EPROM V. 1.0 940520 ISN-512P Analog/Addressable Photo Sensor
18900236 TFX-500 Main processor EEPROM V. 1.0 940522 IBN-512A Analog/Addressable Detector Base
18900237 TFX-800 Main processor EPROM V. 2.1 940530 TS-300 Detector Test Set
18900238 TFX-800 Main processor EEPROM V. 2.0 940547 Serial Printer Cable
18900239 TFX-800 ALXM EPROM V. 2.1 940577 Programming Cable
18900240 TFX-800 ALXM EEPROM V. 2.0 940578 Cable RS232 Serial Printer Cable
18900249 TFX-500 Main processor EPROM V. 2.1
18900250 TFX-500 Main processor EEPROM V. 2.0 975163 "2LR Ex1ernal Battery Cabinet (See KDR1 000
18900259 TFX-500 Main processor EPROM V. 3.1 Owner's Manual, PIN 850175, Rev. B, March 1989)"
18900260 TFX-500 Main processor EEPROM V. 3.0
18900261 TFX-800 Main processor EPROM V. 3.1 976010 TFX Auxiliary Housing Assembly
18900262 TFX-800 Main processor EEPROM V. 3.0 976011 SFE-500 TFX-500 CONSYS Software Package
18900263 TFX-800 ALXM EPROM V. 3.1 (Available only to THORN Automated Systems
18900264 TFX-800 ALXM EEPROM V. 3.0 trained and authorized personnel)
976013 "Auxilary Relay Option - 8 Ass'y (976014, 976015)"
19240248 12V 25AH Battery 976014 ARM500 Auxiliary Relay Module Assembly
19240269 12V 10AH Battery 976015 MPIM Subassembly
19240410 End-ol-line Relay 976016 IAS-500 End-ol-Line Device Assembly
19240890 MF312 Conventional Ion Chamber Detector 976018 "Printer Option Assembly (940545, 940548, 13100076)"
19240891 MR312 Conventional Pilotoelectronic Detector 976019 Spare Fuse Kit Assembly
19240892 M310 Conventional Detector Base 976022 IXA-500DM Detector Monitor Module
19240940 Card guides lor Expansion Motherboard 976023 OXA-500SD Signal Driver Module
976024 OXA-500SB Signal Expander Module
19400831 Auxi!iary Housing Subplate 976025 OXA-500RM Addressable Relay Module
976026 CAA-500Ll Line Isolator Module
19600150 Cable, TLA-530 to TLB-530 976027 IXA-500CM Contact Monitor Module
19600188 Battery Harness Assembly 976030 CVB-500 Reverse Polarity Transmitter Option
19600206 Cable MP to RPS-424 976031 CEB-500 City Box Transmitter Option
19600215 Cable TLB-530 to TLB-530 976032 Remote Ops/Dis Printer Option
19600221 Cable 6-inch for Serial Interface Module 976034 DCPM DC/DC Converter Subplate Assembly
976037 Main Processor Board-- Spare Part
4050-211T Conventional Alarm Station 976040 DCPM DC Power Module--Spare Part
4050-211TB Conventional Alarm Station with Optional IXA-501 CM 976041 PIM-550 Printer Interface Board--Spare Part
4281-050 End-ol-line Resistor, 5.1 k-ohm, 2 W 976042 EOL Assembly - 22 k-Ohm resistor
976043 EOL Assembly - 270 Ohm resistor, 6W
8099-510 Backbox, 2 Module, 4-inch deep 976044 EOL Assembly - 2.2 k-Ohm resistor
8099-511 Backbox, 3 Module, 4-inch deep 976045 EOL Assembly - 1 k-Ohm resistor
8099-512 Backbox,5 Module, 4-inch deep 976046 EOL Assembly - 2 k-Ohm resistor
8099-513 Backbox, 7 Module, 4-inch deep 976047 EOL Assembly - 4.7 k-Ohm resistor
8099-514 Backbox, 7 Module, 6-inch deep 976048 EOL Assembly - 120 Ohm resistor
8099-515 Backbox, 10 Module, 6-inch deep 976062 IIB-800 ALXM Assembly
8099-516 Backbox, 5 Module, 6-inch deep 976063 IAM-800 Motherboard--Spare part
976064 EOL Assembly - 150 Ohm resistor
850463 "TFX-500/800 CONSYS Programming Guide, 976065 AIS-800 Expansion Bus Cable Converter Board
Issue 3, 1994 (Available only to THORN 976066 OAA-16 XI OM 16 Output Module
Automated Systems trained and authorized personnel)" 976067 IAA-16 XI OM 16 Input Module
850481 "TFX-500/800 Application Guide and Maintenance Manual, 976080 SRA-550 DACT Interface Module
Issue 2, August, 1992 (Available only to THORN Automated 976081 IXA-501 CM Mini Contact Monitor Module
Systems trained and authorized personnel)" 976082 End-ol-line Resistor 619 ohm, 0 .. 25 W
976091 OXA-500SDA Signal Driver Module
850515 TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation 976092 IXA-500CMA Contact Monitoring Module
Guide. 976093 IXA-500DMA Detector Monitor Module
850516 TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual 976094 TFX to XA Control Panel Assembly
976098 XAA-16 8lnput/8 Output XI OM
900937 End-ol-line, Special, lor Common Alarm (Sounder) Ckt. 976121 TLX-500 XA Network Interface Module
976122 500PSM Power Monitor (TFX Addressable)
910683 RPS-424 Power Supply/Battery Charger 976123 PSM Power Monitor (Non-addressable)
910688 SK5128 Digital Alarm Communicator Transmitter 976124 XAI XA Interface Board
910692 SX-TB-030-2A Secondary Protector 976127 FCM Fire Control Module
976128 ODM Operator Display Module
920020 TFX-500/800 Printer (LA75) 976129 16-lndicator Module
920067 ISC-3501 Conventional Ionization Detector Head 976130 40 x 2-lndicator Module (with MPIM)
920068 ISC-350P Conventional Photoelectric Smoke Detector Head 976131 40 x 2-lndicator Module (without MPIM)
920070 IHC-115 Conventional Heat Detector Head -(115 OF) 976132 40-Status Control Module (with MPIM)
920071 IHC-135 Conventional Heat Detector Head -(135 OF) 976133 40-Status Control Module (without MPIM)
920072 IHC-160 Conventional Heat Detector Head -(160 OF) 976134 16-Status Control Module (with MPIM)
920073 IHC-210 Conventional Heat Detector Head -(210 OF) 976135 16-Status Control Module (without MPIM)
920083 IBC-351 Conventional Detector Base, 6-inch, 2-wire, 976136 80-lndicator Module (1 MPIM)
compatible with Remote LED 976137 80-lndicator Module (2 MPIMs)
920095 ISN-5501, Ion Smoke Detector Head 976138 80-lndicator Module (without MPIM)
920096 ISN-550P, Photo Smoke Detector Head 976139 Blank Module (lull)
920097 IHN-135 Heat Detector Head, 135 deg. 976165 TLI-530 ThornNet Network Interface Module
920098 IHN-200 Heat Detector Head, 200 deg. 976166 TLO-530 Fiber Optic Modem Module
920099 IBN-550 Detector Base, 4-inch (Not available in U.S.) 976167 TLD-530 ThornNet Line Driver Module
920100 IBN-551 6-inch Addressable DetectorBase 976168 TLB-530 ThornNet Baseboard
920101 IAN-ADD Addressable XPERT Card lor 550 Detector Heads 976169 TLA-530 ThornNet Adaptor Board
920102 ISN-550Dllon Duct System 976170 Auxiliary Mounting Plate
920103 SIN-550DP Photo Duct System 976184 IXM-500 CMA Motherboard
920109 IA-MED Detector Test Pole 976185 IXA-502CMA Contact Monitor Module
920111 IA-MTA Detector Test Gas Aerosol 976186 OXA-501 SDA Signal Driver Module (Plug-in)
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
PageA-B
Smoke Detector Compatibility Chart
....
c."
ff
~
y~
Ii
00 :
N:ii c ii:
:: ~ ~..,
Manufacturer <b ..,
'" .., ~ (e)
::
Detector {Identifier}
Standby
..,
.6 ~
c
~
<> ~
::::]1
Current
Ba~p II .. ~~~ ~:::.:.;~::::.:.~; in '"'" '"
II) II)
(b)~
-
Grinnell U=
(c)~
IHC-115, .35, 160, 210 {IHC}
-=~-~ (t)
~
..
",""
;;; ff
~
: ID ."
a; ""a;
~
is
00 !!: iii: c s :s~
N5
0
:
- ~ ~
ff
0
is 12:
.., ...
: c
'"~
~
>.c <
=-
"t:
co
"t:
co .. ..=
i ~~ 5 5 U U
<h ... ;;!; ...~ ~
... ... ID
N =ID c0 c0 ~"
0= = =<
0 ... 0<
~ !It!
0 0
",u 0
Manufacturer ;:- 0 0 tn.!:: ~~ !:::!~
'i' ~ ~
0 011 S;;:
Standby 'U S:::>
..,0 ..,0 IDe. c., "0 "0
'"
~ '"
0C'> C
0 ID 'l'
~ 5 :0. :0
~
N N S> S> >< ><
~
Current ~! =~ =~
Detector {Identifier} 0 0 C'> C'> C'> u., u.,1D ID N N N C .. 0 .. 0 ..
;;;;:
(rnA) in It! in in in in in in U UN N ii5 ;:c ;:c ii5 ii5 c :;1 :oS UJJ: UJJ:
N
~ ~9 ~g
Base Model (ldentHier) '"
Grinnell Fire Protection Systems CO,
IHC-115, 135, 160,210 {IHC}
18C350/351/353 (18C350,351,353) 25 35 35 30 25 35 35 35 35 30 30 30 - - - - - - - 25 25 25 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 -
--- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -- - - - - ------ - - - - - - - - - - - - - r--- ------- -
ISC-3501 {ISC-3501}
-
IBC350/351/353 (lBC350,351 ,353) ,059 25 35 35 30 25 35 35 35 35 30 30 30 - - - - - - - 20 20 20 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 -
- - - - - - - - - - --- - - - - -- -
ISC350P {ISC-350P}
-
18C350/351/353 (18C350,351 ,353) ,110 25 25 25 15 25 25 25 25 25 18 18 18 - - - - - - 15 15 15 18 18 18 18 18 18 20 -
- - - - - - - - ---- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -------- -- ----- ---- - - - -- --- - - - - - ----- ----- - ----- --- --- - - - - - - - - - ---
IBC352 (IBC352)
IBC354/355 (lBC354, 355)
.130 20 20 20 13 20 20 20 20 20 15 15 15 - - - - - - - 13 13 13 15 15 15 15 15 15 - -
ISC351 DI {ISC-3501}
MR-312 {MR312}
MF312 {MF312}
Autocall
4261501 {X6}, 4261-502 {X6}
Copyright C 1995 Grinn,,11 Fire Protection Systems Company, Inc. Publication Number 19700411
Appearance subject to improvement without notice. Page A-l0
Talble 1 Grinnell Fire Protection Systems and AUTOCALL Fire Control Panels Fire Detector Compatibility Chart
TFX-500/800,
Merli~, MP-400, AP-400, 500M/SOOM, FireQuest
ACII, Al-1500, Al-1500E MDK(1)(2), MDK2(11)(12) FireQuest 300 KDR-l000 500MV/SOOMV FireQuest 200 100
....
c..,
12:
~
12:
~
m
E ::;:;
-c
05 "E
m
..
U
~ m <C'" ::;; ::;; E' U
:b ., :b ~ ~ ~ ~ .=;t coo: C
Manufi!cturer 0
N
~
..,~
0 N
~!!!
C
0
C
0
. ..,
~'"
N"
10.:
c
0
c
0 0 ..
NN
000:
~~
.. ..
oI! 0 0 E;;:
Standby
..,~ .., ;::: ;::: c.. E:::> c 0
~ ~ '"
0 0 0 "a;
me
~
m ::;; ::;;~ ::;; "0
E> E>
~ ~ ~
Current u... m m N X c~ c~
~
Detectol' {Identifier) 0 0 u- C ..
~
0 ..
1;; N N
1;; 1;; 1;; 1;; 1;; 1;; U UN N m <C m as Nc S5 ::;;.e, ua:
0 ..
ua: ....
N ~g ~g
Base Model (Identilier) (rnA)
'" '" :
System Sensor (formerly BRI<)
1451 {A}, :!451 TH {A}
2451 {A}
Detection Systems
DS200/DS200HD {A}
ES_L.
420C {S 1OJ, 420CT {S 1OJ, 425C {S 1OJ,
425CT {S10}, 420CR{S11}, 420CRT {S11},
425CR{SI1}, 425CRT {S11}
Copyright C 1995 Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company, Inc. Publication Number 19700411
Appearance subject to improvement without notice.
Page A-11
Tilble 1 Grinnell Fire Protection Systems and AUTOCALL Fire Control Panels Fire Detector Compatibility Chart
TFXSOO/800,
Merliin, MP-400, AP-400, SOOIll/800M, FireQuest
ACI!, Al-1500, Al-1500E MDK(1)(2), MDK2(11)(12) FireQuest 300 KDR-l000 SOOWIV/800MV FireQuest 200 100
oh
0
~
~ ~
~
'i'
~
~
In
...'i'
~
a::1
N
.c;:
.~!!!
5
C
<:>
5
C
co ~"
",U
=- U
c
0
U
c
0
0>
c::oo:
o~
NN
0>
c::
0<1:
NN
~ ..,~
~ ~
Manufacturer Ln.!:::
.,;;; oil <:> co E;:
~ :i:., .,:i: Qio
Standby 0 'i' E::>
.,
6 .,
6 .,
co a::1~ In N N
...,
c.. In In 'U C QjC;
~ ~ ~ t:!
5-
Detector {Identifier} Current
:;:; N
0
fil :;:; :;:; :;:; :;:; :;:; :;:; ....Ua::1 .... a::1 a::1
N
t:!
a::1
5
N
C :i ~ ~ eo>
5.e,
E>
0 ..
E>
0 ..
5
:it ~ ...
~ ...
~
c::~
~e
c::~
~g
Base Model (ldentHler) (rnA) In UN
'" '" UIX: UIX: N
Fenwal (Cont.)
CPD7021 {11FE1}
70-201000-001 (FEOlA) - - - - 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 - - -
,
- - 40 40 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 25 -
70-201000-002 (FE02A) - - - - 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 25 -
.060
70-201000-003 (FE03A) - - - - - - - - - 30 30 30 - - - - - 40 40 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 25 -
70-201000-00S (FEOSA) - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 30 30 30 - - - - - - 25 -
CPD7126 {P6FE1}
70201000-001 (FEOlA),
70201000002 (FE02A), - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 30 30 30 30 30 30 25 -
70-201000-003 (FE03A) _070
\,.
70-201000-00S (FEOSA) - - - - - - - - - - - - ~
- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 25 -
PSD-7155 {P55FE 1}
DHSI (DH22FES), - - - - - - 20 20 20 - - - - - 20 20 20 - 20 -
- - - - - 20 20 20 20 25
DH-22 (DH22FE1)
DHSI (DH22FES),
DH-22 (DH22FE1)
- - - - - - - - - 20 20 20 - - - - - - - 20 20 20 - - - - - - - -
Copyright C 1995 Grinn,,11 Fire Protection Systems Company, Inc. Publication Number 19700411
Appearance subject to improvement without notice. Page A-12
Table 1 Grinnell Fire Protection Systems and AUTOCALL Fire Control Panels Fire Detector Compatibility Chart
TFXSOO/800,
Merlin, MP400, Ap400, SOOM/800M, FireQuest
ACI!, AL1500, AL1500E MDK(1)(2), MDK2(11)(12) FireQuest 300 KDRl000 SOOMV/800MV FireQuest 200 100
: :
.. "iii III
"E "".Ii
~
=-~
c:""
00 is -< III
=-<> :!: ;
N:S
~
=-
1:1:
-
:
<>
to: .,
:
... ~
~
0;;;:
:;:.c < "'
:= U=" "'
= " . ..
~
!It :s :s U
J;
~ fj ~ -h ~
~<>
<>
...
~
!XI
N
::il
j!!i!
c<:> c
<> -=
....
N'" 0
c c:
0
c:<
0..,.
c
0<
Manul'acturer Standby
<>
.,;;!; .,~
C>
., i ., Cj>
.,<> .,~ 011 c.,
<> <> Ill.: E::::> E:;= c
NN
c _
~C;
N""
'iic
-~
N
0 0 0 0 !XI !XI 12
'"
~ ~
'1' :s '"
~ ~m E> E> :s xN x c_
Current ~
~ ~!
:;;: F:i
..,.
Detector {Identifier} C> C> u.. u..!XI !XI N !::! N 0 .. 0"
;;; ftj ftj ;;; ;;; ;;; ;;; ;;; U UN N !XI <t !XI !XI C ~ :ss, ua: ua: t;;! ~9 ~g
Base Model (ldentHier) (mA) '" ""
Fenwal (Cont.)
PSD712!i{P5FE1}
70201000001 (FEOlA), - -
70201000002 (FE02A)
- - - - 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 - - - - - 38 38 20 20 20 30 30 30 30 30 30 25
----~- ---- -
702011X1000S (FEOSA) - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 20 20 20 - - - - - - - -
PSD712!>D (P5DFE1)
PSD7126 {P6FE1}
702011X10001 (FEOlA), -
702011X10002 (FE02A)
- - - - - 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 - - - - 38 38 20 20 20 30 30 30 30 30 30 25 -
.070
70201000003 (FE03A) - - - - - - - - - 30 30 30 - - - - - - 38 20 20 20 30 30 30 30 30 30 25 -
PSD7129 {P9FE1}
70201000001 (FEOlA). - - - - - 30 30 30 30 25 25 25 - - - - - 35 3S 15 15 15 25 25 25 25 25 25 2S -
702011X10002 (FE02A)
702011X1000S (FE05A) - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 25 -
Gentex
-
DS200/DS200HD {A} (15) .100 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
Pyrotector
3124(N)(1)(R) {X5}
7124(N)(1)(R) {X6}
Copyright C 1995 Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company. Inc. Publication Number 19700411
Appearance subject to improvement without notice. Page A-13
T;ible 1 Grinnell Fire Protection Systems and AUTOCALL Fire Control Panels Fire Detector Compatibility Chart
TFX-500/800,
Merlin, MP-400, AP-400, 500M/800M, FireQuest
ACII, Al-1500,Al-1500E MDK(I)(2), MDK2(11)(12) FireQuest 300 KDR-l000 500MV/800MV FireQuest 200 100
12: :
.. Gl ID ."
c'" g ~ is .Ii '"
.Ii
.... .."'
~
00
~ :
-
~~
S .c
N::E
0
g
-..,N
~
"'-
..,..,
"'-
..
ff
0
E
N
9
e.., : "'-
~
~
::E
::E !2" U
-.::
E E
U .. ..
~ ~
'1' c
~
ID
.b ..... :3 N
.c;: I c
<>
C
c -"
NU
It).:
c
0
c
0
C
0 .. 0
NN
Manufacturer 0 ""ID
;:- <> ~~
..,~
oil 0 E;;:
Standby
..,~ ~N l ~ ..,6 ..,~ ~ ~ 'U E:::>
-..,"'
N
..,
~- "'
'1' C
~
<1_ .. 0
~ c::E~
ID IDe. :;; E> E> :; c_ "0
c_
-~
Detector {Identifier} Current 0 !L !LID ID !::! !::! ~ N t:~ .. 0 .. 0 ..
:1( f:S f:S f:S
in IilJ in in in in in U UN N III ID III C
== :;.!:!o ua: ua: N .... .... ~g ~g
Base Model (Identifier) (rnA) "'
System Sensor
1400 {A) .120 - - - - - - - - - 18 18 18 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 20 20 20 18 18 18 18 18 18 25 4
8401 (A) - - - - - - - - - 18 18 18 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 16 16 16 18 18 18 18 18 18 25 4
84068 (A) - - - - - - - - - 18 18 18 - - - - - 25 25 16 16 16 - 18 18 18 18 18 25 -
1851DH{A}
DHI851DC (A) - - - - - - - - - - - 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 16 16 16 18 18 18 18 18 18 25 -
.120
2400 {A} (15) - - - - - - - - 18 18 18 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 16 16 16 18 18 18 18 18 18 25 4
2851 DH {A}
2851TH{A}
(1) Optional LED annunciator - use BRK Model RMOO with BRK Detectors; use Autoca1l4261-521 with Autocall (9) Dual circuit, Style D (formerly called Class "A"). Compatibility identifier 01A.
Detectors. (10) Dual circuit, Style D with test switch . Compatibility identifier 01A.
(2) The following detectors may be mixed in any quantity up to the maximum on a single circuit: (11) Optional LED annunciator - use BRI< Model FIA400 with BRK Detectors; use Fenwal Model RA12 with Fenwal
BRK 1851B ionization and BRK 2851 B/2851 BTH photoelectric. detectors.
BRK 1451 ionization and BRK 2451/2451TH photoelectric. (12) The following detectors may be mixHd in any quantity up to the maximum on a single circuit:
Autoca1l4261-501 ion and AutocaIl4261-50:l/504 photo. BRK 1451 ionization and BRK 2451/2451TH photoelectric.
Duct detectors may not be mixed on a circuit. Fenwal CPD-7021 ionization and Fenwal PSD-7125tpSD-7126tpSD-7130/PSD-7131 photoelectric.
(3) Alarm verification retard reset time is field adjustable from 0 to 26 seconds maximum. Duct detectors may not be mixed on a circuit.
(4) 8 zone Style D (formerly called Class "A"). Compatibility identifier 01A. (13) If using these detectors with:
(5) 16 zone Style B (formerly called Class "B'). Compatibility identifier 01A. AVM Module (PIN 910666), set the AVM alarm verification lime to the minimum.
(6) Transponder, 4 Style D Smoke Circuits. Compatlibility identifier 01A. VSD Module (PIN 910290), set the VSD alarm verification time to zero (0).
(7) Dual circuit, Style B (formerly called Class "B"). Compatibility identifier 01A. (14) Base with Adaptor MA-OOI (MAFE1) PIN 920126.
(8) Dual circuit, Style B with test switch. Compatibility identifier 01A. (15) Base is built in to detector.
Copyright C 1995 Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company, Inc. Publication Number 19700411
Appearance subject to improvement without notice. Page A-14
Talble 2 Other Fire Control Panels Compatible with Grinnell 350 Seriies Detectors
Harrington
Federal Signal Co.
FaradllY Faraday Signal HS2200 National Silent
15220, 15108Bl (1), Corp. FFC200o(2), Time & Knigh1
.. al 15112Bl (1), Faraday Firelarm G~lmewell Co. HS2400 Signal 5204 (5)
c.., 15240,
5207 (5)
00
852,854 15116Bl(1) MPC2000, 19000A, 19000A EVAC 2000 (2) ZANS 400, FLEX 300, FS140 (2) FFC400o(2) 7000
N5
-...
'"'" :::! ~
Standby =.: :
N
12:
Detector 1[ldentifier}
Base Model (lden1Hler)
Current
(rnA)
~
:z
~
:z 0
...
0 ...'"0 '"0... '"
...
0 ~
:z ~
:>
~
..,
N
...
In
N
~
:z
co
....~ ~
:z
IBC352 (IBC-352) - - - - - - - 30 - - - - 25 - -
.080
IBC354/355 (IBC354, 355) 30 18 18 18 30 30 30 30 - - - - 25 35 -
)SC350P {ISC350P}
IBC352 (1IlC352) - - - - - - - 22 - - - - 20 - 25
.130
IBC-354i3~;5 (IBC-354, 355) 25 12 12 12 25 25 25 20 - - - - 20 25 25
(1) This panel uses circuit styles Band D. (4) This panel uses circuit style D.
(2) This panel uses circuit style B. (5) This panel uses circuit style A.
(3) This panel uses circuit style A, B, C, D.
Copyright C 1995 Grinnell Fire Protection Systems Company Publication Number 19700411
Appearance subject to improvement without notice. PageA-15
@J ~!)!!!!!~!!S:EMS COMPANY
~DEO'\
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 1-2
Earth ground tab, protection of RBus, on MPIM, specifications, 19
70 wiring, 21
EEPROM Fiber optic, wiring for ThornNet, 7
main processor Fiber optic modem module, TLO-530, 127
programming for ARM-500 installation, 80
programming for XIOM, 82 Fire control module, FCM, 19-29
onALXM,77
on main processor board, 57
programming, TLX-530 network interface, 101 G
programming main processor
for 16 input XIOM, 84 Gateway, network application, TLI-530, 102
for SRA-550/DACT, 94 Ground detection, resistor in RPS-424, 60
for XIOM 8 input 8 output, 86
Enclosures, TFX-500M/800M, 17-18
End-of-line
H
for 506SDA, 162 Header
for lXA-500CM, 136 FCM,21
for lXA-500Dtv1, 145 for lXA-500DMA, 148
for lXA-501CM, 142 last board, for 16-Status control module, 48
for lXA-500DMA, 148 SRA-550 relay configuration, 94
for OXA-500SB, 168 XIOM configuration, 82
for OXA-500SD, 156 8 input 8 output, 86
for OXA-504SDA, 158
Headers
for RS-485 network circuit, TLI-530, 103
on main processor board, 57
for TLO-530, 129
XIOM, 16 input module configuration, 84
lXA-500CMA and lXA-502CMA, 138
Hub
Environmental limitations, for TFX-500M/800M configuration, using TLB-530 baseboard, 123
enclosures, 17
network application, TLI-530, 102
Event, central logging, in ThornNet, 6
Expansion bus
cable converter, 99 I
connection to 16 input XIOM, 84
lAA-16, XIOM 16 input module, 83-84
connection to ARM-500, 79
XIOM, 8 input 8 output, 86 IAM-800
XIOM connection, 82 expansion motherboard, 73-76
installation, 74
Expansion motherboard, lAM -800, 73-76
specifications, 73
wiring, 74
IAN-ADD, addressable Xpert card, for analog de-
F tector, 179
Fault IBN-550, detector base, 4-inch addressable, 179
inputs, on main processor board, 57 IBN-551, detector base, 6-inch addressable, 179
pulldown, TLI-530, 103
IBN-552, detector base, 6-inch addressable low
relay connection, on IAM-800 expansion mo-
profile, 179
therboard,74
IBN-553, detector base, 6-inch addressable with
FCM relay, 179
fire control module, 19-29
installation, 20 IBN-554, detector base, 6-inch addressable with
last board header, 21 sounder, 179
operation, 19 IHN-135, detector head, 135 deg. heat analog ad-
programming for, 22 dressable, 179
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 1-3
IHN-135/200, heat detector, operation, 181 specifications, 137
wiring, 138
IHN-200, detector head, 200 deg. heat analog ad-
dressable, 179
IIB-800
ALXM, connection to IAM-800 expansion mo-
J
therboard,74 Jumper, MPIM personality, 70
ALXM loop expansion board, 77
Jumpers, ARM-500, relay contact type, 80
Installation, TFX - XA interface, 114
ISN-55OI
detector head, ionization smoke analog address-
able, 179
L
ionization detector, operation, 180 LCD
connection to ODM, 33
ISN-550P
contrast control, on MPIM, 70
detector head, optical smoke analog addressable,
179 Lightning, protection, 9
optical detector, operation, 180 Line isolator module, CAA-500LI, 133-134
lXA-500, lXA motherboard, connection to Local bus
lXA-502CMA module, 137 connection to DCPM, 67
lXA-500CM connection to lAM-800 expansion motherboard,
contact monitoring module, 135-136 74
installation, 135 on main processor board, 57
specifications, 135 on MPIM, not used when remote bus connected,
wiring, 136 70
PIM-550 connection, 87
lXA-500CMA
contact monitoring module, 137-140 Loop
installation, 137 addressable, on IAM-800 expansion mother-
specifications, 137 board, 74
wiring, 138 circuits, on main processor board, 57
expansion board, ALXM, 77
lXA-500DM TFX addressable, in TFX-to-XA control panel
detector compatibility. See 19700411, Detector assembly, 108
Compatibility Chart XA
detector monitor module, 143-145 connection to XAl, 106
installation, 144 in TFX-to-XA control panel assembly, 108
specifications, 143
wiring, 145
lXA-500DMA M
detector compatibility. See 19700411, Detector
Compatibility Chart Main processor board, 55-58
detector monitor module, 147-149 circuit characteristics, 57
installation, 148 connection to TLA-530 adaptor board, 121
specifications, 147 for powering TLO-530, 129
wiring, 148 in TFX-to-XA control panel assembly, 107
installation to TLI-530 network interface, 101
lXA-501CM
installation, 141 Manual stations, \viring \"ith detectors, 9
mini contact monitoring module, 141-142 MDM521, detector monitor module, 143
specifications, 141
wiring, 142 Mini contact monitoring module, lXA-501CM, 141
AUTO CALL TFX-500M and TFX-800M Operator's Manual and Installation Guide
Page 1-4